Computerized Accounting Using Tally - Erp 9 - Student Guide
Computerized Accounting Using Tally - Erp 9 - Student Guide
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
-S
06
00
60
88
11
21
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
-S
06
00
60
88
Computerized Accounting
11
21
Using Tally.ERP 9
R
___________________
Student Guide
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The information contained in this document is current as of the date of publication and subject to change. Because Tally must
respond to changing market conditions, it should not be interpreted to be a commitment on the part of Tally, and Tally cannot
guarantee the accuracy of any information presented after the date of publication. The information provided herein is general,
not according to individual circumstances, and is not intended to substitute for informed professional advice.
This document is for informational purposes only. TALLY MAKES NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, IN
THIS
R
DOCUMENT AND SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR LOSS OR DAMAGE OF WHATEVER NATURE, ARISING OUT
AI
OF, OR IN
N
CONNECTION WITH THE USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THE CONTENT OF THIS PUBLICATION, AND/OR
AN
ANY CONDUCT UNDERTAKEN BY PLACING RELIANCE ON THE CONTENTS OF THIS PUBLICATION.
AR
Complying with all applicable copyright and other intellectual property laws is the responsibility of the user. All rights
including copyrights, rights of translation, etc., are vested exclusively with TALLY SOLUTIONS PRIVATE LIMITED. No
H
part of this document may be reproduced, translated, revised, stored in, or introduced into a retrieval system, or transmitted
ED
in any form, by any means (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise), or for any purpose, without the
express written permission of Tally Solutions Pvt. Ltd.
LE
Tally may have patents, patent applications, trademarks, copyrights, or other intellectual property rights covering subject
R
matter in this document. Except as expressly provided in any written licence agreement from Tally, the furnishing of this
U
document does not give you any licence to these patents, trademarks, copyrights, or other intellectual property.
IM
Tally, Tally 9, Tally9, Tally.ERP, Tally.ERP 9, Shoper, Shoper 9, Shoper POS, Shoper HO, Shoper 9 POS, Shoper 9 HO,
TallyDeveloper, Tally Developer, Tally.Developer 9, Tally.NET, Tally Development Environment, Tally Extender, Tally
TE
Integrator, Tally Integrated Network, Tally Service Partner, TallyAcademy & Power of Simplicity are either registered
trademarks or trademarks of Tally Solutions Pvt. Ltd. in India and/or other countries. All other trademarks are properties of
-S
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1 Fundamentals of Accounting 1
R
AI
2 Journalizing and Posting of Transaction 19
N
AN
3 Maintaining Chart of Accounts in Tally.ERP9 70
AR
H
4 Fundamentals of Inventory Management 102
8 Banking 253
-S
06
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
TallyPRO- Part I
Chapter 1
Fundamentals of Accounting
Learning Objectives
The meaning and importance of accounting.
Commonly used accounting terms.
R
Accounting assumptions, concepts and principles.
AI
Types of accounts.
N
Golden rules of accounting.
AN
Double entry system of accounting.
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1.1 Introduction
Commercial businesses run with the objective of earning profit, and financial transactions are the
order of the day. It becomes essential for a business owner to keep a record of the business’ income
and expenditure, in order to find answers to numerous questions, a few of which are:
Is the business earning profits or is it incurring a loss?
How much do third parties owe the business?
How much does the business owe to third parties?
Can the business be expanded?
Should a specific operation be withdrawn?
R
AI
What is the total value of business assets?
N
AN
These answers can be arrived at, by studying the financial information of a business operation.
Thus, accounting is an integral part of any business.
AR
Accounting is the practice of maintaining precise records of the financial dealings of a business. It
H
involves identifying business transactions, recording them, and summarising the same in such a
ED
way that important financial information can be communicated to the stakeholders of the business.
Accounting is also called as language of business.
LE
R
Owners
Management
FF
Employees
TE
Suppliers
6
Customers
00
Lending institutions
00
Government authorities
8 86
11
To help you understand accountancy better, a few commonly-used accounting terms are explained
R
below:
1. Transaction
A transaction is a business activity that involves the transfer of money or money’s worth
between two accounts.
A transaction can be of two types:
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Credit transaction: A credit transaction is one where money is paid later, but the
benefits are enjoyed immediately.
2. Capital
Total amount of money or money worth invested in the business by owner is called capital.
3. Assets:
Anything possessed or owned by an individual or company, which are not for usual selling
or trading purpose and utilised over a period of time are called assets
R
AI
4. Liability
N
Liability is the amount due for the goods, services or anything taken from party or anyone
AN
is called as liability of the business
AR
5. Drawings
H
The money withdrawn or taken something of money worth from business for the personal
ED
use is called drawings. LE
6. Bad debts
R
The amount which is unrecoverable from the debtor due to reason like insolvency or
U
absconding and company will not be able to realize due amount from the debtor, hence
IM
7. Purchases
TE
A purchase is the amount of goods bought by a business for further use or for reselling.
-S
Goods purchased with immediate payment of cash are called cash purchases. Goods
6
8. Purchase returns
86
Goods that have been purchased but are returned to the seller before consumption due
8
to reasons like poor quality and damage are called ‘purchase returns’.
11
9. Sales
21
R
Sales refer to the amount of goods sold by a business. Sales made against immediate
payment of cash are called cash sales. Sales on credit, are called credit sales.
10. Sales returns
Goods that have been sold but are returned by the buyer before consumption, due to
reasons like poor quality and damage, are called ‘sales returns’.
11. Debtor
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
A debtor is a person who receives benefits from the business immediately, but is
obligated to pay for the same in future. For example, a buyer who purchases goods from
the business on credit, becomes a debtor to the business.
12. Creditor
A person who provides benefit without receiving immediate payment for the same, and
who will claim the payment in future, is called a ‘creditor’. For example, when the
business purchases goods on credit from a supplier, the supplier becomes a creditor to
the business.
13. Stock
R
AI
Unsold goods, raw material, etc., that lie with the business are collectively known as
N
‘stock’.
AN
14. Revenue
AR
The earnings of a business through its activities and operations, is called ‘revenue’.
H
ED
LE
1.3 Accounting Assumptions, Concepts and
R
Principles
U
IM
To ensure that the interpretation of financial information derived from accounting is uniform,
FF
the following assumptions, concepts, and principles have been developed. They form the basis
for accountancy.
TE
1.3.1 Assumptions
6 -S
As per this assumption, a business is considered as a separate unit or entity from its owner.
00
That is, the proprietor and his business are treated as two distinct entities. Therefore, the
86
transactions of the business are separate from its owner’s personal transactions. All the
8
business transactions are recorded in the Books of Accounts from the business’
11
perspective.
21
Example: A vehicle purchased by the business owner for his personal use, should not be
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
For Example: In Bangladesh, the financial year starts from 1 July and ends on next
30 June. In Iran, the financial year starts from 21st March and ends on next 20th
March.
R
will not be reflected in the accounts of the same year as its acquisition; the cost will be
AI
broken into specific amounts which will be accounted for in subsequent years of the
N
business. This is done with the assumption that the business concern will continue to
AN
operate in the forthcoming year
4. Money Measurement Assumption: According to this assumption, only those business
AR
transactions that can be measured in terms of money are recorded. Example: The sales
H
made by a business during a particular day will be recorded in its books of accounts, as it
ED
can be expressed in terms of money. However, aspects like employee satisfaction will not
be recorded in the books of accounts, as they cannot be accounted in terms of money.
LE
R
U
1.3.2 Concepts
IM
1. Accrual Concept
FF
This concept requires that income or expenditure are recorded when they become
TE
receivable or payable rather than when they are collected or paid i.e., transactions are
-S
recorded on the basis of income earned or expense incurred irrespective of actual receipt
6
or payment.
00
Example: A seller bills the buyer at the time of sale and treats the bill amount as revenue,
00
This concept states that every financial transaction has two aspects: one where the business
21
receives a benefit, and the other where it provides a benefit. Therefore, every transaction
R
should be recorded in such a way that its effect is reflected in two places in a business’
books of accounts. This concept forms the basis for the Double Entry System of
Accounting.
Example: When a business buys a machinery, it receives a benefit (the machinery), and
also provides a benefit (pays for the machinery).
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The various stakeholders of a business derive important information from its financial
statements. Hence, this concept explains that the financial records of a business concern
give a true and fair view of the business’ financial position.
4. Historical Cost Concept
This concept states that assets need to be recorded at the price paid for their acquisition,
and not at their current market value. Thus, a business’ financial statement will not indicate
the price at which its assets could be sold for.
Example: If a business has purchased a machinery for ₹ 10,00,000, and its market value
has come down to ₹ 8,00,000 at the time of preparing final accounts, the value will be
R
AI
recorded as ₹ 10,00,000.
N
5. Matching Concept
AN
As per this concept, the revenue earned and the cost incurred to earn such revenue, need
AR
to belong to the same period, and hence they need to be ‘matched’. This will help ascertain
the result of the business operations. This concept serves as the basis for calculating
H
ED
accurate profit earned during a period. LE
Example: A business pays ₹1, 00,000 as factory rent. Other expenses incurred for business
operations like salaries and wages paid, maintenance of machinery, etc., amount to ₹ 15,
R
00,000. The sales made for the month, amount to ₹ 25, 00,000. The profit of the business
U
IM
According to this concept, revenue is considered as the income earned on the date when
it is received. As per this concept, unearned or unrealised revenue is not taken into account.
-S
This concept is vital for determining income pertaining to an accounting period. It reduces
6
00
Example: On 25th December 2017, ABC Company received a sales order to supply goods
86
worth ₹ 50, 00,000 to M/s. National Traders ABC Company delivered goods worth ₹ 35,
00,000 on 31th December. The remaining supply was delivered on 2nd January 2017. The
8
11
revenue from this transaction for 2017 will be ₹ 35, 00,000 only. The remaining amount
21
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1.3.3 Principles
1. Cost Benefit Principle
This principle states that the cost incurred for applying an accounting principle should be
lesser than the profits derived from doing so.
2. Materiality Principle
As stated earlier in this chapter, financial statements are used by the various stakeholders
to do analysis and arrive at decisions. Hence, all information that is disclosed in financial
R
statements, should aid the interested parties in arriving at decisions.
AI
N
3. Consistency Principle
AN
The accounting practices adopted by a business for a year should be applied in the coming
AR
years too. That is, the accounting practices followed for one financial year should not vary
from those of the previous financial year. Consistency in accounting practices facilitates
H
the comparison of financial statements across years and can help draw important
conclusions about a business.
ED
LE
4. Prudence (Conservatism) Principle
R
U
This principle highlights the uncertainty with which businesses operate. It requires that a
IM
business make provisions for probable losses, but operate by anticipating profits.
FF
Conservatism leads accountants to anticipate/disclose losses, but it does not allow a similar
TE
Every business transaction has a two-fold effect, wherein two accounts are affected in opposite
86
directions. Thus, if a complete record were to be made of each such transaction, it is necessary to
debit one account and credit another account. Recording of this two fold effect of every
8
11
As explained in the Dual Aspect Concept, every financial transaction has two aspects: one where
R
the business receives a benefit, and the other where it provides benefit. Therefore, every
transaction should be recorded in such a way that its effect is reflected in two places in a business
Books of Accounts. The receiving aspect is termed the ‘Debit’ aspect. The giving aspect is termed
the ‘Credit’ aspect. Therefore, every business transaction will have an effect on two accounts; one
will be debited, whereas the other will be credited.
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1.5 Types of Accounts
An ‘account’ is a statement of transactions relating to one of the two aspects of a business
transaction. Based on the aspect being recorded, an account can be ‘debited’ or ‘credited.
R
In effect, there are three types of accounts maintained for transactions:
AI
N
Personal Accounts
AN
Personal Accounts are relating to individuals, a group of individuals, firms and institutions.
AR
They are of three types:
H
ED
o Natural person's accounts: represents the accounts of real persons the business
deal with. The proprietor's account, the accounts of suppliers and customers are
LE
some examples of natural person's accounts.
R
o Artificial person's accounts: represents the accounts of firms the business deals
U
with. The accounts of a limited companies or banks that are not real persons are
IM
o Representative personal account: If a business has not paid the rent of a number
of shops for the past two months then all the landlords are creditors of the business
TE
and the amount due to them is recorded under a common head called Rent
-S
Real Accounts
00
Real accounts are relating to the property or assets and cash belonging to a business concern.
86
o Tangible Real accounts: are accounts of things that can be touched, measured,
21
sold or purchased. Examples of tangible real accounts are furniture account, plant
R
Nominal Accounts
Nominal accounts relating to the incomes, expenses, losses and gains of a business concern.
Without nominal accounts, it is difficult for the management to find out where the money
was spent. The net result of all the nominal accounts helps the management to find out the
profit earned or loss incurred by the business.
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Example: Salary accounts, discount allowed, discount received, etc.
R
AI
N
AN
Debit the receiver
AR
Personal accounts
H
Credit the giver
ED
LE
Debit what comes in
R
U
Real accounts
IM
Nominal accounts
6
00
Table 1.1
8 86
11
Note: The cash basis of accounting is a method wherein revenue is recognised when it is actually received, rather
21
than when it is earned. Expenses are booked when they are actually paid, rather than when incurred. This method
is usually not used by businesses and is, therefore, used only in select situations such as for very small businesses.
R
For example: A sale of iphone 7 for ₹ 80,000 is made to Mr.Praveen, a customer of PG & Co.
who does not make the payment at the time of the sale. In such a case Mr.Praveen is liable to
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
pay ₹ 80,000 to PG & Co. Hence, in the books of accounts of PG& Co., Mr.Praveen account is
debited since he has received goods.
Similarly, if PG & Co. has purchased from Mr.Praveen, the account of Mr.Praveen will have to
be credited and purchases will be debited.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
Below given table 1.2 is a tabular representation of the accounts and the effect on the accounts.
6
Goods
8
business
Table 1.2
R
10
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The debit balance in a real account means that the firm owns and has assets, such as goods,
stocks, and properties, and the credit balance shows that the business has negative balance for
these assets.
In practice, there cannot be a credit balance in a real account except when the property has been
sold at a profit.
For example: If PG & Co. bought Machinery for ₹ 1, 25,000 then value of Machinery in the
business increases. Hence, Machinery account is debited, since payment is made in cash the
balance of cash decreases and Cash account is credited.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
Below given table 1.3 is a tabular representation of the accounts and the effect on the accounts.
8
11
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Rule for Nominal Accounts
In a Nominal account, the rule to be followed is, "Debit all expenses and losses; Credit all
incomes and gains."
All debits in a nominal account infer that there has been an expense or the business has made a
loss in a transaction, and a credit in a nominal account denotes that the business has earned
money, income or profit.
A debit balance in nominal account indicates a loss or an expense, and credit balance indicates a
gain or an income.
R
For example, PG & Co. pays ₹ 16,000 salaries in cash. Since payment of salaries is an expense
AI
for the company, Salaries account is debited. Moreover, payment of salaries is made in cash, thus
N
the balance of cash decreases and cash account is credited.
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
Given table 1.4 is a tabular representation of the accounts and the effect on the accounts.
R
12
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
business through
Bank
Table 1.4
R
involved.
AI
N
The following are the most common source documents:
AN
Bill/Invoice : When a trader sells goods to a buyer on credit (agreeing to a delayed
payment by the buyer), he provides a “sales invoice” with the details of the name and
AR
address of the buyer, the name of goods, the amount, terms of payments, etc.
H
ED
Cash Memo: When goods are sold for cash, the seller issues a ‘Cash Memo’ to the
purchaser. The cash memo contains details of quantity of goods sold, rate per unit of goods
LE
sold, and total value of the sale.
R
Cheque: Cheques’ issued by a buyer become source documents for recording transactions
U
IM
Credit Note: A ‘credit note’ is recorded by the seller, when goods sold by him are returned
FF
to him by the buyer. It contains details of the goods returned, the buyer’s details, and the
TE
amount involved.
-S
A ‘credit note’ is even used by the banking sector The credit note is issued to the account
6
A ‘credit note’ is also used to increase the value of the previous invoice sent by the supplier
and the credit note will be issued by the customer to the supplier.
8 86
Debit Note: A ‘debit note’ is recorded by a buyer when goods purchased by them are
11
returned to the seller. It contains details of the goods being returned, the seller’s details,
21
A ‘debit note’ is also recorded to adjust an under billed invoice. Debit note is issued by the
supplier to the customer.
Receipt: A trader issues a ‘receipt’ to a buyer, when payment is in the form of cash. It
contains details of date, amount of cash received, and the buyer’s details.
Voucher: Vouchers’ are prepared by the accountant, and signed by the designated person
in the organization and they contain detailed information regarding the payee, monetary
value of the payment, a description of the transaction, and more.
13
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Conclusion
This chapter summarises the fundamentals of Accountancy, starting with the Accounting terms,
assumptions, concepts, principles, right up to the double entry system of accounting. It explains
the need and usage of Golden Rules of Accounting in the books of accounting.
R
AI
Key Takeaways
N
Accounting is a comprehensive system to collect, analyse and communicate financial
AN
information.
AR
Entity is the organisational unit for which accounting records are maintained.
Double Entry accounting is a system of recording transactions in a way that maintains the
H
equality of the accounting equation.
ED
The three types of accounts maintained for transactions are real accounts, personal
accounts and nominal accounts.
LE
R
U
IM
Practice Exercises
FF
TE
1. Rajesh purchased goods from Anup Enterprises and agreed to pay for the same two weeks
-S
a. Debtor
00
b. Creditor
00
c. Proprietor
d. Employee
8 86
2. Accounts have to be maintained with an expectation that the business will exist for a
11
3. Accounts relating to the property or assets and cash belonging to a business concern are
called:
a. Personal Account
b. Real Account
c. Nominal Account
d. Not an Account
14
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Kotak Bank account is an example of a _______________________.
a. Personal Account
b. Real Account
c. Nominal Account
d. Not an Account
5. According to the ‘Golden Rules’ of Accounting, ‘Debit Expenses and Losses’ and ‘Credit
all _______.
a. Giver
b. Incomes and Gains
c. Receiver
d. Revenue
R
AI
N
6. Given below are the three types of accounts and an example of each in a jumbled format.
AN
1 Personal Account A Furniture and Fittings Account
AR
2 Real Account B Sumit’s Account
3 Nominal Account C Transportation Charges Account
H
Identify the correct account to example match:
a. 1-a, 2-b, 3-c ED
LE
b. 1-b, 2-a, 3-c
R
7. A vehicle purchased by the business owner for his personal use, should be recorded in the
FF
a. True
b. False
6 -S
a. True
00
b. False
86
9. Cheque is used as one of the most common source documents in the business.
8
11
a. True
b. False
21
R
10. Debit Notes and Credit Notes cannot be considered as the source documents in business.
a. True
b. False
15
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 2
Journalising and Posting of
Transactions
Learning Objectives
R
Classification of transactions according to their nature.
AI
Subsidiary books and Control accounts.
N
Trial Balance.
AN
Trading and Profit & Loss account.
AR
Balance Sheet.
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
16
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2.1 Introduction
Commercial businesses run with the objective of earning profit, and financial transactions are the
order of the day. It becomes essential for a business owner to keep a record of the business’ income
and expenditure, in order to find answers to numerous questions, a few of which are:
Is the business earning profits or is it incurring a loss?
How much do third parties owe the business?
How much does the business owe to third parties?
R
Can the business be expanded?
AI
Should a specific operation be withdrawn?
N
What is the total value of business assets?
AN
These answers can be arrived at, by studying the financial information of a business operation.
AR
Thus, accounting is an integral part of any business.
H
Accounting is the practice of maintaining precise records of the financial transactions of a business.
ED
It involves identifying business transactions, recording them, and summarising the same in such a
LE
way that important financial information can be communicated to the stakeholders of the business.
Accounting is also called as language of business.
R
U
IM
Owners
Management
TE
Employees
-S
Suppliers
00
Customers
00
Lending institutions
86
Government authorities
8
11
21
A transaction is an event or happening that changes an organisation’s financial position and/or its
earnings. For example, when you sell goods for cash, your cash balance increases and your stock
reduces. Such a transaction involves the reciprocal exchange of two things, receipt of cash and
delivery of stock.
Hence, the transaction involves the aspect of ‘give and take’. Receipt of cash involves the take
aspect and delivery of stock is a give aspect. Thus, business transactions are exchanges of economic
consideration between parties and have two-fold effects that are recorded in at least two accounts.
17
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
As explained earlier, business transactions are usually evidenced by appropriate documents such
as cash memo, invoice, sales bill, pay-in slip, cheque, salary slip, and so on. A document which
provides evidence of the transactions is called the source document or voucher.
R
AI
The equation reads as follows:
N
Assets = Liabilities + Capital
AN
The above equation can be presented in the following forms.
AR
Assets - Liabilities = Capital
H
ED
Assets - Capital = Liabilities
LE
As the accounting equation depicts the fundamental relationship among the components of the
balance sheet, it is also called the balance sheet equation.
R
U
IM
Entry/Journal
TE
In real accounting systems, transactions recorded in source documents are analysed and recorded
-S
for the first time in a journal, which is also known as the book of original entry. This practice
6
00
provides a complete record of each transaction in one place, apart from linking the debits and
credits for each transaction. After the debits and credits for each transaction are entered in the
00
journal, they are transferred to the individual accounts. The process of recording transactions in
86
the journal is called journalising. Once the journalising process is complete, the journal entry
8
provides a complete and useful description of the event’s effect on the organisation.
11
Journal is a day book or a daily record wherein the transactions are recorded in chronological
21
order, i.e. as and when they take place. The act of recording a transaction in the journal is called
R
journalising.
The format of journal is as shown.
Journal
18
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 2.1
Date: The date column is meant to record the date on which a particular transaction takes place.
Particulars: In the particulars column the account title to be debited is written in the first line
beginning from the left corner and the word Dr. is written at the end of the column. The account
title to be credited is written in the second line, leaving a margin on the left with a prefix To. Below
the account titles, a brief explanation of the transaction is given which is called narration. After
the narration, a line is drawn in the particulars column which indicates the end of recording the
specific journal entry.
Ledger Folio (L.F): In the Ledger Folio (L.F.) column, the page number of the ledger book on
R
AI
which relevant account appears is recorded.
N
Debit (Dr.): The debit column is meant to record the amount against the account to be debited.
AN
Credit (Cr.): The credit column is meant to record the amount against the account to be credited
AR
H
2.2.2.1 Use of Debit and Credit
ED
Every transaction involves two aspects – give and take. In the double entry system of accounting,
LE
every transaction is recorded in at least two accounts. While recording transactions, the total
R
amount debited and credited must be equal. In accounting, the terms debit (abbreviated as Dr.)
U
and credit (abbreviated as Cr.) indicate whether the transactions are to be recorded on the left or
IM
All accounts are divided into five categories for the purpose of recording business transactions.
-S
Assets
6
00
Liabilities
00
Capital
86
Expenses or losses
8
11
Incomes or gains
21
Two fundamental rules are followed to record the changes in these accounts.
R
19
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Type of Account Increase Decrease
R
AI
Table 2.2
N
The following illustration will help you to understand the Rules of Debit and Credit.
AN
Illustration 1: Application and recording transactions using Debit and Credit rules.
AR
1. As on 01-04-2017, Karthik commenced the business with ₹ 1,00,000
H
ED
2. As on 10-04-2017, purchased goods from Narayan on credit for ₹ 20,000 LE
3. As on 30-04-2017sold good to ABU Enterprises on credit ₹ 15,000
R
Solution:
U
IM
This transaction increases the capital as well as the cash. Increase in assets is debited and
increase in capital is credited. Therefore, record the transaction with debit to cash account
TE
Journal
00
86
Purchased goods from Narayan for ₹ 20,000 on credit. Increase in Revenue is credited
and increase in assets is debited. Therefore, record the transaction with credit to sales
account and debit to ABUEnterprises account.
20
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Journal
Table 2.4
R
AI
3. Sold good to ABU Enterprises on credit ₹ 10,000
N
This transaction increases sales (Income) and assets (ABU Enterprises as debtors). The
AN
rule of debit & credit says; increase in asset is debited and increase in revenue is credited.
AR
Therefore record the transaction by debiting the ABU Enterprises and Crediting the Sales
Account.
H
ED
Journal LE
Date Particulars L.F Dr. Cr.
R
on credit)
Table 2.5
TE
As explained earlier, a journal is a day book or a daily record wherein the transactions are recorded
00
in chronological order, i.e. as and when they take place. The act of recording a transaction in the
00
1. Simple Journal Entry: A journal entry in which one account is debited and one account
11
is credited.
21
R
Journal
21
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
(Being goods sold to Akash
Enterprises on credit)
Table 2.6
In the above journal entry we have debited one account i.e., Akash Enterprises and Credited one
account i.e., Sales Account.
2. Compound Journal Entry: A journal entry in which more than one debit account, more
than one credit account or more than one of both debit and credit accounts are involved
in the transactions on the same date relating to one particular account or one particular
Nature of account is termed as Compound Entry.
R
AI
Instead of recording several Journal entries we can record the transaction which involves
N
more than one debit or credit in a single journal entry called Compound Journal Entry.
AN
For Example refer the journal entry given below:
AR
As on 30-04-2017, made a payment of ₹ 30,000 towards Telephone bill ₹ 10,000,
H
Stationery Expenses ₹ 10,000, and Travelling Expenses ₹ 10,000.
Journal ED
LE
R
Table 2.7
00
In the above entry we have debited three Accounts (Telephone bill, Stationery Expenses
86
and Travelling Expenses) and credited one Account that is Cash Account. A compound
entry can be recorded in any one of the following manner:
8
11
TIM Enterprises furnishes the following information regarding transactions for the month of
April, 2017.
22
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Date Transactions
01-04-2017 Business started with cash ₹ 5,00,000
02-04-2017 Goods purchased from Mohan ₹ 40,000
04-04-2017 Stationery purchased for cash ₹ 2,000
05-04-2017 Opened a bank account with UTI Bank by depositing cash of ₹ 50,000
08-04-2017 Goods sold to Riya for ₹ 25,000
10-04-2017 Received a cheque of ₹ 25,000 from Riya
11-04-2017 Sold goods to Shrinidhi ₹ 12,000
15-04-2017 Shrinidhi pays ₹ 12,000 cash
R
16-04-2017 Goods purchased for ₹ 16,000 on credit from Neetu
AI
18-04-2017 Insurance paid by cheque ₹ 8,000
N
19-04-2017 Paid ₹ 4,000 towards rent by cash
AN
20-04-2017 Payment made to Suraj for ₹10,000 and discount received for ₹1,000
30-04-2017 Cash of ₹ 30,000 was received from Sohan and discount allowed for ₹ 3,000
AR
Table 2.8
H
ED
Solution: LE
Books of TIM Enterprises for the month of April
R
U
23
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
(Cheque received from Riya)
R
16-04-2017 Purchases A/c Dr 16,000
AI
To, Neetu A/c 16,000
N
(Purchase of goods on credit)
AN
AR
18-04-2017 Insurance premium A/c Dr 8,000
To, UTI Bank A/c 8,000
H
(Insurance premium paid by cheque)
ED
LE
19-04-2017 Rent A/c Dr 4,000
To, Cash A/c 4,000
R
U
(Rent paid)
IM
allowed)
21
Table 2.9
Note: When there are many transactions recorded in a number of pages in the journal book, then at the end of
each page of the journal book, the amount columns are totalled and carried forward (c/f) to the next page where
such amounts are recorded as brought forward (b/f) balances.
24
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2.3 Ledger
Ledger is the principal book of the accounting system and is also called the book of secondary
entry. It is defined as a book of final entry containing all the accounts of a business or all the
accounts of a particular type. In a ledger, the transactions of the same nature are classified and
grouped together at one place in the form of accounts. Ledgers may be in the form of a bound
register, cards, or separate sheets maintained in a loose leaf binder.
R
ledger, as a record of the transactions, assumes great importance in the process. The net result of
AI
all transactions in respect of a particular account on a given date can be ascertained only from the
N
ledger. For example, the organisation can ascertain the amount due from a customer only from
AN
the ledger. Ledgers, thus act as a reference for the transactions of an organisation on any given
date. Accounts are opened in the ledger in a specific order, facilitating easy posting and location.
AR
For example, accounts may be opened in the same order as they appear in the profit and loss
account or balance sheet. An index is also provided in the beginning. Some large organisations
H
ED
allot code numbers for each account for easy identification. LE
The format of a ledger is shown below:
R
Amount
IM
Table 2.10
-S
Title of the account: The name of the item is written at the top as the title of the account. The
00
Dr./Cr.: Dr.is the debit side of the account, i.e. the left side and Cr. is the credit side of the
account, i.e. the right side.
8
11
Date: Year, month, and date of transactions are posted in chronological order in this column.
21
Particulars: Name of the item with reference to the original book of entry is written on
R
25
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2.3.2 Differences between a Journal and a Ledger
Journal and ledger are the most important books in the double entry system of accounting. The
following table highlights the main differences between a journal and a ledger.
Journal Ledger
It is the book of primary entry (original entry). It is the book of secondary entry.
It is the book for chronological record. It is the book for analytical record.
Journal, as a book of source entry, gets greater Ledger gets lesser importance as legal
importance as legal evidence. evidence.
Transaction is the basis of classification of data. Account is the basis of classification of data.
R
The process of recording in the journal is known The process of recording in the ledger is
AI
as journalising. known as posting.
N
In the journal, information relating one In the ledger, the information relating to one
AN
particular account is not found in one place. particular account is found in one place.
Table 2.11
AR
2.3.3 Classification of Ledger Accounts
H
Ledger accounts are classified into five categories. They are:
ED
LE
Assets
Liabilities
R
U
Capital
IM
Revenues/gains
FF
Expense/losses
TE
All these accounts may further be classified into two groups, namely:
-S
Permanent accounts are balanced and carried forward to the next accounting period. The
86
temporary accounts are closed at the end of the accounting period by transferring them to the
8
trading account and profit and loss account. All permanent accounts appear in the balance sheet.
11
The process of transferring entries from the books of original entry (journal) to the ledger is called
R
posting. In other words, posting is the process of grouping all the transactions in respect to a
particular account at one place for a meaningful conclusion and to further the accounting process.
Depending on the requirement and convenience of the business, posting from the journal may be
done periodically, i.e. weekly, fortnightly, or monthly.
The process of posting from journal to the ledger involves the following steps.
Step 1: Locate in the ledger, the account to be debited as entered in the journal.
Step 2: Enter the date of transaction in the date column on the debit side.
26
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 3: In the particulars column, write the name of the account through which it has been debited
in the journal. For example, furniture sold for cash ₹ 17,000. Now, in the cash account on
the debit side in the particulars column, ‘Furniture’ is entered, signifying that cash is
received from the sale of furniture. In the furniture account, in the ledger on the credit side
is the particulars column, the word, cash is recorded. The same procedure is followed for
all the entries recorded in the journal.
Step 4: Enter the page number of the journal in the folio column and in the journal, write the page
number of the ledger on which a particular account appears.
Step 5: Enter the relevant amount in the amount column on the debit side. It may be noted that
R
the same procedure is followed for making the entry on the credit side of that account to
AI
be credited. An account is opened only once in the ledger and all entries relating to a
N
particular account are posted on the debit side or credit side, as the case may be.
AN
AR
Illustration 3: Posting journal transactions into the respective ledgers and transferring
from journal to ledgers.
H
ED
TIM Enterprises furnishes the following information regarding transactions for the month of
May, 2017. Journalise the transactions and then post them to ledgers
LE
Date Transactions
R
U
Table 2.12
11
Solution:
21
R
27
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
(Cash deposited in bank account)
R
15-05-2017 Cash A/c Dr 25,000
AI
To Sales A/c 25,000
N
(Goods sold on cash)
AN
AR
20-05-2017 Insurance A/c Dr 2,000
To Cash A/c 2,000
H
(Insurance premium paid)
ED
LE
22-05-2017 Rent A/c Dr 3,000
To Cash A/c 3,000
R
U
(Rent paid)
IM
(Salary paid)
-S
(Furniture purchased)
86
28
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
R
25-05-2017 By Salary A/c 5,000
AI
N
27-05-2017 By Stationery A/c 200
AN
31-05-2017 By Balance c/d 2,94,800
AR
4,25,000 4,25,000
H
ED
01-06-2017 To Balance b/d 2,94,800 LE
Table 2.14
R
U
IM
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
TE
6 -S
31-05-
00
Table 2.15
21
R
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
31-05-
05-05-2017 To Cash A/c 20,000 2017 By Balance c/d 20,000
29
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
20,000 20,000
Table 2.16
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
R
AI
N
To Ranjan Traders 31-05-
AN
10-05-2017 A/c 50,000 2017 By Balance c/d 50,000
AR
50,000 50,000
H
01-06-2017 To Balance b/d 50,000
Table 2.17 ED
LE
R
U
Amount Amount
FF
50,000 50,000
00
Table 2.18
11
21
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
31-05-
2017 To Balance c/d 33,000 15-05-2017 By Cash A/c 25,000
33,000 33,000
30
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-06-2017 To Balance b/d 33,000
Table 2.19
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
R
AI
31-05-
20-05-2017 To Cash A/c 3,000 2017 By Balance c/d 3,000
N
AN
3,000 3,000
AR
01-06-2017 To Balance b/d 3,000
H
Table 2.20
ED
LE
Dr. Rent Account Cr.
R
U
Amount Amount
IM
31-05-
-S
3,000 3,000
00
Table 2.21
8
11
21
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
31-05-
25-05-2017 To Cash A/c 5,000 2017 By Balance c/d 5,000
5,000 5,000
31
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-06-2017 To Balance b/d 5,000
Table 2.22
Dr. Raghu Account Cr.
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
R
31-05-
AI
26-05-2017 To Sales A/c 8,000 2017 By Balance c/d 8,000
N
AN
8,000 8,000
AR
01-06-2017 To Balance b/d 8,000
H
Table 2.23
ED
LE
Dr. Stationery Account Cr.
R
U
Amount Amount
IM
31-05-
-S
200 200
00
Table 2.24
8
11
The trial balance is a statement showing the balances or total of debits and credits of all the
R
accounts in the ledger, with a view to verify the arithmetical accuracy of posting to the ledger
accounts. It is an important statement in the accounting process as it shows the final position of
all accounts and helps in preparing the final statements
32
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. Totals-cum-balances method
Total Method
In this method, the total of each side in the ledger (debit and credit) is ascertained
separately and shown in the trial balance, in the respective columns. The total of the debit
column should agree with the total of the credit column as the accounts are based on the
double entry system.
Balances Method
R
Balances method is the most widely used method in practice. In this method, the trial
AI
balance is prepared by showing the balances of all ledger accounts and then totalling the
N
debit and credit columns to ensure that they are correct. The account balances are used
AN
because the balance summarises the net effect of all transactions relating to an account and
AR
helps in preparing financial statements.
H
Totals-cum-balances Method
ED
This method is a combination of the totals method and balances method. In this method,
LE
four columns are prepared for amount. Two columns are meant for the debit and credit
R
totals of various accounts and the other two are for the debit and credit balances of these
U
accounts.
IM
FF
Particulars
6
Sales — xxxx
00
Depreciation xxxx —
86
Insurance xxxx —
11
Furniture xxxx —
Purchases xxxx —
R
33
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Bills Payable — xxxx
Bad Debts xxxx —
Petty Cash in Hand xxxx —
Bank Overdraft — xxxx
Wages xxxx —
Discount (Dr.) xxxx —
Salaries xxxx —
Returns Outwards — xxxx
Total xxxx xxxx
Table 2.25
R
AI
Illustration 4: Preparation of Trial Balance
N
Example 1: From the following ledger balances extracted from the books of TIM Enterprises,
AN
prepare the Trial Balance as on 31-03-2017
AR
Particulars Amount (₹) Particulars Amount (₹)
Debtors 12,000 Purchases return 400
H
ED
Creditors 10,000 Sales return 500
Capital 15,000 Buildings 10,000
LE
Drawings 5,200 Rent paid 500
R
Table 2.26
TE
Solution:
-S
Creditors — 10,000
86
Capital — 15,000
8
Drawings 5,200 —
11
Purchases 20,000 —
Sales — 30,000
Buildings 10,000 —
Rent paid 500 —
Purchases return — 400
Sales return 500 —
Interest received — 200
Furniture 5,000 —
Total 55,600 55,600
34
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 2.27
Example 2: From the following ledger balances extracted from the books of Coffee Federation
India Ltd., prepare the Trial Balance as on 31-03-2017
Particulars Amount (₹) Particulars Amount (₹)
Opening Stock 1,250 Printing Charges 481
Sales 11800 Carriage Outwards 200
Depreciation 667 Capital 9228
Commission (Cr.) 211 Creditors 1780
R
AI
Insurance 380 Bills Payable 541
N
Carriage Inwards 300 Bad Debts 180
Furniture 670 Petty Cash in Hand 47
AN
Purchases 8679 Bank Overdraft 4000
AR
Returns Inwards 1659 Wages 1589
Bills Receivable 2730 Discount (Dr.) 328
H
ED
Debtors 1905 Salaries 750
Cash in Hand 895 Returns Outwards 1380
LE
Plant and Machinery 6230
R
Table 2.28
U
IM
FF
Solution:
TE
Sales — 11,800
00
Depreciation 667 —
86
Furniture 670 —
Purchases 8,679 —
R
35
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Bills Payable — 541
Bad Debts 180 —
Petty Cash in Hand 47 —
Bank Overdraft — 4,000
Wages 1,589 —
Discount (Dr.) 328 —
Salaries 750 —
Returns Outwards — 1,380
Total 28,940 28,940
Table 2.29
R
AI
N
2.5 Subsidiary Books & Control Accounts
AN
AR
Business transactions are first recorded in the journal and then posted to ledger accounts.
Small businesses usually record all their transactions in a single journal. In large
H
organisations, the journal is sub-divided into special journals, also known as day books or
subsidiary books.
ED
LE
A special journal facilitates division of labour in accounting work and enables you to record
R
transactions of a similar nature. Business transactions, which are repetitive in nature, can
U
be easily recorded in special journals. For example, all cash transactions may be recorded
IM
in one book, all credit sales transactions in another book, and so on. Transactions that
FF
cannot be recorded in any special journal are recorded in the journal proper.
TE
Cash book
6
Purchases book
00
Sales book
86
Journal proper
21
R
36
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2.5.1.1 Single Column Cash Book
The single column cash book records all cash transactions (receipts and payments) of a business
in chronological order. It has only one amount column on each (debit and credit) side.
The format of a Single Column Cash Book is as follows.
Dr. Cr.
R L. Amount V L. Amoun
Date Particulars No F (₹) Date Particulars No F t (₹)
R
AI
Table 2.30
N
Single column cash book consists of two sides.
AN
Debit side: The left side or the receipt side (used for recording cash receipts).
AR
Credit side: The right side or the payment side (used for recording cash payments).
H
ED
Each side is further divided into five columns. These columns contain the following information.
LE
Date column: Records the date on which cash is received or paid.
Particulars column: Records the name of the person from whom cash is received or to
R
U
Receipt Number (R. No.) column: Records the serial number of the receipt which is
issued at the time of receipt of cash.
FF
Voucher Number (V. No.) column: Records the serial number of the voucher which is
TE
Ledger Folio (L.F.) column: Records the page number of the ledger to which a particular
6
TIM Enterprises furnishes the following information regarding transactions for the month of
June, 2017. Record the transactions in Single Column Cash Book
Date Transactions
01-06-2017 Business has an opening cash balance of ₹ 50,000
02-06-2017 Received cash ₹ 30,000 from Gaganjeet
03-06-2017 Paid ₹ 3,000 towards insurance premium
04-06-2017 Purchased furniture for cash ₹ 6,000
10-06-2017 Sold goods for cash ₹ 20,000
37
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
15-06-2017 Purchased goods for cash ₹ 7,500 from Tom
30-06-2017 Deposited cash ₹ 20,000 in bank
Table 2.31
Solution:
The Transactions are recorded in the Single Column Cash Book as shown.
R L. Amount V L. Amount
Date Particulars No F (₹) Date Particulars No F (₹)
R
01-06- To balance 03-06- By Insurance
AI
2017 b/d 50,000 2017 A/c 3,000
N
To
AN
02-06- Gangajeet 04-06- By Furniture
AR
2017 A/c 30,000 2017 A/c 6,000
10-06- To Sales 15-06- By Purchase
H
2017 A/c 20,000 2017 A/c 7,500
30-06-
ED
LE
2017 By Bank A/c 20,000
30-06- By Balance
R
U
1,00,000 1,00,000
01-07- By Balance
FF
Table 2.32
-S
The left side of a cash book shows the receipts of cash, while the right side shows payments made
in cash. The accounts appearing under debit are credited as cash has been received. Thus, in the
00
above example, the entry ‘Cash received from Gaganjeet’ appears on the debit side of the cash
86
book. Therefore, Gangajeet’s account is credited by writing cash in the particulars column on the
8
credit side. Similarly, all account names appearing on the credit side of the cash book are debited
11
Consider how the transactions in the above example are posted to the related ledger accounts
R
38
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 2.33
R
01-07-
AI
2017 By Balance b/d 20,000
N
Table 2.34
AN
AR
Dr. Insurance Account Cr.
H
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹)
ED
Date Particulars J.F (₹)
LE
03-06- 30-06-
2017 To Cash A/c 3,000 2017 By Balance b/d 3,000
R
U
3,000 3,000
IM
01-07-
2017 To Balance B/d 3,000
FF
Table 2.35
TE
-S
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
00
04-06- 30-06-
86
6,000 6,000
11
01-07-
21
Table 2.36
39
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-07-
2017 To Balance B/d 7,500
Bye Table 2.37
R
20,000 20,000
AI
01-07-
N
2017 To Balance B/d 20,000
AN
Table 2.38
AR
2.5.1.2 Double Column Cash Book
H
A double column cash book contains two columns of amounts on each side of the cash book. In
ED
many organisations, as far as possible, all receipts and payments are affected through bank.
LE
Cash/cheque is deposited in a bank account by filling a form called the pay-in slip. This slip
contains a counterfoil to be returned to the customer (depositor) with the signature of the cashier
R
as receipt.
U
IM
To withdraw money, banks issue blank cheque books to account holders, Cheques are generally
crossed in practice. The payment of a crossed cheque is effected only through a bank account.
FF
As the number of bank transactions increases, a separate amount column can be maintained in the
TE
cash book to record bank transactions. Using this, you are updated on the position of the bank
-S
account from time to time. Entries of all deposits made to the bank are recorded on the left.
6
Withdrawals/payments through the bank are recorded on the right. Cash deposits and cash
00
withdrawals are recorded both in the bank column and cash column because both aspects of the
00
transaction appear in the cash book itself. The amount of cash deposited in the bank is recorded
86
in the bank column on the left. At the same time, the same amount is entered in the cash column
on the right. The reverse entries are recorded when cash is withdrawn from the bank for use in
8
11
the office. Such entries are called contra entries. In the ledger folio column, the letter C which
indicates contra is written against such entries. This ensures that these entries are not to be posted
21
The bank column and the cash column are balanced in a similar way. However, in the bank column,
there can be credit balance as an overdraft may have been availed from the bank. Overdraft
indicates a situation when cash withdrawn from the bank exceeds the deposits in the bank.
In a cash book, particulars of cheques received are entered in the bank column. If a cheque is
deposited in the bank on the day of its receipt, the amount is recorded in the bank column of the
cash book on the receipts side. If it is deposited on another day, it is treated as cash received on
the date of receipt and hence recorded in the cash column on the receipts side. It is recorded in
the bank column on the receipt (Dr.) side and in the cash column on the payment (Cr.) side on
the day of deposit to the bank. This is a contra entry.
40
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Sometimes, due to insufficient funds, the bank dishonours cheques deposited. If a cheque received
from a customer is dishonoured, then the bank returns it and debits the firm’s account. On
receiving a returned cheque or intimation from the bank, the firm makes an entry on the credit
side of the cash book by entering the amount of the cheque in the bank column. The name of the
customer is mentioned in the particulars column. This entry restores the position prevailing before
the receipt of the cheque from the customer and its deposit in the bank.
If the bank debits the firm on account of interest, commission, or other charges for bank services,
the entry is made on the credit side in the bank column. If the bank credits the firm’s account,
then the entry is made on the debit side of the cash book in the appropriate column.
R
The format of a Double Column Cash Book is as follows:
AI
R Cash Bank V Cash Bank
N
Date Particulars No L.F (₹) (₹) Date Particulars No L.F (₹) (₹)
AN
AR
Table 2.39
H
ED
Note: In double column cash book, bank column is added. LE
Illustration 6: Recording of cash and bank transactions in Double Column Cash Book.
R
TIM Enterprises furnishes the following information regarding transactions for the month of July,
U
Date Transactions
FF
01-07-2017 Business has cash balance of ₹ 25,000 and bank balance of ₹ 50,000
TE
10-07-2017 Received cheque for ₹ 10,000 towards the sales made and deposited it in bank
00
L L
Cash Bank Cash Bank
R No
V No
41
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01- To By
02-07-
07- Balance 25,000 50,000 Purchases 5,000
2017
2017 b/d A/c
05- By
To Sales 08-07-
07- 6,000 Machinery 15,000
A/c 2017
2017 A/c
10- By
07- To Sales 15-07- Purchases
2017 A/c 10,000 2017 A/c 8,000
22- By
R
07- 18-07- Stationery
AI
2017 To Bank C 4,500 2017 A/c 750
N
By Uday
AN
20-07- Shankar
2017 A/c 2,000
AR
22-07- By Cash
H
2017 A/c C 4,500
ED
23-07- By Rent
2017 A/c 3,000
LE
25-07- By Salary
R
By
IM
28-07- Drawings
FF
31-07- By Balance
2017 c/d 17,500 28,750
-S
01- To
00
08- Balance
00
Table 2.41
8
Note: Drawing Account for Personal use is not a Contra entry because cash has not been brought into office use.
11
21
R
42
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-08-
2017 By Balance c/d 16,000
Table 2.42
R
15-07-
AI
2017 To Cash 8000
N
13,000 13,000
AN
01-08-
2017 To Balance b/d 13,000
AR
Table 2.43
H
ED
LE
R
Amount Amount
IM
08-07- 31-07-
2017 To Bank 15,000 2017 By Balance b/d 15,000
TE
15,000 15,000
-S
01-08-
6
Table 2.44
00
86
Amount Amount
21
43
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
20-07- 31-07-
2017 To Bank 2,000 2017 By Balance b/d 2,000
2,000 2,000
01-08-
2017 To Balance b/d 2,000
Table 2.46
R
Dr. Rent Account Cr.
AI
Amount Amount
N
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
AN
23-07- 31-07-
AR
2017 To Bank 3,000 2017 By Balance b/d 3,000
3,000 3,000
H
01-08-
2017 To Balance b/d 3,000
ED
LE
Table 2.47
R
U
IM
25-07- 31-07-
2017 To Cash A/c 10,000 2017 By Balance b/d 10,000
-S
10,000 10,000
6
00
01-08-
2017 To Balance b/d 10,000
00
Table 2.48
8 86
11
Cr.
R
Amount Amount
Date Particulars J.F (₹) Date Particulars J.F (₹)
28-07- 31-07-
2017 To Bank A/c 1,000 2017 By Balance b/d 1,000
1,000 1,000
01-08-
2017 To Balance b/d 1,000
Table 2.49
44
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2.5.1.3 Three Column Cash Book
When we receive cash from Debtors, we allow discount to them and when we pay cash to
suppliers, we receive discount from them. To record Discount received and discount allowed
details, Three Column Cash Book is used. When we add Discount Column is added in both the
sides of Double Column Cash Book, It is called as Three Column Cash Book
The format of a Three Column Cash Book is as follows
Particulars
Particulars
Discount
N LDiscount
AReceived
Bank (₹)
Bank (₹)
Cash (₹)
Cash (₹)
Allowed
R No
IR
V No
Date
Date
F
LF
AN
Table 2.50
AR
H
ED
Illustration 7: Recording of cash and bank transactions with discount in Three Column
Cash Book.
LE
TIM Enterprises furnishes the following information regarding transactions for the month of
R
Date Transactions
TE
Received Cash from Suraj for ₹ 20,000 against the bill of ₹ 20,500 and discount
6
00
Received a Cheque from Akash for ₹ 30,000 against the bill of ₹ 31,000 and
8
Paid Cash of ₹ 20,000 to Royal Traders against the bill of ₹ 21,000 and discount
21
45
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Particulars
Particulars
Discount
Discount
Received
Bank (₹)
Bank (₹)
Cash (₹)
Cash (₹)
Allowed
R No
V No
Date
Date
L.F
LF
01- To 04- By Sun 300 10,
08- Balance 2,00 50, 08- Traders 00
2017 b/d ,000 000 2017 A/c 0
03- 500 09- By Royal 1,0 20,
08- To Suraj’s 20,0 08- Traders 00 00
2017 A/c 00 2017 A/c 0
R
05- 1,00 20-
AI
08- To Akash 0 30, 08- By Rent 3,0
N
2017 A/c 000 2017 A/c 00
AN
15- 25- 10,
AR
08- To Sales 60,0 08- 00
2017 A/c 0 2017 By Salary 0
H
30- To TT 500 31- 2,4 97,
08- Traders 20, 08-
ED
By Balance 0,0 00
LE
2017 A/c 000 2017 b/d 00 0
2,00 1,0 1,3 2,8 1,0
R
U
000 00 00 00
Table 2.52
FF
Miscellaneous expenses such as conveyance, cartage, postage, telegrams, and so on are common
-S
to every organisation. These are generally repetitive in nature and it would burden the cashier to
6
00
record all these payments in the main cash book. Further, the cash book would become very bulky.
Hence, large organisations usually appoint a petty cashier and maintain a separate cash book to
00
record such transactions. Such a cash book is called a petty cash book.
86
The petty cashier follows the Imprest system. Under this system, a definite sum, say ₹ 1500, is
8
given to the petty cashier at the beginning of a certain period. This amount is called imprest
11
amount. The petty cashier makes all small payments out of this imprest amount. When he has
21
spent a substantial portion of the imprest amount, say ₹1380, he gets a reimbursement from the
R
head cashier. Thus, he again has the full imprest amount. The reimbursement may be made on a
weekly, fortnightly, or monthly basis, depending on the frequency of small payments.
Generally, petty cash books have a number of columns for the amount on the payment side (credit)
besides the first total payment column. Each of the amount columns is allotted for items of specific
payments which are most common. The last amount column is ‘miscellaneous’. Payments for
which a separate column does not exist are recorded in the miscellaneous column. At the end of
the period, all amount columns are totalled. The total payment column shows the total amount
spent and to be reimbursed. On the receipt (debit) side, there is only one amount column. Columns
for the date, voucher number and particulars are common for both receipts and payments.
46
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2.5.3 Purchase Book
A purchase book is used to record all credit purchases of goods used in the normal course of
business. Other purchases such as the purchases of office equipment, furniture, and building are
recorded in the journal proper, if purchased on credit, or in the cash book if purchased for cash.
Invoices or bills received from suppliers of goods are the source documents to record entries in
the book. Entries are made with the net amount of the invoice. Details of the invoice such as trade
discount need not be recorded in this book
R
AI
and so on. Entries regarding the purchases return of goods are recorded in the purchases return
book.
N
AN
For every return, the trader prepares a debit note (in duplicate) to inform the supplier that his
account has been debited to the extent of the goods returned or for the allowance claimed. The
AR
original is then sent to the supplier to enable him to make the necessary entries in his book. The
source document to record entries in the purchases return journal is generally a debit note. A debit
H
ED
note contains the name of the party (to whom the goods have been returned), details of the goods
returned and the reason for returning the goods. Each debit note has a serial number and date.
LE
2.5.5 Sales Book
R
U
The sales journal is a book maintained to record all credit sales of merchandise. The format of the
IM
sales journal is similar to that of the purchases journal explained earlier. Sales invoices or bills,
issued by the firm to its customers, are the source documents to record entries in the sales journal.
FF
For each sale, two or more copies of a sales invoice are prepared. The book-keeper makes entries
TE
in the sales journal from a copy of the sales invoice. In the sales journal, one additional column
-S
may be added to record sales tax recovered from the customer and to be paid to the government
within the stipulated time. At the end of each month, the amount column is totalled and posted to
6
00
the credit of sales account in the ledger. Posting to the debit side of individual customer accounts
00
Sales return book is used to keep a record of the goods returned by customers. The trader prepares
a statement, known as credit note, when goods are taken back from the customers or an allowance
R
is granted to a customer. A credit note informs the customer that his account has been credited
for the goods returned or for the allowance granted.
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Transfer entries
Adjustment entries
Closing entries
Entries regarding dishonour of cheques
Credit purchases and sale of things other than goods
Entries of goods withdrawn by the owner for personal use
Loss of goods by fire, theft and so on
Transactions with respect to consignment and joint ventures
R
AI
2.5.8 Control Accounts
N
Control Account is also termed as Controlling Account, are accounts prepared to keep the general
AN
ledgers like Asset Account (Cash, Accounts Receivable, Inventory) nice and clean.
AR
Control Accounts are the total accounts used for checking the arithmetical accuracy of each ledger
separately; and contains the correct balances which can be used in the Financial Statements.
H
ED
Control Accounts Balance are updated for a particular period; from here the balances are
transferred to Balance Sheet and Profit & Loss account.
LE
R
U
For example; all receivables entered during one day will be accumulated from the subsidiary ledger
IM
and posted as a single summary-level number into the accounts receivable control account. Posting
FF
to all control accounts must be completed before the books are closed at the end of the reporting
TE
If anyone wants to understand the detailed transaction level information for accounts receivable,
they can get the details from subsidiary ledger, since it is not located in the general ledger.
6
00
Control accounts are most commonly used by large establishments, since their transactions are
00
very high in volume. A small business can naturally store all of its transactions in the general ledger,
86
and does not need a subsidiary ledger that is linked to a control account.
8
Note:
11
21
1) Bad debts recovered, cash purchase, cash sales and increase in provision for doubtful debts are not included in
control accounts and do not affect debtors and creditors account.
R
2) ‘Sales ledger control account’ is also known as ‘debtors control account’ and ‘purchases ledger control account’ is
called as ‘creditors control account’.
48
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Trading and Profit & Loss Account
Balance Sheet
R
together in one account or shown separately. However, the usual practice is that a single account
AI
is prepared with two sections, viz. trading account and profit and loss account.
N
AN
AR
2.6.1.1 Trading Account
A trading account merely indicates the result of buying and selling of goods, i.e. the gross profit
H
or gross loss on trading, without considering administration, selling and financial expenses
incurred in running the business.
ED
LE
The format of trading account is given below.
R
U
xx
00
account)
21
To Freight xxxx
To Octroi xxxx
49
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To Wages xxxx
To Power xxxx
R
profit transferred to
AI
profit and loss
N
account)
AN
Table 2.53
AR
Explanation of the items in the above format
Opening stock: It is the first item on the debit side of the trading account. In case of
H
manufacturing business, opening stock includes the stock of raw materials, partly finished goods,
ED
and finished goods at the beginning of the trading period. In case of trading business, it includes
LE
only the stock of finished goods at the beginning of the trading period.
R
Purchases and purchase returns: Purchases refer to finished goods purchased for resale or raw
U
materials purchased for manufacture. It includes both cash and credit purchases. Net purchases
IM
are entered in the outer column by deducting the purchase returns from the total purchases.
FF
Cartage, carriage inwards, and freight: The details of transportation charges incurred for the
TE
movement of goods are entered in these fields. They may be inwards or outwards. Carriage,
carriage inwards, and freight incurred on the goods purchased are entered on the debit side of the
-S
trading account. When these expenses are incurred on goods sold, they are entered in the profit
6
and loss account. When it is not stated whether cartage, carriage, and freight are inward or outward,
00
Import duty, Excise duty, Octroi: The import duty, excise duty, and octroi paid on the goods
86
purchased are shown on the debit side of the trading account. Such duties paid on goods sold are
8
11
entered in the profit and loss account. If there is no specification as to whether these duties are
paid on purchases or on sales, it is considered to have been paid on purchases.
21
R
Dock dues: Dock dues incurred on purchases are entered on the debit side of the trading account
and those incurred on sales are entered in the profit and loss account. If it is not stated whether
they are paid on the purchases or sales, it can be regarded as the dues paid on the purchases.
Wages: Wages incurred while manufacturing goods or making purchased goods ready for sale are
considered direct expenses and entered on the debit side of the trading account. Indirect and non-
manufacturing wages are entered in the profit and loss account. The wages, of which the nature
(direct or indirect) is not mentioned, are treated as direct wages. Certain organisations combine
wages and salaries. They treat them as direct expenses and enter the details on the debit side of the
trading account.
50
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Power, fuel, gas, water, heating, lighting, and so on: Fuel, power, gas, and oil used for running
the machines are direct expenses. Water used in the factory is also treated as a direct expense. They
are entered on the debit side of the trading account.
Heating and lighting may be for a factory or an office. Factory heating and lighting are direct
expenses and appear on the debit side of the trading account. Office heating and lighting appear
on the debit side of the profit and loss account. When it is not stated whether the heating and
lighting are for factory or office they are treated as direct expenses.
Packaging materials and charges: Packaging materials and charges incurred to make goods
ready for sale are direct expenses and entered on the debit side of the trading account. Whereas
R
such expenses incurred on the finished goods for their safe dispatch to the customer are treated
AI
as indirect expenses. They appear on the debit side of profit and loss account.
N
Other factory expenses: Other factory expenses such as factory rent, factory insurance are direct
AN
expenses. They appear on the debit side of the trading account.
AR
Sales and sales returns: Sales is the first item on the credit side of the trading account. Sales
H
include both cash and credit sales. Net sales are entered in the outer column by deducting the sales
ED
returns from the total sales. LE
Sales tax: Sales tax refers to the tax paid by a businessman to the government on the sales made
by him. It can be deducted from sales on the credit side of the trading account. Alternatively, it
R
U
can also be treated as a selling expense and entered on the debit side of the profit and loss account.
IM
Closing stock: Closing stock represents the stock of finished goods in case of a trading business.
FF
Whereas in case of a manufacturing business, it represents the stock of raw materials, partly
finished goods, and finished goods at the end of the trading period. Closing stock generally does
TE
not appear in the trial balance but it has to be calculated and brought into the books of accounts.
6 -S
00
Prepare the trading account for the year ended 31-03-2017 from the following particulars.
8 86
Purchases 60,000
R
Carriage 600
Sales 1,10,000
Sales returns 5,000
Sales tax 2,000
Factory lighting 1,000
Fuel and oil 750
Freight inwards 1,050
51
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Octroi 1,200
Import duty 1,800
Marine insurance 2,400
Dock dues 500
Wages 6,000
Water and electricity 650
Factory rent 7,500
Packing materials 1,500
R
Purchase returns 3,000
AI
Cartage 120
N
AN
Customs duty 3,000
Factory insurance 2,500
AR
Closing stock on 31.03.2009 10,500
H
Purchase Returns 3000
Table 2.54
ED
LE
Solution:
R
U
Less Purchase Return 3000 57,000 Less Sales Tax 2,000 1,03,000
6
To Octroi 1,200
11
To Wages 6,000
To Water and
650
electricity
To Factory rent 7,500
To Packing materials 1,500
To Purchase returns 3,000
To Cartage 120
To Customs duty 3,000
To Factory insurance 2,500
52
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To Gross Profit 10,930
(Transferred to Profit
& Loss Account)
1,13,500 1,13,500
Table 2.55
Illustration 9: Preparation of Trading Account
Prepare the Trading Account for the year ended 31-03-2017 from the following particulars.
R
Particulars Amount (₹)
AI
Opening stock 30,000
N
Purchases 85,000
AN
Sales 1,20,000
Octroi 2,500
AR
Cartage 600
H
Purchase returns 7,800
ED
Sales returns 12,000
Import duty 6,000
LE
Carriage inwards 3,500
R
Table 2.56
11
Solution:
21
R
53
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
(Transferred to profit
To Cartage 600
and Loss Account)
Import duty 6,000
R
Factory rent 8,000
AI
Factory insurance 2,400
N
AN
Marine insurance 1,750
AR
Customs duty 1,500
H
Water and electricity 780
1,40,990 1,40,990
IM
Table 2.57
FF
The profit and loss account helps to ascertain the net profit earned or net loss incurred during a
-S
particular period. This helps the company in monitoring and controlling the costs incurred and in
6
improving its efficiency. In other words, the profit and loss statement shows the performance of
00
54
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To Insurance xxxx By Bad debts recovered xxxx
To Printing and
xxxx By Interest on drawings xxxx
stationery
To Postage and By Net loss (Transferred
xxxx xxxx
telegrams to capital account)
To Interest paid xxxx
To Discount allowed xxxx
To Bad debts xxxx
To Repairs xxxx
To Depreciation xxxx
R
To Commission paid xxxx
AI
To Carriage outwards xxxx
N
To Travelling expenses xxxx
AN
To Interest on capital xxxx
AR
To Net profit xxxx
(Transferred to capital
H
xxxxxx
account) Xxxxxx
Table 2.58
ED
LE
Explanation of a few important items in the above format
R
Rent and taxes: Rent and taxes refers to municipal taxes and the rent paid for the office building.
FF
TE
Insurance: This refers to the premium paid for insuring buildings, machinery, stock, and so on
against risks.
-S
Office lighting and heating: This refers to lighting and heating expenses incurred in providing
6
00
Printing and stationery: This indicates the printing and stationery expenses incurred in the office.
86
Repairs and renewals: This refers to repair charges incurred for repairing the properties of the
8
business.
11
21
Depreciation: Depreciation refers to the wear and tear, i.e. the reduction in the value of an asset,
resulting out of its use.
R
Financial Expenses
55
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Discount on sales or Discount allowed: This indicates the cash discount allowed to the debtors
for the prompt payment made by them.
Interest paid: This refers to the interest paid on loans.
Interest on capital: Interest allowed to the proprietor on his capital is entered under interest on
capital.
Incomes
Non-trading incomes: It refers to all incomes other than trading incomes, such as rent received,
commission received, interest received, and so on.
R
AI
Interest on drawings: It refers to the interest charged on the amount withdrawn by the proprietor
N
from the business for his personal use. It is an income of the business and appears on the credit
AN
side of profit and loss account.
AR
Note: Personal expenses such as life insurance premium, income tax, and so on, incurred by the business owner
H
should not be included in the profit and loss account. Such expenses are treated as drawings, which has to be deducted
ED
from the capital. LE
Illustration 10: Preparation of Profit & Loss A/c
R
U
From the below given particulars, prepare the profit and loss account for the year ended 31-12-
IM
2017
FF
Salaries 25,000
-S
Advertisement 5,600
86
56
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Sundry expenses 550
Discount received 600
Commission received 1,200
Table 2.59
Solution:
Profit & Loss Account for the year ending on 31st December, 2017
Dr. Cr.
Amount Amount Amount Amount
R
Particulars Particulars
AI
(₹) (₹) (₹) (₹)
N
To Salaries 25,000 By Gross Profit 1,50,000
AN
By Commission
AR
To Rent paid 10,000 1,800
Received
H
By Interest on bank
To Office lighting 2,500 1,200
ED
deposits
To Advertisement 5,600 By Interest on drawings 250
LE
To Printing and By Rent received from
3,000 1,500
R
stationery sub-tenant
U
To Repairs and
IM
To Insurance
00
1,800
premium
86
To Travelling
21
outwards 1,850
R
57
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Gross loss 25,000
Salaries 13,500
Rent paid 5,600
Advertisement expenses 2,100
Commission received 1,950
General expenses 750
Bad debts 1,100
Printing and stationery 2,150
Repairs and renewals 900
Discount allowed 600
R
Discount received 850
AI
Carriage 300
N
Lighting and heating 1,250
AN
Trade expenses 560
AR
Insurance 2,000
Interest on investments 3,000
H
Depreciation 1,450
Commission Paid
ED 800
LE
Table 2.61
R
Solution:
U
IM
FF
Profit & Loss Account for the year ending on 31st March, 2017
TE
Dr. Cr.
-S
By Commission
To Gross Loss 25,000 1,950
00
Received
86
(Transferred from
By Discount Received 850
Trading A/c)
8
11
By Interest on
To Salaries 13,500 3,000
21
Investment
To Rent paid 5,600 By Net Loss 52,260
R
58
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To Carriage 300
To Lighting and
1,250
heating
To Trade expenses 560
To Insurance 2,000
To Depreciation 1,450
To Commission Paid 800
58,060 58,060
Table 2.62
R
2.6.2 Balance Sheet
AI
The Balance Sheet is a statement that summarises the assets and liabilities of a business. The excess
N
of assets over liabilities is the net worth of a business. The balance sheet provides information that
AN
helps in assessing:
AR
A company’s long-term financial strength and performance
H
A company’s efficiency in day-to-day working capital management
ED
A company’s asset portfolio
LE
A key element of the Profit and Loss Account, and one that distinguishes it from the Balance
Sheet, is that the amounts shown on the statement represent transactions over a period of time,
R
U
while the items represented on the balance sheet show information as on a specific date.
IM
All revenue and expense accounts are closed once the profit and loss account is prepared. The
FF
Revenue and Expenses accounts will not have an opening balance for the next accounting period
TE
-S
Assets are defined as any item of economic value owned by an individual or corporation, provided
it can be measured in terms of money. In other words, assets are the properties owned by an
00
organisation and the debts (i.e. amounts) due to an organisation from other parties. Examples are
86
cash, securities, accounts receivable, inventory, office equipment, and other properties. On a
balance sheet, assets are equal to the sum of liabilities, common stock, preferred stock, and retained
8
11
earnings.
21
From an accounting perspective, assets are divided into the following categories namely current
R
assets (cash and other liquid items), long-term assets (real estate, plant, equipment), prepaid and
deferred assets (expenditures for future costs such as insurance, rent, interest), and intangible assets
(trademarks, patents, copyrights, goodwill).
Current assets, circulating, floating or fluctuating assets: These refer to cash or other
temporary assets which can be converted into cash in a short period. Examples are cash in
hand, cash at bank, bills receivable, and other liquid items.
Liquid assets: Liquid assets are the current assets which are either in the form of cash or
can be converted into cash immediately without incurring high losses. Examples are cash
in hand, cash at bank, and sundry debtors.
59
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Investments: This refers to the amount invested by the business on government bonds,
on shares and debentures of companies for the purpose of earning interest and dividends.
Investments may be for a short-term or long-term. Short-term investments are grouped
with current assets and long-term investments are shown as a separate item.
Fixed assets: These are the assets held by a business organisation for its use, and not for
sale. These are relatively permanent in nature. Examples are buildings, furniture, and
machinery.
Wasting assets: Wasting assets are the fixed assets lost through use or exhausted.
Examples are mines and quarries.
Intangible assets: Intangible assets are the fixed assets which do not have a physical
R
existence, i.e. it cannot be seen or touched, but the possession of which yields benefit to
AI
the business or the possessor. Examples are copyright, patent, and goodwill.
N
Fictitious assets: Fictitious assets are the debit balances, i.e. expenses and losses, carried
AN
forward from one accounting period to another. These are fictitious and not represented
by any tangible or concrete property. Examples are heavy advertisement expenses not
AR
written off and preliminary expenses.
H
Format of Balance Sheet is shown below:
ED
Balance sheet as on ________________ (e.g. 31st March, 2017)
LE
Amount Amount Amount Amount
Liabilities Assets
R
2.Long Term
86
2. Long term
R
60
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Bills Receivables xxxx
Cash at Bank xxxx
Cash in Hand xxxx
xxxx xxxx
Table 2.63
Illustration 12: Preparation of Balance Sheet
Prepare the Balance Sheet as on 31-03-2017, from the below given particulars
R
Capital 60,000
AI
Drawings 3,000
N
Long term loan 40,000
AN
Sundry creditors 16,000
AR
Sundry debtors 30,000
Investments 20,000
H
ED
Bills receivable 5,000
Outstanding rent 1,500
LE
Plant and machinery 18,000
R
Goodwill 10,000
IM
Patents 5,000
FF
Solution:
11
21
61
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Bills Payable 13,000 Closing Stock 15,500
Bank Overdraft 5,000 Sundry Debtors 30,000
Outstanding Rent 1,500 Bills Receivables 5,000
Cash at Bank 10,400
Cash in Hand 5,600
1,44,500 1,44,500
Table 2.65
Illustration 13: Preparation of Balance Sheet
R
Prepare the Balance Sheet as on 31-12-2017, from the below given particulars
AI
N
Particulars Amount (₹)
AN
Capital 1,20,000
AR
Drawings 6,000
Interest on capital 7,200
H
Net loss 14,200
Building
ED 32,000
LE
Plant and machinery 16,500
Patents and trademarks 6,500
R
Goodwill 7,000
U
Solution:
62
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Less: Drawings 6,000 Good will 7,000
Add: Interest on Patents and
Capital 7,200 Trademarks 6,500
Less: Net Loss 14,200 1,07,000 Land & Buildings 32,000
2.Long Term
Liability Plant & Machinery 16,500
2. Long term
Long term loan 20,000 Investments 10,000
Long term
deposits(Cr.) 15,000 3. Current Assets
3. Current Liability Prepaid Insurance 750
R
Sundry Creditors 14,000 Closing Stock 21,000
AI
Bills Payable 6,500 Sundry Debtors 24,000
N
Bank Overdraft 8,000 Bills Receivables 18,000
AN
Cash at Bank 15,300
AR
Cash in Hand 8,700
Commission Accrued 250
H
Deposits(Cr.) 10,500
ED
LE
1,70,500 1,70,500
Table 2.67
R
U
IM
Conclusion
FF
TE
This chapter summarises the fundamentals of Accountancy, starting with the Accounting terms,
assumptions, principles, right up to the double entry system of accounting. It explains the process
-S
of recording business transactions in the Books of Original Entry/Journal, posting of the same to
6
00
the Books of Final Entry/Ledger, preparation of a Trial Balance and finally preparation of the key
financial reports like Balance Sheet and Profit & Loss Accounts to know the financial position and
00
performance of a company
8 86
Key Takeaways
11
21
Journal and ledger are the most important books in the double entry system of accounting.
Trial Balance is prepared with a view to verify the arithmetical accuracy of posting to the
R
ledger accounts.
Control Accounts are used for checking the arithmetical accuracy of each ledger separately.
Profit and loss statement shows the performance of the company in terms of profits or
losses made by it over a specified period.
Balance Sheet gives an overview of the financial position of a company as on a specific
date.
63
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Practice Exercises
1. Which of the following is the correct entry for Advance Payments made to Creditors?
a. Debit Cash/Bank A/c and Credit Creditors A/c
b. Debit Creditors A/c and Credit Cash/Bank A/c
c. Debit Creditors A/c and Credit Liabilities A/c
d. Debit Assets A/c and Credit Cash/Bank A/c
R
a. Book of Original Entry
AI
b. Book of Final Entry
N
c. Book of Fixed Entry
AN
d. Book of Complex Entry
3. Neeraj bought a vehicle on credit from Vijay. Which of the following journal entries will
AR
be made for this transaction in Neeraj's books?
H
a. Dr. Vehicle Cr. Cash
ED
b. Dr. Purchases Cr. Vijay
c. Dr. Neeraj Cr. Purchases
LE
d. Dr. Vehicle Cr. Neeraj
R
U
4. The ___________is a statement showing the balances or total of debits and credits of all
IM
b. Trial Balance
TE
c. Ratio Analysis
d. Cash Flow Statement
6 -S
a. Gain
00
b. Expense
c. Loss
86
d. Income
8
11
21
6. Given below are the three types of accounts and an example of each in a jumbled format.
R
64
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
a. True
b. False
8. There are 3 methods of preparing Trial Balance. i.e.; Totals method, Balances method,
and Totals-cum-balances method
a. True
b. False
R
AI
10. Based on his incomes and expenses Mr. Karan, a trader, prepared the following P&L
N
A/c:
AN
AR
Profit and Loss Account for the year ending 31-12-2017
Dr. Cr.
H
Particulars Amount Particulars Amount
(₹)
ED (₹)
LE
To Salaries paid 80,000 By Gross profit (transferred 2,50,000
from Trading A/c)
R
to capital A/c)
6
2,56,000 2,56,000
00
00
Based on the above Profit & Loss account, answer the following questions:
8 86
a) Salaries paid
21
b) Interest received
c) Discount received
R
d) Advertisement expenses
65
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
iii. During the year, Karan introduced ₹50,000 as additional capital into the
business. Do you think this information should be reflected in the Profit &
Loss statement?
a) Yes
b) No
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
66
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 3
Maintaining Chart of Accounts in
Tally.ERP9
R
AI
Learning Objectives
N
AN
Getting started with computerised accounting
AR
Create a company
Select and shut a company
H
Set companies chart of accounts by creating ledgers and groups
Display the company chart of accounts ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
67
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3.1 Introduction
In the previous chapters, Fundamentals of Accounting and Journalising & Posting of
Transactions, introduced you to the principles of accounting, and the entire cycle of accounting,
starting with recording of business transactions to preparing key financial statements.
This chapter will help you understand the application of accounting knowledge in a real-time
business scenario, using a computerised accounting system, Tally.ERP 9.
Maintaining accounts under the manual system of accounting is a tedious and time-consuming
R
activity. Under this system, transactions are first recorded in journals, then the entries are posted
AI
into the respective ledger accounts and then a trial balance is prepared, to verify whether, the ledger
N
summaries of all account transactions are accurate. If the totals of the debit and credit side of the
AN
trial balance are not equal, then to rectify the same, adjusting entries are passed and ledger entries
are corrected. Finally, the transactions data is used to prepare the accounting reports for each
AR
accounting period. With the increase in scale of business and volume of business transactions, the
difficulties and complexities of maintaining accounts also increases.
H
ED
Computerised accounting puts an end to the above tedious and time-consuming process. It
involves the simple cycle of one-time creation of the ledgers, followed by the recording of day-to-
LE
day transactions. The rest of the accounting process including generation of financial reports is
R
automated.
U
IM
Among accounting softwares, Tally.ERP 9 stands out for its simplicity and efficiency. It is one of
the fastest and most powerful concurrent multi-lingual Business Accounting and Inventory
FF
Management softwares available in the market. It is a fully integrated, affordable and highly reliable
TE
software. Tally.ERP 9 is easy to buy, quick to install, and easy to learn and use. Tally.ERP 9 is
-S
designed to automate and integrate all business operations, such as sales, finance, purchasing,
inventory, and manufacturing.
6
00
Let us understand how to get started with Tally.ERP 9, before moving on to recording
00
transactions.
8 86
11
21
R
68
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3.1.1 Getting Started with Tally.ERP 9
To begin working on Tally.ERP 9, double click the Tally.ERP 9 icon on your system.
Tally.ERP 9 Gateway of Tally screen appears as shown in the figure 3.1:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
The key components of the Gateway of Tally screen are as listed below:
6 -S
00
Top Horizontal Button Bar: This panel contains, Option to print, e-mail, import, and upload
data, access help, control centre, and support centre.
00
86
Close Button: This button allows you to exit the current screen. If you are at the Gateway of
Tally, clicking this button allows you to exit the application.
8
11
Vertical Button Bar: All the button options are displayed here. The buttons vary from screen to
21
screen.
R
Calculator: Mathematical calculation can be done here. Press Ctrl+N to use the Calculator
function.
Information Panel: This displays details of Product, Version, License, and Configuration
Menu: This box contains options to Select Company, Create Company etc.
69
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3.1.2 Mouse and Keyboard Conventions
While working on Tally.ERP 9, you may use the following keyboard conventions:
Mouse/Keyboard Conventions
Action Particulars
R
Fn Press the Function key
AI
N
Fn Press Alt+ Function key
AN
AR
Fn Press Ctrl + Function key
H
Table 3.1
Switching between Screen Areas ED
LE
R
When Tally.ERP 9 first loads, the Gateway of Tally screen is displayed. To switch between the
U
main screen area and calculator at the bottom of the screen, press Ctrl+N or Ctrl+M. Press
IM
Ctrl+Alt+T to navigate to Product and Features screen, press Ctrl+Alt+L to navigate to the
License and Services detail screen, press Ctrl+Alt+F to navigate to Configuration
FF
Information screen.
TE
6 -S
Quitting Tally
00
You can exit the program from any Tally screen, but Tally requires all screens to be closed before
00
it shuts down.
86
Press Esc until you see the message Quit? Yes or No. Press Y or Enter, or click on Yes
21
to quit Tally
R
Now that you are familiar with Gateway of Tally and keyboard conventions, let us use a business
scenario to illustrate the creation of a company in Tally.ERP 9, before recording business
transactions in its books of account.
70
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Business Scenario
Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd., is a dealer in computer hardware. The company maintained its accounts
manually till March 2017. In April 2017, the company installed Tally.ERP 9.
After installation of Tally.ERP 9, the company’s accountant is required to create the company,
‘Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd.’ in Tally.ERP 9. After company creation, ledgers and groups have to be
created as per the previous year’s balance sheet with their balances to record further transactions.
R
AI
N
3.2 Company Creation
AN
The first step in working with Tally.ERP 9 is to create a Company. A Company in Tally.ERP 9 is
AR
a central repository where you can maintain all the financial records of your business, and from
H
where you can extract the required financial reports and statements.
ED
The procedure to create a company is illustrated using the above business scenario.
LE
R
Tally.ERP 9
IM
The fields in the Company Creation screen and the information to be filled in each of them are
explained below.
71
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To navigate between the fields, use Enter/Tab, or Mouse clicks.
Directory: The path to the location of Tally.ERP 9 data is displayed here. By default, the
path provided while installing Tally.ERP 9 will be displayed. However, you can press
Backspace and specify the location in which you want the data to be stored.
Name: Provide a name for the company that is being created. In this example, we are
creating a company named Nidhi Sales Pvt. Ltd.
Primary Mailing Details: The mailing name and address details are picked from here for
any report such as balance sheet and statements of accounts.
R
o Mailing name: The name provided for the company in the Name field is
AI
automatically displayed here. However, you can change it as per requirements. The
N
name specified here will be used for mailing purposes.
AN
In this example, Nidhi Sales Pvt. Ltd. is retained.
o Address: Fill in the company’s address. Country: Select the country in which the
AR
company is located. This will allow users to choose the statutory capabilities
H
available for that country. In this example, the country selected is India.
ED
o State: This field appears once India is selected as the country. Select the State in
which the company is located. In this example, Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd is located in
LE
Karnataka.
R
o Fill in the relevant numbers in the Phone No., Mobile No. and Fax No fields.
IM
o E-mail: Fill in the company’s official E-mail ID here. This will be used while
FF
-S
o Financial year begins from: This refers to the twelve-month accounting period
00
of the company. For Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd, the financial year begins on 1-4-2017.
00
o Books beginning from: The date provided in the aforesaid field will be
86
automatically displayed here. In the example, the date is retained. However, if you
have started with maintaining your books of accounts with Tally.ERP 9 mid-year,
8
11
Security Control
R
o Tally Vault password (if any): Once you enter a password here, you will need it
to open your company each time. The name of a company that is locked using
Tally Vault will be hidden with the asterisk ‘*’ symbol. You need to provide the
Tally Vault password to open and access the company.
o Use security control? : Setting this option to ‘Yes’ will allow you to define the
access rights for each user who will access your company. This feature is explained
in forthcoming volumes. For Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd., we shall set this option to No.
72
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Base Currency Information:
o Base currency symbol: The base currency symbol will be filled as per the
country selected. For India, it is ₹.
o Formal name: The currency’s formal name will be filled here. In this example,
it is INR (Indian Rupees).
o Suffix symbol to amount?: For some countries, the currency symbol is
specified after the amount. This option can be enabled for such countries, so
that the currency symbol may be printed after the amount. However, Nidhi
R
Sales Pvt Ltd., is an Indian company and hence this option is set to No.
AI
o Add space between amount and symbol?: Tally.ERP 9 will provide a single
N
space between the amount and the currency symbol, if this option is set to Yes.
AN
For e.g.: ₹ 5,000. Notice the space between symbol and the amount
o Show amounts in millions?: If the company’s financial statements need to
AR
have their values expressed in terms of millions, set this option to Yes.
H
o Number of decimal places: By default, the number of decimal places for the
ED
base currency is set to 2. However, you can have up to 4 decimal places. The
Indian currency has 2 decimal places whereas certain other countries require 3
LE
decimal places and so on.
R
o No. of decimal places for amounts in words: You can specify the number
FF
of decimal places for printing the amount in words. This number should be
equal to or lesser than the number specified in Number of Decimal Places field.
TE
For example, if the currency has up to 3 decimal places, the value to be printed
-S
Note: Base currency information is set to default based on the country selected. In the above Illustration, we have
selected India so the base currency symbol is ₹.
00
86
The Company Creation screen for Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd., appears as shown in the figure 3.3
8
11
21
R
73
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 3.3 Company Creation Screen
The message Accept? Yes or No will be displayed. Press Enter or Y to save the details
After saving the Company Creation screen, The Gateway of Tally screen will appear with the
company’s name displayed on the left pane as shown in the figure 3.4:
The Gateway of Tally screen with loaded company name appears as shown in the figure 3.4:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
Activity: Create a company - Indus Enterprises by pressing Alt+F3 > Create company > with the financial
-S
year begins from 1st April, 2017 and books beginning from 1st April, 2017. You may enter company details
6
On completing the above activity, the Gateway of Tally screen with two companies loaded will
now appear as shown in the figure 3.5:
8 86
The Gateway of Tally screen with two companies loaded appears as shown in the figure 3.5
11
21
R
74
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 3.5 Gateway of Tally with the New Company — Indus Enterprises
AR
Observation: Notice that Indus Enterprises is highlighted. This indicates that it is currently the active company
H
from the list of loaded companies. To switch between the companies loaded, all you have to do is; click the name of
ED
the company or press F3 and select the company on which you want to work on.
LE
R
By shutting a company, you are essentially closing a company. To return to working on Nidhi Sales
Pvt. Ltd., let us close Indus Enterprises.
FF
To do so,
TE
2. Click Shut Company. Tally.ERP 9 displays the Close Company screen, with the List of
6
You can also use Alt + F1 from the Gateway of Tally to get to this screen
00
2. Click Select Company, or press S. Tally.ERP 9 displays the Select Company screen, with
a List of Companies that are available in the location specified.
You can also press F1 to get to the Select Company screen. Select Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd.
75
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2. Click Alter or press A.
If multiple companies are loaded on Gateway of Tally screen, then Tally.ERP 9 displays the
Select Company screen, with a List of Companies that are available in the location specified.
Select the company which you need to alter and press Enter to view the Company Alteration
screen. Alter the company details as required and accept the screen
R
AI
Once you have created a company in Tally.ERP 9, the next step would be to setup Tally.ERP 9’s
N
Features and Configurations. There are sets of options that help you optimize your usage of
AN
Tally.ERP 9.
AR
3.3.1 Company Features: F11
H
ED
Features in Tally.ERP 9 are a set of capabilities, provided as options that enable you to maintain
LE
financial records as per your business needs. The Company Features menu can be accessed by
clicking F11: Features on the vertical button bar. The effect of these options will be reflected only
R
Company Features section in Tally.ERP 9 is divided into the following major categories:
Accounting Features
FF
TE
Inventory Features
-S
TSS Features
00
Add-On Features
00
86
You can press F11 from any screen of Tally.ERP 9 or you may also click the F11: Features button
8
available in the button bar, to enable the required features. The features are specific only to the
11
company currently in use (for which the said feature is enabled), thereby allowing flexibility of
21
To view the company features screen of Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd., go to Gateway of Tally > press
F11: Company Features.
76
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 3.6 F11: Company Features menu
AR
H
There are various settings available under Accounting Features, Inventory Features and
ED
Statutory & Taxation Features, which facilitate the advance functions during voucher entry.
LE
R
Configuration in Tally.ERP 9 are options that help you modify the way a feature works. The
configuration menu can be accessed by clicking F12: Configure on the vertical button bar. The
FF
options when enabled, will have an effect on all the companies in the data directory.
TE
-S
In Tally.ERP 9, F12: Configure is provided for Accounting, Inventory and Printing options and
are user-definable as per the business requirements.
6
00
The F12: Configure is applicable to all the companies residing in the Tally.ERP 9 data directory.
00
The F12: Configure options vary depending upon the operations, i.e., if you press F12: Configure
86
from the voucher entry screen, the respective F12: Configure screen is displayed.
8
To view the company features screen of Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd., go to Gateway of Tally > click
11
F12: Configure.
21
R
77
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 3.7 F12: Configuration Menu screen
AR
There are numerous settings available under various menus in the F12: Configure screen, which
H
may be configured for any additional information required to be entered during master creations,
ED
voucher entry and printing.
LE
Now let us get back to the business scenario and see how the accountant at Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd.,
R
creates a chart of accounts, depicting the hierarchy of ledgers and groups, in Tally.ERP 9 to record
U
A Chart of Accounts is a list that describes the accounts that a business uses to record transactions
00
The purpose is to establish a framework for classifying, recording, and reporting on your business
86
transactions and to use as an aid (reference) for looking up accounts when recording transactions.
8
Without chart of accounts, a business user would find it very difficult to find a list of all his
11
accounts
21
Tally.ERP 9 automatically displays a company’s chart of accounts, based on the Ledgers and
R
3.4.1 Ledger
Ledgers are books in which the monetary transactions of a business are posted in the form of
debits and credits. Ledgers are maintained to keep a record of all the transactions pertaining to
an accounting entity.
Common ledgers that all businesses would maintain are cash, bank, debtors, creditors, expenses,
incomes. Without ledgers, it would be difficult to organize all the transactions pertaining to an
accounting entity.
78
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
In Tally.ERP 9, for a newly created company, there are two pre-defined ledgers available in
Tally.ERP 9:
1. Cash
2. Profit & Loss A/c
To view the pre-defined list of ledgers (for Nidhi Sales Pvt. Ltd.), Go to Gateway of Tally >
Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Display (Multiple Ledgers) > Select All Items.
The Multi Ledger Display screen appears as shown in the figure 3.8:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
3.4.2 Group
6 -S
Groups are collection of ledgers of the same nature. Account groups are maintained to determine
00
the hierarchy of ledger accounts which is helpful in determining and presenting meaningful and
00
compliant reports.
86
For example, in a business all their customers would be grouped as debtors. This would help them
8
in easy classification
11
21
If account groups are not created, it would be difficult to determine the accounting nature of all
the ledgers in books.
R
There are 28 pre-defined groups in Tally.ERP 9, which feature in the Chart of Accounts of many
organisations. Out of 28 pre-defined groups, 15 groups are primary groups and 13 are sub-groups.
Among the 15 primary groups, 9 groups are Balance Sheet items and the remaining 6 groups are
Profit & Loss A/c items. You can use these groups to organise the chart of accounts of your
company; you may also create and use group specific to your business transactions. You may also
alter the nomenclature of these 28 groups.
To view the list of the 28 groups, Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Groups >
79
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Display (Multiple Groups) > Select All Items.
The Multi Group Display screen appears as shown in the figure 3.9:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 3.9 Multi Group Display screen
R
U
IM
Out of the 15 Primary Groups, the following groups appears in Profit & Loss Account:
1. Sales Accounts
FF
2. Purchase Accounts
TE
Since Tally.ERP 9 has only two default ledgers, i.e., Cash and Profit & Loss A/c, creation of
ledgers is necessary for recording transactions that involve other accounts.
21
To understand the process of ledger creation, let us create the necessary ledgers for Nidhi Sales
R
Pvt. Ltd., based on the Balance Sheet provided in the illustration given in table 3.2
Illustration 2: Creation of ledgers using single and multiple ledger creation and entering
opening balance in ledgers.
80
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Capital Reserve 1,25,000 Land and Buildings 4,58,950
General Reserve 1,25,000 Manufacturing Equipment 6,86,650
Proprietors Capital 10,12,000 Plant and Machinery 7,85,320
Account
Loans (Liability) Investments
Secured Loan 5% Debenture of AG 86,450
Com
Loan From Axis Bank 12,75,000 Bonds to SBI 86,450
Current Liabilities Current Assets
Sundry Creditors Closing Stock --
Computer Care 35,450 Sundry Debtors
R
Systems
AI
Horizon Enterprises 15,420 Debtors - South
N
Silver Plus Computers 50,870 Supreme Computers 35,650
AN
Profit & Loss Account 10,12,000 Debtors – North
Data Link Technologies 56,980
AR
Spectrum Computers 75,840
Total 36,50,740 Total 36,50,740
H
Table 3.2
ED
LE
R
U
The debtors of the company are classified into the following four Groups:
IM
Debtors - North
FF
Debtors - South
TE
Debtors – East
Debtors – West
6 -S
00
For illustration purpose, let us create two ledgers based on the details given in the balance sheet
00
of Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd. The ledgers to be created, the opening balance for each and the groups
under the ledgers are to be classified are specified in table 3.3:
8 86
Table 3.3
In Tally.ERP 9, ledgers can be created in two ways;
81
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2. Enter Name as Proprietor’s Capital Account
3. Select Capital Account from the List of Groups
4. Enter ₹ 10,12,000 Cr. in the Opening Balance (1-Apr-2017) field
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
Similarly, to create the Land & Building ledger using single ledger creation option,
TE
82
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 3.11 Ledger Creation screen — Land & Buildings
H
5. Accept the screen ED
LE
R
Note: Tally.ERP 9 displays the total debit and credit opening balances along with the difference in opening balance,
U
while the ledgers are being created in the Ledger Creation screen. This helps in knowing the difference amount.
IM
“This shows for each debit there should be a corresponding credit, if not in Tally. ERP 9, you will
FF
Now let us create the following ledgers using the Multi Ledger Creation option
6
00
Table 3.4
21
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create (Multiple Ledgers)
The Accounts Info Ledger Menu screen appears as shown in the figure 3.12
83
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 3.12 Accounts Info Ledger Menu screen
AR
2. Press Enter on Multiple Ledgers Create
H
3. In the Under Group field select All Items
ED
4. Enter Loan From Axis Bank in the Name of Ledger field under group Secured Loans from
the List of Groups.
LE
5. Provide Opening Balance ₹12,75,000 Cr
R
6. Press Enter
U
7. Similarly create a ledger as 5% Debenture of AG Com under group Investments and provide
IM
Note: If you select Investments in the ‘Under Group’ field, then the ledger will be created under the Investment
TE
head.
-S
The Multi Ledger Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 3.13:
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
84
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8. Accept the screen
Now that we have learnt how to create ledgers under Tally.ERP 9’s default pre-defined Groups,
let us move on to understand how to make alterations to ledgers that are already created.
R
options.
AI
N
3.5.3.1 Ledger Alteration
AN
Illustration 3: Alteration of Ledgers
AR
In the books of Nidhi Sales Pvt. Ltd. alter the ledger named Loan form Axis Bank to Loan
from IDBI Bank.
H
ED
To change the ledger name from Loan form Axis Bank to Loan from IDBI Bank, follow the
steps given below:
LE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers
R
4. Change the Name from Loan from Axis Bank to Loan from IDBI Bank
FF
The single Ledger Alteration screen appears as shown in the figure 3.14
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
85
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
If you use Display in Single Ledger now, you will see that the list of ledgers shows Loan from
IDBI Bank instead of Loan from Axis Bank.
You can also Alter ledgers from Gateway of Tally >Accounts Info > Ledgers > Alter
(Multiple Ledgers) option.
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers > Under Single Ledger > Select
AI
Display
N
2. Select SBI Bonds
AN
The single Ledger Display screen appears as shown in the figure 3.15
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
To view groups in multi display mode, follow the steps given below:
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers > Under Multi Ledgers > Select
Display
2. Select All Items
The multi Group Display screen appears as shown in the figure 3.16
86
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 3.16 Multiple Ledgers Display screen
H
ED
LE
R
U
To delete a ledger that has no transactions entered, follow the given path:
FF
1. From Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Under Single Ledger> Select
TE
The Ledger Alteration screen with delete message appears as shown in the figure 3.17
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
87
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2. Accept the screen
R
AI
Illustration 4: Creation of groups using single and multiple group creation option.
N
Let us illustrate creation of Groups by creating the Debtor Groups of Nidhi Sales Pvt. Ltd.
AN
3.6.1 Single Group Creation
AR
To create a Group in the books of Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd., with the details given in the table 3.5,
H
using the Single Group Creation option.
ED
LE
Group to be Created Classification
R
U
Table 3.5
FF
3. In the Under field, select Sundry Debtors from the List of Groups
-S
88
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note
o We have created Debtors – North under the group Sundry Debtors. This means that the group
Debtors – North is a sub group of Sundry Debtors.
o If it is a new primary group, select Primary (requirement of a new primary group is very rare,
but the option exists).
o Creation of a new Primary Group will not be allowed if the option Provide advanced
information in master is set to No in F12: Configure. You can also create a new Parent Group
by using ALT+C.
4. Group Behaves like a Sub ledger – If this option is set to No, the screen will display all
R
AI
the Ledgers grouped under the Group in detailed mode.
5. Nett Debit/Credit Balances for Reporting – Set this option to Yes to display either the
N
net debit or credit balance in the report (whichever is higher). If this is set to No, both debit
AN
and credit balances will be displayed in the report.
AR
6. Used for Calculation (for example: taxes, discounts) - Set this option to Yes if ledgers
under this group have percentages for discounts/taxes to be used in invoice entry.
H
7. Method to allocate when used in purchase invoice - Select the appropriate allocation
ED
method from the list. This is used to allocate the expense of the Item in the ratio of the
LE
quantity or value.
8. Accept the screen
R
U
IM
Tally.ERP 9 allows you to create any number of groups under all the default groups. One sub-
FF
group viz. Debtors - North has now been created under Sundry Debtors.
TE
-S
To create multiple Groups at a time as given in the table 3.6, using the Multiple Group
Creation option
00
86
Table 3.6
To create multiple group at one time, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Groups > Under Multiple Groups >
Create
2. In the Under Group field select Sundry Debtors (by selecting the group as sundry
debtors, all groups which you create now will automatically fall under the same group i.e.,
Sundry Debtors)
89
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: If you select All Items in the Under Group field, then you will be able to create different account groups,
whose nature are different
3. Under Name of Group enter the name as Debtors-South the Under field will get
captured as Sundry Debtors. (Because we have selected the under group as sundry
debtors).
4. Repeat the process for the other groups (Debtors-East and Debtors-West)
The Multi Group Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 3.19:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
Activity: Create the following ledgers using the Multiple Ledger Creation menu.
8
11
90
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
balance)
Capital Reserve Reserve & Surplus 1,25,000 Cr
General Reserve Reserve & Surplus 1,25,000 Cr
Computer Care System Sundry Creditors 35,450 Cr
Horizon Enterprises Sundry Creditors 15,420 Cr
Silver Plus Computers Sundry Creditors 50,870 Cr
Plant & Machinery Fixed Assets 7,85,320 Dr
Furniture & Fixture Fixed Assets 2,75,450 Dr
Manufacturing Equipment Fixed Assets 6,86,650 Dr
R
SBI Bonds Investments 86,450 Dr
AI
Closing Stock Stock In Hand 3,28,580 Dr
N
Cash Cash In Hand 4,58,000 Dr
AN
(Do not create the ledger because it is already
AR
available, alter the ledger and provide the
opening balance)
H
ED
Kotak Bank A/C Bank Account LE 6,45,000 Dr
Table 3.7
R
Note: After completing the above activity, go to Gateway of Tally > Balance Sheet > Press Alt+F1
U
Check whether your Balance Sheet matches with the screen shot of Balance Sheet given in the
FF
figure 3.20
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
91
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
If the same option Integrate accounts and inventory is set to No, then the Closing Stock
amount ₹ 3, 28,580 given as opening balance appears under Current Assets group.
R
You can alter the Groups in Single mode or multiple mode by selecting Alter from the menu to
AI
change any information. You can change the Name of any reserved group, but its characteristics
N
will remain the same.
AN
Illustration 5: Alteration of Groups
AR
In the books of Nidhi Sales Pvt. Ltd. alter the group named Debtors-North to Debtors-North
H
East
To change the ledger name from Debtors-North to Debtors-North East, follow the steps
ED
LE
given below:
R
The single Group Alteration screen appears as shown in the figure 3.21
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
92
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Accept the screen
If you use Display in Single Group now, you will see that the list of groups shows Debtors-
North East instead of Debtors-North.
Activity: Alter the ledger Debtors-North East to Debtors-North and save.
You can also Alter ledgers from Gateway of Tally >Accounts Info > Ledgers > Alter
(Multiple Ledgers) option
R
3.6.3.2 Single Group Display
AI
To view groups in single display mode, follow the steps given below:
N
AN
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Groups > Under Single Group > Select
Display
AR
2. Select Bank Accounts
H
The single Group Display screen appears as shown in the figure 3.22
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
93
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 3.23 Multi Group Display screen
H
3.6.4 Deleting Groups ED
LE
You can delete a group via the Group Alteration (Single Mode) screen by pressing Alt+D.
R
U
Note:
IM
o Groups and Ledgers cannot be deleted from the Multi Alteration screen. Hence to delete ledgers
FF
and groups, use the Single Alteration Menu
TE
To understand the process of deletion of a Group, first let us first create a Group in Nidhi Sales
00
Pvt Ltd.
00
Activity: Create a Group called Equipment under the Fixed Assets head.
86
Now to delete the newly created group called Equipment, follow the steps given below:
8
11
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Groups > Under Single Group > Select
21
The Group Alteration screen with delete message appears as shown in the figure 3.24
94
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 3.24 Group Alteration screen (Deletion)
H
2. Accept the screen
ED
LE
R
Conclusion
U
IM
This introductory chapter on maintaining chart of accounts in Tally.ERP 9, shows you how simple
FF
it is to create a company and chart of accounts in Tally. This intuitive software comes with 28
predefined Groups and 2 predefined ledgers. Creating ledgers and displaying groups and ledgers
TE
Key Takeaways
6
00
Chart of Accounts is the listing of ledger accounts of an organisation. It differs from one
00
organisation to another.
86
Ledgers need to be classified under groups, and there is no limit to the levels of hierarchy
21
Shortcut Keys
Shortcut Key Description
95
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Alt+D From single ledger alteration screen.
To delete the ledger.
Ctrl+L From group creation screen
To navigate to ledger creation.
Ctrl+G From ledger creation screen
To navigate to group creation
Alt+Z From multi ledger alteration screen.
To remove all the opening balances at one go.
R
Practice Exercises
AI
N
AN
1. Based on the business scenario (Nidhi Sales Pvt Ltd.) discussed in the above chapter,
answer the following question: You cannot delete which of the following groups in Tally.ERP
AR
9?
H
a) Debtors – North
ED
b) Creditors – South
c) Fixed Assets
LE
d) Bills – Telephone & Internet
R
U
IM
a) Chart of Accounts
TE
b) Ledgers
c) Groups
-S
d) List of Ledgers
6
00
00
3. For a company where no ledgers have been created, there are two pre-defined ledgers
86
b) Bank Account
c) Fright Charge Account
21
d) Discount Account
R
4. Which of following ledgers falls under the Current Liability head?
a) Land & Building
b) Goodwill
c) Stationery Expense
d) Payables
5. Which of the following is the first step in recording a business transaction, after Tally.ERP
9 is installed?
a) Company creation
96
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
b) Group creation
c) Ledger creation
d) Transaction recording in journal
R
AI
a. 1-a, 2-b, 3-c, 4-d
N
b. 1-d, 2-b, 3-c, 4-a
AN
c. 1-b, 2-c, 3-d, 4-a
d. 1-a, 2-d, 3-b, 4-b
AR
H
7. Which group will you select for the ledger shown in the figure 3.25?
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
a) Indirect Expenses
21
b) Current liability
R
c) Bank Account
d) Fixed Assets
9. I can delete ledgers and groups from the Multi Alteration Menu in Tally.ERP 9.
a) True
97
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
b) False
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
98
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 4
Fundamentals of
Inventory Management
Learning Objectives
R
AI
N
Meaning of inventory
AN
Understanding of inventory management
Terms used in inventory management
AR
Understanding of different types of inventory valuation
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
99
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4.1 Introduction
Inventory is an asset that is intended to be sold or consumed to produce finished products in the
ordinary course of business. Inventory may not be immediately ready for sale.
In accounting, inventory is typically broken down into three stages, which are:
R
Finished goods: Includes goods ready for sale to customers. May be termed merchandise
AI
in a retail environment where items are bought from suppliers in a state ready for sale.
N
AN
4.2 Inventory Management
AR
Inventory Management is the process of keeping the track of goods from manufacturing till it
reaches point of sale and also it involves keeping track of new and returned from entering to exist.
H
Hence inventory management is very crucial process for a business.
Stock Item: It is the physical stock that is kept in the godown or store for sale and it can be
measured in quantity. When we purchase stock item the quantity of stock item increases and while
FF
Godown: It is the place/location/warehouse/rack where the stock items or goods are stored.
-S
SKU: SKU stands for Stock Keeping Units, it is the unique code assigned to a product or services
6
Safety Stock: It is also called as buffer stock, it is the stock that is kept by business in order to
00
Reorder Level: It is the inventory level at which the company has to place an order for the stock
item. The importance of a reorder level arises from the need to have sufficient stocks to service
21
customer orders and at the same time not to have unnecessarily high stocks.
R
Price List: It is a list of items maintained by an organisation along with their price details. It is
generally used by organisations which deal in multiple products.
Price Lists are maintained in various structures for different types of buyers (customers), viz.,
Wholesalers, Dealers, Retailers, etc. It is structured based on the classification of buyers and is
referred to at the time of making sales.
Manufacture & Expiry Date: Manufacture date is the date on which the goods are produced.
Expiry date is the date on which the goods are expired, this mean that goods are not in a good
condition to be consumed. Manufacture & Expiry dates will be available in perishable goods like
food, medicines etc.
100
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Dead Stock: It is a stock which is not sold and lying in godown from long time.
R
AI
situation and financial goals of the business organisation.
N
The cost of goods sold is largely based on the cost assigned to closing stock (Ending inventory).
AN
Cost of goods sold = Opening stock (Beginning Inventory) + Purchases made during the
AR
reporting period – Closing Stock (Ending Inventory)
H
Note: Similarly, Gross Profit = Net sales – Cost of goods sold
ED
There are different types of stock valuation methods available for calculating the recorded value
LE
of closing stock (ending inventory).
R
Following are the different types of inventory valuation used by many businesses based on their
situation and financial goals of the business.
FF
There are different types of stock valuation methods that can be used for accurate stock valuations
TE
3. FIFO Perpetual
4. LIFO Annual (Last-in, First-Out)
8
11
5. LIFO Perpetual
6. HIFO (Highest In, First Out)
21
8. Standard Cost
Let us check in detail explanation of different stock valuation methods.
1. Average Cost Method: It is also called as weighted average cost method, in this method
the stock is valued based on the formula given below:
Average Cost = Total Inward Value for the year/ Total Inward Quantity for the year
In case of Monthly Average Cost Method, the weighted average cost is determined on a
monthly basis instead of annual
101
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2. FIFO (First In First Out): Under FIFO Periodic System, it is assumed that items
purchased first are sold first under the current financial year (i.e., first lot from the opening
stock of current year).
In case of Perpetual FIFO Method, it is assumed that items purchased first are sold first
across the financial year (i.e., first lot may be from previous year entry).
Hence cost of goods sold is based upon the cost of material received first in the period,
while the cost of inventory is based upon the cost of material received last in the period.
This method is adopted by the business, when the cost of the items are decreasing
(deflation) and this will result in lower taxable income.
R
3. LIFO (Last In First Out): Under LIFO Periodic System, it is assumed that items
AI
purchased last are sold first under the current financial year (i.e., first lot from the opening
N
stock of current year)
AN
In case of Perpetual LIFO Method, it is assumed that items purchased last are sold first
across the financial year (i.e., first lot may be from previous year entry).
AR
Hence cost of goods sold is based upon the cost of materials received last in the period,
H
while the cost of inventory is based upon the cost of material received first in the period.
ED
This method is adopted by the business when the cost of the items are increasing
(Inflation) and this will result in lower taxable income.
LE
R
4. HIFO (Highest In First Out): Under HIFO, the items purchased with the highest cost
U
is sold first or removed first. This method is followed by the company who wants to
IM
5. Last Purchase Cost: Last purchase cost is Last purchase rate. Cost of goods sold and
TE
6. Standard Cost: In this method a standard cost is fixed for all the goods available within
00
the business. This method is used when it becomes hectic and time consuming to collect
00
actual costs of goods, hence standard costs are used and this cost will be approximately
close to actual cost.
8 86
11
Note: FIFO is not restricted by GAAP (Generally Accepted Accounting Principles) & IFRS International
21
Financial Reporting Standards) but LIFO is restricted by IFRS (accounting standards. In many countries
R
102
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Stock Group: It is a group where stock items with same nature/characteristics are
grouped under one head called as stock group. For example Television is a stock
group and under this group we can add stock items like LG Television, Videocon
Television, and Philip Television etc. here the brand are different but characteristic
(i.e. Television) is same. So in this case we can create a stock group by name Television.
Stock Item: It is the inventory of the business which are manufactured or traded. It
is the primary inventory entity and is the lowest level of information on your inventory.
In Tally.ERP 9, one must create the inventory in order to keep the track of the same.
For example we create stock items like LG Television, Videocon Television etc.
R
AI
N
Units of Measure: Stock items are measured in units, in Tally.ERP 9, we can create
simple units like Nos, Kg, Pcs etc. and compound units like Box of 12 Nos, Doz of
AN
12 Nos etc.
AR
Godown: It is the location where stock items/goods are stored, few example of
H
godowns are storehouse, warehouse and rack etc.,
ED
2. Batch Wise Details: Batch details are used to identify the movement of inventory in
LE
batches or lots. Although this is a requirement primarily of the pharmaceutical industry,
R
the same can be used by other industries that maintain or manufacture perishable goods.
U
We can define the manufacturing and expiry dates for stock item along with batch details.
IM
FF
3. Price List & Levels: A Price List refers to a list of items maintained by an organisation
along with their price details. It is generally used by organisations which deal in multiple
TE
products. Price Lists are maintained in various structures for different types of buyers
-S
you to create any number of price lists & price levels, based on the Stock Group and Stock
Category to match the required structure.
00
86
4. Point of Sales (POS): Point of Sale or POS can be a retail outlet, a checkout counter in a
8
shop, or any other location where a sale transaction takes place. POS system is a
11
computerised cash register which adds up the sales totals, calculates the balance to be
21
returned to the buyer and automatically adjusts the inventory levels to reflect the quantity
sold. The equipment required for POS to work effectively are cash registers, card readers,
R
5. Tracking of Item wise cost Details: In Tally.ERP 9, we can effectively track and
ascertain the procurement cost, landing costs, manufacturing or production cost, order
cost/profit and job cost/profit. This feature is also useful in determining the sales price of
finished goods based on the costs incurred till date and the overall profitability.
6. Order Processing: In Tally.ERP 9, we can keep the track of purchase order processing
and sales order processing. We can maintain the details of inventory which are rejected or
103
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
returned. It also gives us the facility to cancel the unwanted or rejected orders & check the
outstanding reports.
7. Job order processing: In Tally.ERP 9, we can maintain the details of work which is
outsourced. We can keep the track of inventory which is sent out, inventory which is
received and inventory which is yet to be received.
8. Stock Categories: In Tally.ERP 9, we can give a parallel allocation to the stock item by
maintaining stock category details for example if we create stock group as Television, then
parallel grouping in inch (21 inch, 22 inch) can be given to Television. This will lead us to
generate different inventory reports like availability of total Television, availability of total
R
21 inch television.
AI
N
9. Costing Methods: The choice of stock valuation methods depends on a number of
AN
variables, like the business situation and financial goals of the business organisation. In
Tally.ERP 9, one can explore the following costing method for stock valuation as per
AR
business requirement.
H
At Zero Cost
ED
Average Cost
FIFO
LE
FIFO Perpetual
R
LIFO Annual
IM
LIFO Perpetual
FF
Standard Cost
-S
10. Bill of Materials (BoM): Automatic listing of components while manufacturing a finished
6
product is possible through Bill of Materials feature provided in Tally.ERP 9. Apart from
00
auto listing, we can add the manufacturing cost like labour change, packing charge etc., to
00
finished goods.
86
Apart from BoM, we can also maintain or record the complete manufacturing process
details using manufacturing journal voucher. While recording manufacturing process entry
8
11
we can keep the track of by-products and co-products along with scrap details.
21
11. Inventory Vouchers: We come across different inventory transactions in our day to day
R
business activities like purchase of raw materials, manufacturing of goods, sale of goods,
rejection of goods, transfer of goods etc. All these transactions can be recorded in
predefined inventory vouchers available in Tally.ERP 9.
12. Inventory Reports: In Tally.ERP 9, we can instantly generate inventory reports like stock
summary, physical stock register, transfer analysis, ageing analysis, stock query, batch wise
details etc., with ease. Once the inventory related transactions are recorded in Tally.ERP
9, the reports will get updated instantly.
Note: We have the flexibility to maintain our books of accounts with Accounts with Inventory details as
well as Accounts only details in Tally.ERP 9.
104
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Conclusion
In this chapter, we have learnt the importance of setting inventory mechanism for any organisation,
understood the different types of inventory valuation and learnt about different inventory features
like inventory master, batch wise details, price level and price list and bill of materials etc., which
helps in setting strong inventory foothold in an organisation.
Practice Exercise
1. ________________ = Opening stock (Beginning Inventory) + Purchases made during
the reporting period – Closing Stock (Ending Inventory).
R
a. Cost of goods sold
AI
b. Cost of goods manufactured
N
c. Cost of goods purchased
AN
d. Cost of goods transferred
AR
2. FIFO Stands for__________________.
H
a. First Out First In
ED
b. Fast In Fast Out
c. Last In First Out
LE
d. First In First Out
R
U
4. When the cost of goods are increasing __________valuation method is recommended and
6
a. LIFO
00
b. FIFO
c. Zero Cost
86
d. Purchase Cost
8
11
5. In ________________ method, a fixed cost is used for all the goods available within the
21
business.
R
a. Purchase Cost
b. Market Cost
c. LIFO
d. Standard Cost
105
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
7. Dead Stock is the stock which is __________________.
a. Fast moving stock
b. Unsold stock from long time
c. Stock in high demand
d. Stock yet to be produced
8. A Price List refers to a list of items maintained by an organisation along with their price
details.
a. True
b. False
R
9. LIFO stands for Last In Last Out
AI
a. True
N
b. False
AN
10. Match the following feature with their respective function:
AR
a LIFO 1 Can define Expiry and Manufacturing
H
details
ED
b Batch wise details 2 Stock valuation method
c Bill of materials 3 Outsourcing
LE
d Job order processing 4 Auto listing of components
R
106
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 5
Stock Keeping Units
Learning Objectives
Creation stock groups
Creation of units of measure
R
Creation of stock items
AI
Creation of godowns
N
Defining stock opening balance
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
107
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5.1 Introduction
Inventory is an asset that is intended to be sold in the ordinary course of business. Inventory may
not be immediately ready for sale.
In accounting, inventory is determined into three categories, which are:
R
Finished goods: Includes goods ready for sale to customers. May be termed merchandise
AI
in a retail environment where items are bought from suppliers in a state ready for sale.
N
In Tally.ERP 9 the inventory details are maintained same way as followed in accounting system.
AN
In Tally.ERP 9, inventories can be classified by ‘Stock Groups’ and ‘Stock Categories’ are used,
AR
and ‘Stock Items’.
H
5.2 Inventory Masters in Tally ERP 9
ED
LE
Stock Group
R
A Stock Group is similar to the groups created for accounting in Tally.ERP 9. Stock Items of
U
similar nature, brand, etc. can be classified under a single stock group. For example, the Stock
IM
Group for ‘Television’ can be the brand, like ‘Sony’, ‘Videocon’, ‘Philips’, etc.
FF
Units of Measure
TE
Stock items are purchased and sold on the basis of quantity. The quantity in turn is measured by
-S
units. In Tally.ERP 9, such goods are quantified using ‘Units of Measurement’. Units of measure
are of two types:
6
00
Simple Units of Measure: are Numbers, Metres, Kilograms, Box and Pieces etc.
00
Compound Units of Measure: A Compound Unit is a combination of two simple units. Example:
86
1 Box = 12 Pieces.
8
11
Stock Item
21
Stock Item refers to goods that is manufactured or traded or can be component or by-product. It
R
is the primary inventory entity and is the lowest level of information on your inventory. We have
to create a stock item in Tally.ERP 9 for each inventory item that you want to account for.
Godowns/Locations
A place where stock items are stored is referred to as a ‘Godown’. For example, a warehouse. You
can obtain stock reports for each godown and account for the movement of stock between
Locations/Godowns.
Stock Category
108
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Stock Category offers a parallel classification of stock items. Like stock groups, classification is
done based on similarity in behaviour.
The advantage of categorizing items is that you can classify the stock items (based on functionality)
together – across different stock groups which enables you to obtain reports on alternatives or
substitutes for a stock item.
To illustrate the creation of inventory masters in Tally.ERP 9, let us use the following business
scenario:
Business Scenario
R
AI
Surya Mobiles, Karnataka, are into wholesale and retail business. They deal in different mobile
N
brands, within each brand, their stock includes mobile phones with different features. Surya
AN
Mobiles has demo mobiles of each brand for promoting sales.
The company has branches located in different parts of the country. They also have store-houses
AR
to store stocks in key cities like Bengaluru and Delhi.
H
ED
The stocks are sold in numbers or dozens based on the type of sales, i.e., retails or wholesale. Surya
Mobiles installed Tally.ERP 9 in 2017 to maintain their accounts, and to help them make quick
LE
decisions regarding stock movement.
R
Help the accountant at Surya Mobiles create the Inventory Chart of Accounts.
U
IM
Let us now understand the process of creating required inventory masters by using the information
TE
given in the following illustrations, which are based on the above Business Scenario of Surya
-S
Mobiles.
6
Activity: In order to set up inventory details in Tally.ERP 9, create the following company.
00
00
Country: India
21
State; Karnataka
R
109
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5.3.1 Creation of Stock Group
Let us start the illustration of creation of inventory masters with the creation of stock group and
sub stock groups for Surya Mobiles.
Illustration 1: Creation of stock groups, sub stock groups using single stock group and
multiple stock group creation method.
Surya Mobiles deals in mobile phones of the following 3 brands:
R
Apple iPhone
AI
N
Based on the above information, the stock groups that have to be created are:
AN
Main Stock Group and Sub Stock Group
Main Stock Group (Grouped Under Primary) Sub Stock Group
AR
Mobile Phone Samsung Mobile Phone
H
Mobile Phone Sony Mobile Phone
Mobile Phone Apple iPhone
ED
LE
Table 5.1
R
It can be seen from the above table the grouping structure in Tally.ERP 9 is as follows:
U
IM
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Groups > Under Single Stock
00
Mobile Phone
11
110
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Group Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 5.1:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.1 Stock Group Creation - Mobile Phone
H
2. Accept the screen ED
LE
Note: You can delete a Stock Group by pressing Alt+D, option from Gateway of Tally > Inventory
R
U
Info. >Stock Groups > Under Single Stock Group > Select Alter. The Stock Group will get deleted if
IM
the same is not used anywhere i.e., if sub stock groups or stock items are created, then the stock group cannot be
deleted until and unless the sub stock group and items are deleted.
FF
TE
Table 5.3
R
The Sub-Stock Group Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 5.2:
111
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.2 Sub-Stock Group Creation - Sony Mobile Phone
Accept the screen
H
ED
Step 3: Creating Sub Stock Groups using the Multiple Stock Group Creation method LE
To create the remaining sub stock groups like Samsung and iPhone Mobile Phones at one go, use
the Multiple Stock Group Creation method, follow the steps given below:
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Groups > Under Multiple Stock
U
IM
3. Under Name of Stock Group, enter the name as Samsung Mobile Phone
TE
The Multiple Stock Groups Creation screen is shown in the figure 5.3:
00
8 86
11
21
R
112
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 5.3 Multiple Stock Group Creation screen
Observation: Once after creating the stock groups check whether all the stock groups are created as per the
requirement. To check, go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Groups > Under Multiple
Stock Groups > Select Display > Select All Items from the List of Stock Groups. In Multiple
Stock Group Display screen, we will get the details of all the stock groups created in the company.
R
AI
of measure.
N
Illustration 2: Creation of simple and compound units of measure.
AN
The stocks of Surya Mobiles are sold in numbers or dozens based on the type of sales, i.e., retail
AR
or wholesale.
H
Based on this information, the units of measure to create are:
Dozens
U
Dozen of 12 Numbers
Table 5.4
FF
TE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Units of Measure > Create
6
Numbers
00
00
113
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.4 Simple Unit of Measure Creation -
Nos
H
2. Accept the screen
Activity: Create a Simple unit of Measure, ED
LE
Doz (Dozen)
R
U
IM
Note: We can delete the Units of Measure by using the key Alt+D from the Unit Alteration screen.
However, you cannot delete the same if the Units of Measure are defined in stock item or used in creating compound
FF
nits.
TE
From Unit creation screen, Press Backspace to move to the Type field, and select Compound
00
00
Numbers
86
Conversion Enter as 12
Second Unit Select as Numbers
Table 5.6
The Compound Unit Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 5.5:
114
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.5 Compound Unit Creation screen
H
Accept the screen
ED
LE
5.3.3 Creation of Stock Item
R
Illustration 3: Creation of stock items using single stock item and multiple stock item
FF
creation methods, and generating statistics report to check the chart of inventory.
TE
The given table 5.7 shows the list of products within each mobile brand that Surya Mobiles deals
in and the corresponding unit of measure details are given in table 5.8.
6 -S
Table 5.7
R
Based on the information given in the scenario, the Stock Item structure in Tally.ERP 9 can be
defined as follows (table 5.8):
115
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Single Stock Item Creation Method
To Create Single Stock Item, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Items > Under Single Stock
Item > Select Create
Note: In Stock Item Configuration (F12: Configure) screen, set the option Allow advanced
entries in Masters to Yes (By enabling this option, we can define the required Costing Method).
Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
Against the Field Action to be Performed
R
AI
Name Enter as Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
N
Under Select as Samsung Mobile Phone
AN
Units Select as Nos
AR
Opening Balance leave it Blank.
H
Table 5.9
The Stock Item Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 5.6 ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
Note: In the figure 5.6, Avg. Cost is the default costing method selected in Tally.ERP 9. If required we can define
the required costing method like FIFO, LIFO, Standard Cost etc.
2. Accept the screen
Note: You can delete the stock item by using the key Alt+D from the stock item alteration screen. However, you
cannot delete the stock item, if the same is used in recording any transaction.
116
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Let us create the following Stock items at one go using Multiple Stock Items creation option
R
Items > Select Create > Under Group >Select as All Items > Press Enter
AI
2. Select the stock items to be created one by one as shown in the figure 5.7:
N
AN
The Multi Stock Items Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 5.7:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
After the stock items are created, the same can be seen in the Statistics Report in Tally.ERP 9.
8
117
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.8 Statistics Report
H
The Statistics report displays the count of accounts created in Tally.ERP 9. To check the
ED
LE
details within each menu item, select particular required field and press enter. i.e., select Stock
Items field and press enter.
R
The List of Accounts or Chart of Inventory screen appears as shown in the figure 5.9:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
118
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Phone).
R
Godowns
AI
Bengaluru Location
N
Delhi Location
AN
Table 5.11
AR
To Create Godowns in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
H
ED
Step 1: Configuration of Godown in Tally.ERP 9 LE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > F11: Company Features > F2: Inventory Features
2. Enable the option Maintain multiple Godowns to Yes
R
U
Note: Option Maintain multiple Godowns is enabled in order to create the required Godowns
IM
The Inventory Features screen with the options enabled, appears as shown in the figure 5.10:
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
119
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 2: Creation of Godowns
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Godowns > Create
Bengaluru Location
R
Allow storage of materials: This option is used for deciding whether storage of materials is allowed in
AI
this Godown or not. This option will appear only if the option Allow advanced entries in master is
N
enabled in F12: Configuration, while creating stock items. If the option is not visible, then by default this
AN
option will be set to Yes.
AR
Our Stock with Third Party: Set this option to Yes, if the godown is used to account the company's
goods lying with the third party.
H
ED
Third Party Stock with us: Set this option to Yes, if the godown created is used to account the goods
received from third party and the stock of third party should not affect the company stock value.
LE
R
Table 5.12
U
IM
The Bengaluru Location Godown screen appears as shown in the figure 5.11:
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note:
o Godowns have a pre-defined Main Location, because of which the options Display and Alter are functional
even before you create a godown.
120
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
o We can delete a godown by using the key Alt+D. The same cannot be deleted if transactions are recorded
or stock items are allocated to the godown while defining the opening quantity.
R
AI
Refer to the table given below (table 5.13) and define the stock opening balance in different
N
locations of Surya Mobiles:
AN
AR
Stock Item Godown Opening Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
H
Quantity
ED
Samsung 32GB Mobile 100 Nos 10000 1000000
Phone Bengaluru 50 Nos 10,000 5,00,000
LE
Location
R
U
Location
-S
Location
8
11
Table 5.13
Defining stock item opening balance using single stock item alter menu
To define the opening balance of stock, follow the steps given below:
121
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Items > Under Single Stock
Item > Select Alter
2. Select Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
3. Bring the cursor in the Quantity field and enter 100 Nos as opening balance, press Enter,
and to get the Stock Item Allocation screen of a particular stock item
4. In the Godown field select Bengaluru Location
5. Enter the Quantity as 50, Rate as 10,000 and the amount will get captured automatically
6. Press Enter, then select the Godown name as Delhi location
7. Enter the Quantity as 50, Rate as 10,000 and the amount will get captured automatically
The Allocations of Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone screen appears as shown in the figure 5.12:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
8. Press Enter, and to get the stock item alteration screen as shown in the figure 5.13:
00
The Stock Item Alteration screen appears as shown in the figure 5.13:
00
8 86
11
21
R
122
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 5.13 Stock Item Alteration screen
R
Items > Select Alter
AI
2. From the List of Groups, select All Items
N
AN
The Multi Stock Item Alteration screen appears as shown in the figure 5.14:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
In figure 5.14, we can observe that, for the stock item Samsung 32 GB Mobile Phone, the
11
opening quantity, rate and amount are filled as per the details defined in single stock item alteration
21
screen.
R
3. Now, bring the cursor in the Samsung 64 GB Mobile phone and enter the quantity as
100, you will get the Stock Item Allocation screen for particular stock item.
4. In the Godown field name select Bengaluru Location.
5. Enter the Quantity as 50, Rate as 15,000 and the amount will get captured automatically.
6. Press Enter, then select the Godown name as Delhi location.
7. Enter the Quantity as 50, Rate as 15,000 and the amount will get captured automatically.
8. Similarly, refer the figure 5.15 and provide the opening stock
The Multi Stock Item Alteration screen with opening balance appears as shown in the figure
5.15:
123
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.15 Filled Multi Stock Alteration Screen
9. Accept the screen
H
ED
LE
Conclusion
R
U
This chapter shows, the simplicity and efficiency of the inventory feature in Tally.ERP 9. This
IM
feature helps in organising inventory masters, leading to efficient logistics and supply chain
FF
management.
TE
Key Takeaways
-S
Inventory feature in Tally.ERP 9 helps in recording of stock details like receipt of stock,
delivery of stock, stock movement between storage locations or godowns and providing
8
11
Shortcut Keys
Shortcut Key Description
124
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Ctrl+L From the account group creation screen.
To navigate to the ledger creation screen.
Ctrl+G From the ledger creation screen.
To navigate to the account group creation screen.
Ctrl+I From any inventory master creation screen.
To navigate to the stock item creation screen.
Practice Exercises
R
AI
N
1. What is the default Godown name in Tally?
AN
a. Primary Category
b. Primary Location
AR
c. Main Location
d. No Location
H
ED
LE
2. Rajesh Enterprises sold 12 dozen chalk boxes, each containing 100 chalks, to Radha on
R
April 02, 2017. Which type of unit of measure will you create in Tally.ERP 9 to record
U
a. Complex
b. Simple
FF
c. Compound
TE
d. Triple
-S
Products Model
Bajaj Iron Boxes Model 1 Model 2
00
125
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
ii. Based on the information given in the table, how many Stock Items will have to be
created?
a. 3
b. 4
c. 6
d. 16
iii. Assuming that the company has made the Stock Groups based on the home appliances,
Stock Items are based on the Models under each Stock Group, identify the correct match:
R
1. Nos a. Stock Group
AI
2. Mixer Grinders b. Units of Measure
N
3. BPL TV – Model 10 c. Stock Item
AN
a. 1-c, 2-a, 3-b
AR
b. 1-b, 2-a, 3-c
c. 1-a, 2-b, 3-c
H
ED
d. 1-c, 2-b, 3-a LE
R
a. Stock Item
IM
b. Stock Group
c. Units of Measure
FF
d. Indirect Expenses
TE
6 -S
a. True
00
b. False
8 86
a. True
21
b. False
R
8. Mr. Karthik, the accountant at Surya Traders is trying to create a stock item from the screen
given in figure 5.16 in Tally.ERP 9:
126
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 5.16 Stock Group Creation screen
H
Mr Karthik can create the stock item from the above screen.
ED
LE
a. True
R
b. False
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
127
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 6
Recording of Day-to-Day
Transactions
R
AI
Learning Objectives
N
AN
Recording contra voucher
AR
Recording payment voucher
Recording receipt voucher
H
Recording sales voucher
Recording credit note voucher
ED
LE
Recording purchase voucher
Recording debit note voucher
R
U
128
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.1 Introduction
Accounting is the practice of maintaining a record of the financial dealings of a business. It involves
identifying business transactions, recording them, and summarising the same in such a way that
important financial information can be communicated to stakeholders of the business.
The different phases of an accounting cycle are:
1. Identification of transactions
2. Preparation or receipt of business documents
3. Recording of transactions in books of original entry
R
4. Posting of transactions to ledgers
AI
5. Preparation of trial balance
N
6. Preparation of final accounts
AN
7. Passing of closing and adjustment entries
AR
In this chapter, we will learn how day-to-day transactions are recorded in an actual business
scenario using Tally.ERP 9, and the simplicity of generating reports through Tally software.
H
6.2 Business Transactions ED
LE
The accounting cycle begins with the occurrence of a business transaction, which is then recorded
R
A transaction is an event or happening that changes an organisation’s financial position and/or its
earnings. This involves a business concern and its clients, suppliers or others with whom the
FF
concern has business dealings. For example, when a company purchases goods for cash, the
TE
company’s cash balance reduces and its stock balance increases. The transaction involves a
reciprocal exchange of two things, i.e., receipt of cash and delivery of stock and vice versa.
-S
Similarly, every transaction involves the aspect of ‘give and take’. Thus, business transactions are
6
exchanges of economic consideration between parties and have two-fold effects that are recorded
00
129
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.2.2 Recording Transactions in Tally.ERP 9
Recording of a financial transaction is the first step in an accounting cycle. Every day, business
concerns are involved in business activities like making purchases, sales, making payments to
vendors, receiving payments from customers and so on. Even if one of the transactions is not
recorded or is inaccurately recorded, the financial reports will not reflect the correct financial
performance or position of the company.
Under the manual system of accounting, transactions are first recorded in the books of original
entry called journals, as per the golden rules of accounting.
R
AI
N
Type of Accounts Golden Rules
AN
AR
Debit the receiver
H
ED
Personal accounts
LE
Credit the giver
R
U
IM
Real accounts
TE
Nominal accounts
86
Table 6.1
21
A journal is a record of financial transactions in order, by date. Manual systems usually have a
R
variety of journals such as a sales journal, purchase journal, cash receipts journal, cash
disbursements journal, and a general journal. However, in today’s computerized accounting
environment, a general journal is maintained in which adjusting entries and unique financial
transactions like provision entries are recorded. In other words, accounting software has eliminated
the need to first record routine transactions into a journal.
Next, the entries are posted into ledgers (if an organisation is large, then the entries are recorded
in subsidiary books like purchase, sales, credit note, debit note etc.), and then a trial balance is
prepared from the ledger accounts.
Now, let us see how day-to- day business transactions are maintained in Tally.ERP 9.
130
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
In Tally.ERP 9, the first step is a one-time activity of creation of ledgers for recording transactions.
Recording of transactions in Tally.ERP 9 follows the Golden Rules of Accounting.
It involves use of separate vouchers for recording different types of transactions, like purchase
vouchers are used for recording purchase entries, sales vouchers for recording sales entries, debit
note vouchers to record purchase return entries, credit note vouchers for recording sales return
entries, etc.
After the transactions are entered using vouchers, posting to ledgers, and preparation of trial
balance and financial statements are automated in Tally.ERP 9, speeding up the accounting process
thus, saving precious time.
R
AI
N
6.3 Accounting Vouchers
AN
Accounting Voucher is the primary document in which the complete details of accounting
AR
transactions are recorded. Businesses require to maintain documentary evidence of their
H
transactions to arrive at meaningful accounting information. This will help them to arrive at
ED
relevant reports.
LE
Without accounting vouchers, there would be no record of transactions occurring in a company.
Further, it would not be possible to get the relevant accounting reports.
R
U
a different job.
FF
These vouchers can be altered to suit a company’s requirements. Tally.ERP 9 also allows creation
of new ones.
Let us illustrate the different types of transactions that take place in a real-time business
environment and the accounting procedure in Tally.ERP 9.
Business Scenario
Pratap started a company KRA Traders, with a capital of ₹ 20, 00,000, in April 2017. The company
traded in water bottles – steel and plastic water bottles. The company made frequent purchases
131
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
from MK Traders; its biggest and most frequent customer is Chakri Traders. The company had a
current account in SBI for business purpose.
Before recording the transactions of KRA Traders, one must first create the company in Tally.ERP
9.
Activity: In order to record transactions in Tally.ERP 9, create the following company.
Company Name: KRA Traders
Address: No: 204, Hayavadana Main Road, Gavipuram Extension, Ramalaya Building, Gandhi Bazar,
Bengaluru - 560001
R
AI
Country: India
N
State; Karnataka
AN
Financial Year: 01-04-2017 to 31-03-2018
AR
Now, the company is created. Let us begin recording the company’s business transactions.
H
6.3.1 Receipt Voucher
ED
LE
Any money received by a business concern, from sales or any other source capital introduced by
owners are considered receipts and any money received from debtors against sales, where money
R
Date Particulars
-S
Table 6.2
To record the transaction of table 6.2, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Capital Ledger
132
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create.
Table 6.3
R
AI
The Owners Capital A/c Ledger Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.1
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
To record the receipt voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
R
133
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Debit the Cash Account, the amount will get captured automatically.
6. Enter the Narration.
The Receipt Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.2:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 6.2 Receipt Voucher Creation Screen
R
U
IM
Note: The same entry can be recorded in single entry mode by setting the option - Use single entry mode for
payment/receipt/ contra vouchers to Yes from F12: Configure.
TE
-S
Contra Voucher is a transaction involving transfer of cash between one Cash A/c to another or
00
one Cash A/c to another Bank A/c. A transaction indicating transfer of funds from:
86
134
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-07-2017 Voucher: Contra
R
AI
Table 6.4
N
To record the transaction of table 6.4, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
AN
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AR
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
H
Bank Account Ledger
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create. ED
LE
R
Bank Configuration
R
135
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.3 SBI Bank A/c Ledger Creation Screen
H
2. Accept the screen
Step 2: Recording Contra Voucher ED
LE
To record the Contra voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
R
U
Double Entry Mode: This mode allows debiting and crediting of multiple accounts
TE
at a time.
Single Entry Mode: This mode allows debiting multiple accounts but crediting of
-S
2. Press F12: Configure to get the Contra Configuration, and ensure the options are set as
given below:
00
Skip Date field during creation for faster entry to Yes (By enabling this option,
86
disabling this option, entries will be recorded in double entry mode i.e., Debit and
Credit mode).
21
Use Cr/Dr instead of To/By during entry to Yes (By enabling this option, the
R
136
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.4 Cash Denomination Screen
H
7. Press Enter.
8. Enter the Narration.
ED
LE
R
The Contra Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.5:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note: In Tally.ERP 9, the same entry can be recorded in single entry mode by setting the option - Use single
entry mode for payment/receipt/ contra vouchers to Yes from F12: Configure.
137
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.3.3 Payment Voucher
Payment voucher is used to account all the payments made by the company by cash or through
bank.
Illustration 3: Recording a Payment Voucher in Tally.ERP 9
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
Date Particulars
R
01-07-2017 Voucher: Payment
AI
N
KRA Traders Paid ₹ 50,000 as Salaries to Staff through cheque.
AN
Particulars L.F Dr. Cr.
AR
Salaries to Staff _________________ Dr. 50,000
H
To, SBI Bank A/c 50,000
KRA Traders made a cash payment of ₹ 20,000 towards travelling expenses and
FF
incurred)
21
R
Table 6.6
To record the transaction of table 6.6, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
138
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create
Salaries to Staff
201FTable 6.7
R
AI
Activity: Similarly, create the ledgers Travelling Expenses and Food Expenses.
N
Step 2: Recording Payment Voucher involving one Debit and one Credit Account each
AN
To record the Payment voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
AR
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F5: Payment
H
Payment entries can be entered in Tally.ERP 9 in the following modes:
ED
Double Entry Mode: This mode allows debiting and crediting of multiple accounts
LE
at a time.
R
Single Entry Mode: This mode allows debiting multiple accounts but crediting of
U
2. Debit the Salaries to Staff ledger and enter the amount ₹50,000.
FF
3. Credit the SBI Bank A/c, the amount will get captured automatically
4. Press Enter to skip Cheque Range.
TE
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.6:
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
139
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
7. Accept the screen.
Note: The above entry (figure 6.6) is recorded in double entry mode. The same entry can be recorded in single entry
mode by enabling the option - Use single entry mode for payment/receipt/ contra vouchers to
Yes from F12: Configure.
Step 3: Recording Payment Voucher where One Account is Credited and Multiple
Accounts are Debited (Compound Entry)
R
To record the Payment voucher using multiple accounts in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given
AI
below:
N
AN
1. From Payment Voucher Creation screen, Press F2: Date and change the date to 05-07-
2017.
AR
2. Debit the Travelling Expenses ledger and enter the amount ₹20,000.
H
3. Debit the Food Expenses ledger and enter the amount ₹20,000.
4. Credit the Cash A/c, the amount will get captured automatically. ED
LE
5. Enter the Narration.
R
U
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.7:
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
140
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Illustration 4: Recording a Payment Voucher in Single Entry Mode
R
AI
Food Expenses _______________ Dr. 30,000
N
To, SBI Bank A/c 50,000
AN
(Being Travelling and Food Expenses
AR
incurred, paid by cheque)
H
ED
Table 6.8 LE
Note: All three ledgers, i.e. SBI Bank A/c, Travelling Expenses and Food Expenses involved in this transaction
have been already created in Tally.ERP 9.
R
U
To record the Payment voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
FF
3. Click F12: Configure to get the Payment Standard Configuration, and set the option
6
Observation: On enabling the Single Entry mode, the payment screen displays the Account field (Select the
86
ledger which has to be credited), Particulars field (Select the ledgers which has to be debited) and the amount
field (Enter the amount)
8
11
21
5. Under Particulars field Select Travelling Expenses ledger and enter the amount,
₹20,000.
6. Then select the Food Expenses ledger and enter the amount, ₹30,000
7. Press Enter.
8. Press Enter. The Bank Allocations screen appears.
9. Press Enter to skip the field Cheque Range.
10. Enter the instrument number and date in Bank Allocations screen.
11. Enter the Narration.
The Payment Voucher Creation screen in single entry mode appears as shown in the figure 6.8:
141
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.8 Payment Voucher Creation Screen (Single Entry Mode)
H
12. Accept the screen.
ED
LE
R
In the entry of figure 6.8, one account i.e., SBI Bank A/c has been credited and two accounts i.e.,
U
Travelling Expenses and Food Expenses have been debited. This is one form of compound entry.
IM
Purchase is the cost incurred by the business concern during a period, for further sale of inventory.
6
Purchase is an expense to the company. It is included in the income statement and is also
00
In accounting, the purpose and type of purchases is important. Purchase of fixed assets for own
86
consumption will be accounted as fixed assets and shown in the Balance Sheet, while purchases
8
made for further sale will be accounted as Expenses. (Inventory Accounting will be explained in
11
some goods on cash, cheque or on credit basis. A purchase voucher can be recorded in the
following three modes:
Voucher Mode
Item Invoice Mode
Account Invoice Mode (will be explained in detail in chapter 17)
Voucher Mode: In Voucher mode, the debit and credit amount fields are shown adjacent to each
other.
The Sample Format of Voucher Mode in Tally.ERP 9 is shown in the figure 6.9:
142
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.9 Purchase (Voucher Mode Sample Format)
H
Note: From the Purchase Voucher Creation screen, press Ctrl+V to move to the Item Invoice mode and vice
versa.
ED
LE
Item Invoice Mode: This mode allows entry of inventory details like Name of Stock Item,
R
Quantity, Rate and amount details. This mode is useful for recording inventory movements in the
U
books of account.
IM
Note: To pass a purchase entry in the invoice mode, ensure the the option- Enable invoicing in F11:
FF
The Sample Format of Item Invoice Mode in Tally.ERP 9 is shown in the figure 6.10:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
143
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
.
Note: From the Accounting Voucher Creation screen in item invoice mode, press Alt+I or click I:
Accounting Invoice to change the mode to Accounting Invoice Mode and vice versa.
Accounting Invoice Mode: This mode allows a user to directly select/debit a ledger account
while passing an entry in Accounting Invoice mode. This mode is useful especially when a Service
Bill is being entered (as it does not include inventory details).
The Sample Format of Accounting Invoice Mode in Tally.ERP 9 is shown in the figure 6.11:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
Note: The above screen displays the fields Particulars, Rate, and Amount. To change to voucher mode, press
00
Ctrl+V and for item invoice mode from this screen, press Alt+I key combinations.
00
86
Similarly, we can record Sales transactions, Debit Notes, and Credit Notes in voucher mode, item
8
Once after understating about the different modes of voucher like item invoice, accounting invoice
and voucher mode, let us record the transactions in different vouchers like purchase, sales, debit
R
144
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11-07-2017 Voucher: Purchase
KRA Traders, purchased goods for ₹ 20,000 on cash with supplier invoice
number 1.
R
AI
Table 6.9
N
To record the transaction of table 6.9, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
AN
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AR
H
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Purchase Ledger ED
LE
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create
R
U
Purchase A/c
IM
Voucher mode: By disabling the option Inventory values are affected? One can debit the purchase
00
ledger but cannot define the inventory details like stock item name in voucher mode.
86
Item invoice mode: By enabling the option Inventory values are affected? One can select the
8
11
Purchase Ledger from the List of Ledger Account, if the same is disabled then the purchase ledger will not
appear for selection in item invoice mode.
21
R
Table 6.10
Note: By disabling the option Inventory values are affected? the purchase ledger can be debited in a
transaction but inventory details can’t be provided in the transaction. This ledger can be used in the voucher mode or
an accounting invoice mode but will not be available in the List of Ledger Accounts for selection in the Item
Invoice mode.
145
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 2: Recording a Purchase Transaction in Voucher Mode
To record the Purchase transaction in voucher Mode, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F9: Purchase.
2. From the Accounting Voucher Creation screen, press F12: Configure to view the
Purchase Standard Configuration.
3. Set Enable supplementary details to No.(If you enable this option, you will have to
R
specify supplier details like Name , Address etc.)
AI
4. Press F2: Date and change the date to 11-07-2017.
N
5. Press Ctrl+V (V: As Voucher) to record the transaction in voucher mode, if you are on
AN
the invoice mode.
AR
6. Enter the Supplier Invoice No. as 1
7. Credit the Cash Ledger and enter the amount ₹20,000
H
8. Debit the Purchase A/c and the amount will get captured automatically
9. Enter the Narration.
ED
LE
The Purchase Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.12:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
146
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Illustration 6: Recording Purchase Transaction in Item Invoice Mode
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
12-07-2017 Voucher: Purchase
KRA Traders purchased following stock items from MK Traders on cash, with
supplier invoice number 2.
R
AI
N
Table 6.11
AN
To record the transaction of table 6.11, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AR
H
ED
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
LE
Purchase ledger
R
Purchase of Goods
U
To record the purchase voucher in item invoice mode, the following inventory masters are to be
00
created in Tally.ERP 9.
86
Unit of Measure
8
11
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Units of Measure > Create.
21
Numbers
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Items> Create
Table 6.13
R
AI
N
Steel Water Bottle
AN
Against the field Action to be performed
AR
Name Enter as Steel Water Bottle
H
ED
Under Under Primary
LE
Units Select Nos
R
Table 6.14
U
IM
FF
3. Set Enable supplementary details to No (If you enable this option, you will have to
specify the supplier details like Name, Address etc.)
00
7. In the Party A/c name field select Cash (In this field, you must select Sundry Creditors
21
148
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.13 Purchase Voucher (Item Invoice Mode)
H
13. Accept the screen.
ED
LE
On recording of entries, relevant accounts like purchase and cash are updated automatically.
R
Note: Recording transactions in Account Invoice mode will be covered in later chapters.
U
IM
A Sales voucher is used when a company sells goods to customers on cash, cheque or credit basis.
TE
In Tally.ERP 9, a sales entry can be recorded with and without inventory details.
6
The following illustration will demonstrate how a sales entry is recorded in Tally.ERP 9.
00
00
KRA Traders, sold goods for ₹ 40,000 to Chakri Traders on cash with reference
number 1.
149
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
Table 6.15
N
To record the transaction of table 6.15, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
AN
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AR
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
H
Sales Ledger
ED
LE
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create
R
Sales A/c
U
IM
Table 6.16
00
To record the sales transaction in voucher mode, follow the steps given below:
11
2. From the Accounting Voucher Creation screen, click F12:Configure andset Enable
R
supplementary details to No (If you enable this option, you will have to specify the
despatch details ,Order details, and Buyers details.)
3. Press F2: Date and change the date to 15-07-2017.
4. Press Ctrl+V or click V: As Voucher to record the transaction in voucher mode.
5. Enter the Reference No. as 1
6. Debit the Cash Ledger and enter the amount 40,000.
7. Credit the Sales A/c and the amount will get captured automatically.
8. Enter the Narration.
The Accounting Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.14:
150
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.14 Sales Voucher (Voucher Mode)
H
9. Accept the screen.
ED
LE
Illustration 8: Recording Sales Transaction in Item Invoice Mode
R
U
KRA Traders sold the following stock items to Mahavir Traders on credit with
reference number 2.
TE
-S
Table 6.17
8
11
To record the transaction of table 6.17, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
21
151
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 2: Recording Sales Transaction in Item Invoice Mode
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Sales
2. From the Voucher Creation screen, press F12: Configure to get the Sales Invoice
Standard Configuration and set Enable supplementary details to No (If you enable
this option, then you will have to specify the supplier details like Name and Address etc.)
3. Press F2:Date and change the date to 18-07-2017
4. Press Ctrl+V to record the transaction in item invoice mode.
5. Enter the Reference No. as 2
6. In the Party A/c name field select Mahavir Traders (In this field, you must select Cash
R
ledger, if sale is made on cash basis)
AI
7. In the field Sales ledger select Sale of Goods.
N
8. Under the field Name of Item, select Plastic Water Bottle, enter the Quantity as 50
AN
Nos, rate as 150 per Nos and the amount 7,500 will get captured automatically.
AR
9. Press Enter.
10. Select the second stock item, Steel Water Bottle, enter the Quantity as 50 Nos, Rate as
H
700 per Nos and the amount 35,000 will get captured automatically.
ED
11. Enter the Narration.
LE
The Accounting Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.15:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
152
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.3.6 Debit Note Voucher
A Debit Note Voucher is used to record the transaction details of the purchases returns or returns
outwards. The reason for purchases returns could vary from supply of damaged goods, or goods
not as per specifications, to any other.
Purchases Returns must be recorded in the books of account, because the value of returned
goods must be deducted from the purchases.
In Tally.ERP 9, a purchase return transaction using Debit Note voucher can be recorded for
change in price consideration also. A Debit Note can be recorded in voucher mode as well as in
item invoice mode.
R
AI
N
Illustration 9: Recording Debit Note Voucher without Inventory.
AN
Activity: Record the below purchase transaction in voucher mode.
AR
As on 18-07-2017, KRA Traders, purchased goods for ₹ 30,000 on cash, with supplier invoice number 3.
H
20-07-2017 Voucher: Debit Note ED
LE
R
Goods for ₹ 15,000 was returned to supplier for the purchase made on 18-07-
U
Table 6.18
8
11
Note: Ledgers used in this transactions are already created in Tally.ERP 9, hence there no need of creating these
21
Step 1: Recording Debit Note voucher for accounting the details of purchase return for
cash purchase made.
To record the Debit Note voucher without inventory details, follow the steps given below:
1. This voucher type is made available when the option Use debit and credit notes is set to
Yes in the F11: Features (F1: Accounting Features)
2. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F9: Debit Note
153
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. PressF2: Date and change the date to 20-07-2017
4. Mention the Original Invoice No as 3 and original invoice date as 18-07-2017 which is
returned
5. Debit the Cash Ledger and enter the amount ₹15,000
6. Credit the Purchase A/c and the amount will get captured automatically
7. Enter the Narration
The Debit Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.16:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
The entry of figure 6.16, will increase the cash balance and decrease the purchase/expense balance.
6
00
KRA Traders purchased following stock items from MK Traders on credit, with supplier
21
invoice number 4
R
Table 6.19
154
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
23-07-2017 Voucher: Debit Note
Returned the following goods which are in damaged condition to MK Traders
for the purchase made on 21-07-2017, with supplier invoice no. 4.
Table 6.20
R
AI
Note: Ledgers and Stock Items used in this transactions are already created in Tally.ERP 9, hence there is no
N
need of creating these once again.
AN
AR
Step 1: Recording Debit Note Voucher for accounting the details of purchase return for
H
credit purchase made.
To record the Debit Note Voucher with inventory details, follow the steps given below: ED
LE
1. This voucher type is made available when the option Use debit and credit notes and
R
U
Record debit notes in invoice mode is set to Yes in the F11: Features (F1: Accounting
IM
Features).
2. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F9: Debit Note.
FF
7. Under Name of Item field, select Plastic Water Bottle and enter the Quantity as 50
Nos, Rate as ₹ 100 per Nos and the amount ₹ 5,000 will get captured automatically.
00
8. Press Enter and select the second stock item, Steel Water Bottle and enter the quantity
86
as 50 Nos, rate as ₹ 500 per Nos and the amount ₹ 25,000 will get captured automatically.
8
11
Enter the Narration. The Debit Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure
6.17:
21
R
155
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.17 Debit Note Voucher (Purchase Return)
H
ED
9. Accept the screen.
LE
R
A Credit Note Voucher is used to record transaction details of sales returns or returns inwards.
The reason for sales returns could be damaged condition of goods sold, not as per specifications
FF
Goods are mostly returned because they were damaged when sold, or were not as per the buyer’s
-S
specifications.
6
00
Sales returns must be recorded in the books of account, because the value of returned goods must
be deducted from the sales.
00
86
In Tally.ERP 9, a sales return transaction is recorded using Credit Note Voucher, generally issued
by the seller to the buyer. The Credit Note voucher can be recorded in Voucher mode as well as
8
11
156
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
25-07-2017 Voucher: Credit Note
Goods for ₹ 20,000 was returned by customer for the sales made on 24-04-2017
against invoice number 3
R
(Being sales return from customer)
AI
N
AN
Table 6.21
AR
H
Note: Ledgers used in this transactions are already created in Tally.ERP 9, hence there no need of creating these
ED
ledgers once again.
LE
R
Step 1: Recording Credit Note Voucher for accounting the details of sales return for cash
U
sales made.
IM
FF
To record the Credit Note Voucher without inventory details, follow the steps given below:
TE
1. This voucher type is made available when the option Use debit and credit notes is set to
Yes in the F11: Features (F1: Accounting Features)
-S
2. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Credit Note
6
00
6. Debit the Sales A/c and the amount will get captured automatically
8
The Debit Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.18:
21
R
157
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.18 Credit Note Voucher (Sales Return)
H
ED
8. Accept the screen.
LE
The entry of figure 6.18, will decrease the cash balance as well as the sales balance.
R
U
KRA Traders sold following stock items to Kalyani Traders on credit, with reference number
-S
4.
6
00
Kalyani Traders
00
Table 6.22
R
158
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 6.23
R
AI
Note: Ledgers and Stock Items used in this transactions are already created in Tally.ERP 9, hence there no need
N
of creating these once again.
AN
AR
Step 1: Recording Credit Note Voucher for accounting sales return made on cash sales.
H
ED
To record the Credit Note Voucher with inventory details, follow the steps given below:LE
1. This voucher type is made available when the option Use debit and credit notes and
Record credit notes in invoice mode is set to Yes in the F11: Features (F1:
R
Accounting Features).
U
IM
2. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Credit Note
3. PressF2: Date and change the date to 28-07-2017
FF
4. Enter the Original Invoice No as 4 and Original Invoice Dt. as 26-07-2017 which is
TE
returned
5. In the Party A/c name field select Kalyani Traders
-S
7. Under Name of Item field, select Plastic Water Bottle and enter the quantity as 20 Nos,
00
rate as ₹ 150 per Nos and the amount ₹ 3,000 will get captured automatically
00
8. Press Enter and select the second stock item, Steel Water Bottle and enter the quantity
86
as 20 Nos, rate as ₹ 700 per Nos and the amount ₹ 14,000 will get captured automatically
9. Enter the Narration
8
11
The Credit Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.19:
21
R
159
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.19 Credit Note Voucher (Credit Sales Return)
H
ED
10. Accept the screen.
LE
Since the transaction of figure 6.19, involves sales returns entries with inventory details, the
R
Journal vouchers are used to pass adjustment entries, to adjust the debit and credit amounts
without involving cash or bank accounts. Adjusting journal entries are typically made just before
-S
Activity: As on 01-08-2017, KRA Traders made purchase of 100 Nos of Plastic Water Bottles
00
worth ₹ 10,000 from Kalyani Traders. Freight charges incurred towards purchase was ₹ 1,000 as
86
on 15-08-2017.
8
Freight charge was not recorded at the time of purchase, hence the same has to be recorded
11
Date Particulars
160
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
15-08-2017 Voucher: Journal
R
purchase of Plastic Water Bottle
AI
N
AN
Table 6.24
AR
To record the transaction of table 6.24,in the books of account, first ensure that the required
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
H
ED
LE
Step 1: Creation of Ledgers
R
Table 6.25
21
R
161
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6. Enter the Narration.
The Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.20:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 6.20 Journal Voucher Creation Screen
R
U
In the above section, we have seen how accounting transactions are recorded using different
FF
In Tally.ERP 9, you have seen that there are predefined voucher types available to record
00
transactions. However, you can create voucher types to suit specific requirements using the pre-
defined voucher types as the base.
00
86
For example: KRA Traders wants to record bank payments and petty cash payments separately.
The company wants to maintain different voucher types to record only bank related transactions.
8
11
Illustration 14: Creating a new voucher type and recording transactions in Tally.ERP 9
21
In this scenario, KRA traders will create a new voucher type using payment voucher type
R
as the base. The new voucher type will inherit the functions of a payment voucher.
Step 1: Accounting Masters Creation
Bank Payment Voucher Type
To create Bank Payment Voucher Type, follow the below given procedure:
1. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Voucher Types > Create
2. Enter Name as Bank Payment
3. Select Type of Voucher as Payment Voucher.
162
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Enter an abbreviation for the new voucher. The abbreviation will be used to denote this
new voucher in reports
5. Select the Method of Voucher Numbering as Automatic
Automatic
Select this option if you want Tally.ERP 9
to automatically number the vouchers in
this voucher type sequentially.
Automatic (Manual Override) This method will automatically number the
R
AI
voucher and also we can manually enter the
N
number.
AN
Choose this option if you want Tally.ERP 9
to automatically number the vouchers, but
AR
also manually enter the voucher number
H
when required.
Manual ED
LE
Select this option to manually enter the
voucher number.
R
U
IM
managed by Tally.ERP 9.
6
00
numbering.
86
Table 6.26
8
11
6. Set the option Use Advance Configuration to No. ( To modify the voucher number as
21
per your requirement like, you want to add suffix & prefix details, then the same need to
be enabled)
R
7. Set the option Use effective dates for vouchers to No (By enabling this option, you
will get the additional effective date field while recording the entry)
8. Set the option Make this voucher type as ‘Optional’ by default to No (By enabling
this option the voucher will behave like a permanent Non Accounting Voucher, it will
not reflect in books of account)
9. Set the option Allow Narration in voucher to Yes (If the same is disabled, then you
will not get the option to enter Narration details while recording the entry in this
particular voucher)
10. Set the option Provide Narrations for each ledger in voucher to No (If you enable
this option, then after selecting each ledger, you will get the Narration option)
163
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11. Set the option Enable default accounting allocations to No & set/alter Default
Accounting Entries to No (If you enable this option, you will be able to define the
default entries or automation of the entry)
12. Set the option Printing voucher after saving to No
13. Press Enter on the field Name of Class to skip the field.
The Voucher Type Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.21:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
Similarly, in Tally.ERP 9, you can create many voucher types based on your requirements. For
example, an organization wants to maintain its credit & cash sales in separate vouchers. These
6
00
Activity:
86
2) Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > Press F5: Payment > Select the required
voucher type from the list of voucher types (It will display two payment voucher types Bank Payment and Cash
21
Payment)
R
Note: Observe the voucher type menu, you will notice that you can also display and alter voucher types. Selecting
these options brings up a list of voucher types, from which you can select the one you want to view or work on. Apart
from the heading and function, the voucher type Display/Alter screens are identical to the creation screen.
Activity
1) Create a Payment voucher type to record for Petty Cash transactions in Tally.ERP 9
2) Record further entries in the books of KRA Traders:
Date Particulars
164
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
21-08-2017 Voucher: Cash Payment
Cash Payment made to Kalyani Traders for ₹ 5,000 from SBI Bank account.
(Use Cash Payment Voucher Type to record the transaction)
R
Salaries to staff of ₹ 2,500 amount paid through SBI Bank Account, vide cheque
AI
number 345678, date 23-08-2017
N
AN
(Use Bank Payment Voucher Type to record the transaction)
AR
24-08-2017 Voucher: Petty Cash
H
Paid stationary charges of ₹ 50 from Petty Cash.
ED
(Use Petty Cash Payment Voucher Type to record the transaction)
LE
R
Received Cheque for ₹ 1, 50,000 received from MK Traders. and the same is
IM
Table 6.27
TE
-S
Once after recording above transactions of table 6.27 check the Day Book Report (This report
will display the details of day to day transactions)
6
00
The Day Book is a report of all the transactions recorded on a day or in a period of time. Let us
view the transactions recorded in the Day Book.
00
165
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.22 Day Book Report Screen
H
ED
You can see that along with the pre-defined voucher types in Tally.ERP 9, the new voucher
LE
types created are also listed in the Day Book.
R
U
IM
Voucher Classes are used to automate accounting allocations in transactions. It is a table for
predefining the entries to make invoice entry a simple task. This is useful in sales invoicing where
TE
the nominal ledger accounts to be credited for each item of sale is defined once.
-S
During voucher entry, the accounting credits for items sold are done automatically. Additional
6
accounting entries like tax, freight, and other charges, can be predefined to be carried out
00
Voucher Classes are available for all major voucher types like Contra, Payment, Receipt, Journal,
86
Sales, Credit Note, Purchases, Debit Note, Sales Order, Purchase Order, Delivery Note, Stock
8
Business Scenario:
KRA Traders use SBI Bank account for all the bank payments that they make. They can avoid
selecting the SBI Bank A/c ledger every single time a bank payment transaction is made. They
automate this by using voucher classes in Tally.ERP 9.
Illustration 15: Creation and recording a bank payment voucher with voucher class and
automation of bank ledger in transaction.
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
166
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
26-08-2017 Voucher: Payment
KRA Traders made a cheque payment of ₹ 1, 20,000 towards Rent Paid vide
cheque number 002314
R
AI
N
Table 6.28
AN
To record the transaction of table 6.28, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
AR
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
H
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Activity: Create the ledger by name Rent Paid A/c ledger under Indirect Expenses group. ED
LE
Step 2: Creation of Class in Voucher Type Master
R
U
To create a voucher class in the Bank Payment Voucher Type, follow the steps given below::
FF
1. Go to the Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Voucher Types > Alter.
TE
The Voucher Type Class screen appears as shown in the figure 6.23:
00
8 86
11
21
R
167
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 6.23 Voucher Type Class Creation Screen
Note: End of list is selected because we don’t want to exclude any ledger for this voucher type
7. Under Specific Ledger for which this Class is created (e.g. Cash, or a Bank
Account) field, select SBI Bank A/c as shown in the figure 6.24.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 3: Recording Payment Voucher Using Voucher Class
To record the Payment voucher using voucher class in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F5: Payment
2. In Name field, select Bank Payment from the List of Types.
3. In Class field, select SBI Payment from Voucher Class List as shown in figure 6.26.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
5. Under Account field, SBI Bank A/c is selected by default and the cursor does not move
6
to Account field.
00
6. Under Particulars field Select Rent Paid A/c ledger and enter the amount, ₹1, 20,000.
00
7. Enter the instrument number and date in the Bank Allocations screen.
86
The Accounting Voucher Creation screen in single entry mode appears as shown in the figure
21
6.27:
R
169
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.27 Payment Voucher Creation Screen (Single Entry Mode)
9. Accept the screen.
H
You can see that the Voucher Type is Bank Payment, and the Voucher Class is SBI Payment.
ED
Once the voucher class is selected, the SBI Bank Ledger is automatically selected and you need to
LE
select only the Ledgers which are to be debited.
R
U
Note: The entry is done in Single Entry System, to make the data entry faster.
IM
Activity:
FF
2) Create a Voucher Class as Petty Cash Payment in Petty Cash Payment Voucher Type.
-S
Date Particulars
86
Cash Payment made on purchase of stationary for ₹ 150 using petty cash.
21
(Use Petty Cash Payment Voucher Type with class to record the transaction)
R
Cash Receipt made on sale of goods for ₹ 1,500 from Kalyani Traders.
(Use Receipt Voucher Type with class to record the transaction)
Table 6.29
170
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.6 Non-Accounting Vouchers
The Non-Accounting/Unconventional Vouchers are the special vouchers that are used to
record provisional or non-accounting transactions. They are used as provisional entries from the
books of accounts and make them available for what-if (future reports, projections, forecasts etc.)
reports required at any given time. These Non-Accounting transactions doesn’t affect the regular
books of accounts.
Tally.ERP 9 comprises the following predefined non-accounting vouchers, to suit different
business requirements and for recording various transactions. Tally.ERP 9 also allows you to create
user-defined vouchers (voucher types) according to your requirements.
R
AI
Memorandum Voucher
N
Optional Vouchers
AN
Let us see understand the non-accounting voucher in Tally.ERP 9 are used in real time business
AR
scenarios:
H
6.6.1 Memorandum Voucher
Memorandum Voucher (memo voucher) is a non-accounting voucher and the entries made
ED
LE
using memo voucher will not affect your books of accounts. You can use memo vouchers when
you are uncertain about the account to which the amount has to be allocated to when recording
R
U
the transaction. When the account is determined, the memo voucher can be converted into a
IM
regular voucher, and the transaction can be brought to the books of accounts.
FF
KRA Traders gave cash to office staff to buy stationeries, the company does not know the actual
21
cost of stationaries and gave ₹ 1,000 as suspense payment assuming that the actual cost incurred
R
KRA traders made a suspense cash payment of 1,000 to the office staff. However, the actual cost
of purchase wasn’t known. Pass the following transaction in the book of KRA Traders:
Date Particulars
171
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-09-2017 Voucher: Memorandum
R
AI
N
Table 6.30
AN
AR
In this transaction, the exact nature and cost of stationary is unknown. So we need to record the
H
Memorandum Journal.
ED
To record the transaction of table 6.30, in the books of KRA Traders, first ensure that the required
LE
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
R
U
IM
Stationery A/c
6
00
Table 6.31
R
172
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To record the memorandum voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F10: Memos.
2. Press F2: Date and change the date to 01-09-2017.
3. Debit the Stationary A/c and enter the amount, 1,000
4. Credit the Cash Account, the amount will get captured automatically.
5. Enter the narration in the Narration field
The Memorandum Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.28:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
The Memorandum voucher will not affect the regular books of accounts, you can convert this
00
Memo Voucher into a regular voucher (Journal) by pressing F7 from the memorandum voucher
00
alteration screen, when you decide to bring this entry into your books.
86
173
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.29 Memorandum Register
H
The report of figure 6.29, displays the details of total monthly summary. Further, you can press
Enter from the monthly summary to get Voucher Register. It shows all the Memorandum
ED
LE
Vouchers made for the specified period.
R
Note: You can also view memorandum vouchers from the Day Book. To view the same, go to Gateway of
U
Optional Vouchers are non-accounting vouchers. You can mark any existing vouchers as
-S
optional by Pressing Ctrl+L. Optional Vouchers do not affect regular books of accounts, but
6
remain in the Optional Voucher Register. Again, by pressing Ctrl+L, from the voucher, the
00
Optional vouchers can also be used to forecast future sales projections, to see the impact of
86
transactions without actually posting them, and the transaction that is incomplete to affect the
8
11
Proforma Invoice
R
A Proforma invoice. is an estimated invoice sent by a seller to the buyer in advance before delivery
of goods. Proforma invoices are commonly used as introductory invoices along with the
Quotation.
Illustration 17: Recording proforma sales invoice in Tally.ERP 9
Pass the following transaction in the book of KRA Traders:
174
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-09-2017 Voucher: Proforma Sales
On 01-09-2017, KRA Traders is making sales to Kalyani Traders with the
Reference no: 5. Before making the actual sales, KRA Traders is issuing a
proforma invoice as an estimated invoice in advance before the delivery of
goods.
R
AI
Table 6.32
N
AN
Note: Stock items: Plastic Water Bottle and Steel Water Bottle, and party ledger are already created in the books.
AR
H
Step 1: Recording Sales Transaction in Item Invoice Mode
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Sales
ED
LE
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 01-09-2017
3. Press Ctrl+L and make the entry as Optional.
R
5. In the Party A/c name field select Kalyani Traders (In this field, you must select Cash
ledger, if sale is made on cash basis)
FF
7. Under Name of Item field, select Plastic Water Bottle and enter the quantity as 10 Nos,
rate as ₹ 250 per Nos and the amount ₹ 2,500 will get captured automatically.
-S
8. Press Enter and select the second stock item, Steel Water Bottle and enter the quantity
6
as 10 Nos, rate as ₹ 850 per Nos and the amount ₹ 8,500 will get captured automatically
00
The Sales Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.30:
8
11
21
R
175
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.30 Sales Voucher (Optional)
H
10. Accept the screen
ED
LE
The sales voucher recorded is marked as optional voucher and will not affect the regular books of
R
accounts.
U
IM
2. Press Enter.
TE
The Optional Vouchers Register screen appears as shown in the figure 6.31:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
176
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The report of figure 6.31, displays the details of total number of optional vouchers made for the
specified period.
To print Proforma Invoice,
1. Press Enter on the sales voucher which is made optional. From sales voucher alteration
screen press Alt+P
The Proforma Invoice printing screen appears as shown in the figure 6.32:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
3. Press Enter
6
00
177
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
You can convert this Optional Voucher (Proforma Invoice) into a regular voucher (Sales Invoice)
by pressing Ctrl+L from the voucher alteration screen, when you decide to bring this entry into
your books.
178
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: You can also view optional vouchers from the Day Book.
R
is made at the end of the year, you can create Reversing Journal for a specific period to give more
AI
accurate status or position.
N
This Reversing Journal voucher will not affect the regular books of accounts, you can convert
AN
this Reversing Journal into a regular voucher (Journal) by pressing F7 from the Reversing Journal
voucher alteration screen, when you decide to bring this entry into your books
AR
6.7 Recording Provisional Entries
H
ED
Provision refers to the amount that is kept aside from profits for future known liabilities.
LE
Provisions are shown on the liabilities side of a Balance Sheet. For example, provision for
expenses, provision for bad debts and provision for depreciation.
R
U
Business Scenario: During the year-end (31-03-2018), KRA Traders incurred expenses of ₹
IM
10,000 payable the next year. To show the correct financial position of the company in its reports,
FF
Table 6.33
21
R
By accounting the above entry in its books of accounts, the company balance sheet will reflect a
liability of ₹ 10,000.
Reverse the above entry as on 01-04-2018, as shown below:
179
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-04-2018 Particulars L.F Dr. Cr.
Table 6.34
By recording the entry of table 6.34, the problem of double counting of expenses or revenues is
R
AI
eliminated.
N
Note: Reversing Entries are recorded on the first day of the accounting period. These entries are required to remove
AN
the adjustment entries made in the previous accounting period.
AR
Illustration 18: Recording Provisional entry in journal and changing the financial year in
Tally.ERP 9
H
ED
Date Particulars LE
31-03-2018 KRA Traders, incurred expenses of ₹ 15,000 as audit fee, but it is payable in the
next financial year. (Because the bill is not yet received from the KR Vendor)
R
U
IM
Table 6.35
TE
To record the transactions of table 6.35, in the books of KRA Traders, first ensure that the required
-S
Table 6.36
Provision for Expenses Ledger
180
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Table 6.37
Activity: Create a party as KR Traders under sundry creditors
R
AI
Step 2: Recording Journal Voucher
N
To record the Journal voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
AN
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F7: Journal
AR
2. Click F2:Date and change the date to 31-03-2018
3. Debit the Expenses Incurred A/c and enter the amount, ₹ 15,000
H
ED
4. Credit the Provision of Expenses A/c and amount will get captured automatically.
5. Enter the narration in the Narration field
LE
R
The Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.34:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Balance Sheet: Go to Gateway of Tally > Balance Sheet > the amount will be reflected
as a Current Liability. To check the exact provision amount, press the Enter key on Current
Liability Account.
181
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Profit & Loss Account: Go to Gateway of Tally > Profit & Loss Account > the amount
will be reflected under Indirect Expenses Account. To check the exact Expense Incurred
amount, press the Enter key on Indirect Expenses Account
Step 3: Recording Reversal Entry in the New Financial Year
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Press Alt+F2: Period.
2. Enter date as 01-04-2018 to 31-03-2019 (Changing the Financial Year) and Accept.
Note: After the financial year is changed in Tally.ERP 9, you cannot view the data which belongs to previous
year, but the closing balance of the previous year will automatically be carried forward to the new financial year as
opening balance.
R
AI
3. Go to Gateway of Tally>Accounting Vouchers > Press F7: Journal
N
4. Press F2: Date and change the date as 01-04-2018
5. Debit the Provision for Expenses A/c Ledger and enter the amount as ₹ 15,000
AN
6. Credit the Expense Incurred A/c Ledger and the amount will get captured automatically
AR
7. Enter the Narration.
H
The Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.35:
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
Balance Sheet: Go to Gateway of Tally > Balance Sheet > the amount will be reversed
(i.e., amount will not appear in the balance sheet)
Profit & Loss Account: Go to Gateway of Tally > Profit & Loss Account > the amount
will be nullified.
Activity: Go to Gateway of Tally and press Alt+F2: Change Period and set the financial period as 01-04-2017
to 31-03-2019.
182
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.8 Recording Inventory Vouchers
A voucher is a document that contains details of a financial transaction and is required for
recording the same into the books of accounts.
Inventory management is an integral part that helps in smooth running of the business and in
determining the deficiency/excess of stock at any time. Inventory management implies
maintaining an accurate record of incoming and outgoing stock.
Inventory vouchers record the details of receipt and issue of goods/stock, movement of goods,
transfer of stock between locations, and physical stock adjustments
R
Without inventory vouchers, it would be impossible to record the movement of inventory when
AI
an accounting transaction has not taken place.
N
AN
Business Scenario
AR
TRA Traders expanded its business and now deals in Mobile Phones. The company would like to
deliver stock to their customer. The sales invoice will be sent on a later date. In this scenario, an
H
inventory voucher recording movement of inventory but not affecting accounts is required.
The Inventory Vouchers are: ED
LE
R
These vouchers can be altered to suit a company’s requirements. Tally.ERP 9 also allows creation
86
Let us illustrate the different types of inventory transactions that take place in a real-time business
11
Receipt note is used for recording goods received from the supplier or receipt of goods/items at
stores. It is also called as GRN i.e. Goods Receipt Note. Receipt Note updates only inventory
books and does not affect accounting books.
Example: Purchase Register, Party Accounts and other Subsidiary Books.
Illustration 19: Recording a receipt note voucher in Tally.ERP 9
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
183
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-06-2018 Voucher: Receipt Note
KRA Traders received the following goods from JJ Enterprises with the
reference number 1 for ₹ 10,000 each.
R
Table 6.38
AI
N
To record the transaction of table 6.38, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
AN
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AR
Step 1: Configuration of Receipt Note
H
To configure Receipt Note voucher, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > F11: Company Features > F2: Inventory Features
ED
LE
2. Set the option Use tracking numbers (enables delivery and receipt notes ) to Yes
R
The Inventory Features screen with the required options enabled, appears as shown in the figure
U
6.36
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
184
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Create
2. Enter Name as JJ Enterprises
3. Select Sundry Creditors from the List of Groups
The party Ledger Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.37:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 6.37 Party Ledger Creation screen
R
U
Activity: In Purchase A/c Ledger alteration, set the option – Inventory values are affected to Yes
TE
-S
Stock Item
00
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Items > Under Single Stock Item >
86
Create
8
185
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.38 Stock Item Creation- Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
1. Accept the screen
H
Step 3: Recording Receipt Note Voucher
ED
LE
To record the Receipt Note voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
R
The Receipt Note Standard Configuration screen appears as shown in the figure 6.39:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
186
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Enter the Reference no. as 1
6. In the Party A/c name field, select JJ Enterprises
7. Provide the Other Reference(s) as GRN 01 in the Supplementary details screen.
8. Select the Purchase A/c ledger
9. Under Name of Stock Item select Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
10. In the Item Allocations screen, Select Not Applicable from the List of Tracking
Numbers.
11. Enter Quantity as 10 Nos, Rate as ₹ 10,000 and the amount will get captured
automatically as ₹ 1, 00,000.
The completed Receipt Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.40:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
-S
The receipt note transaction will affect in stock summary, and all inventory books. If the option
integrate accounts with inventory is enabled in F11:F1:Accounting feature, then the stock value
86
will reflect in accounting reports like balance sheet, profit & loss account, trial balance etc.
8
11
21
Delivery note is used for recording goods delivered to the customer or deliver of goods/items
from stores. It is also called as DC i.e. Delivery Challan. Delivery Note does not affect accounting
books.
Illustration 20: Recording a Delivery Note Voucher in Tally.ERP 9
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
187
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
05-06-2018 Voucher: Delivery Note
KRA Traders delivered following goods to Manya Enterprises with the reference
number – 1 for ₹ 15,000 each.
R
Table 6.40
AI
N
To record the transaction in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers are created
in Tally.ERP 9.
AN
AR
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
H
ED
Activity: Create the following Ledger Accounts in the books of KRA Traders:
LE
1) Create Manya Enterprises (Customer) under Sundry Debtors
R
2) Alter Sales A/c and set Inventory values are affected to Yes
U
IM
To record the Delivery Note voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
TE
Order Details
86
Despatch Details
o Despatch Doc No.: 01
o Despatch through : Truck
o Destination : Mysore
The Party Details screen displays as shown in the figure 6.41
188
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.41 Party Details screen (Delivery Note)
H
6. Select the Sales A/c ledger
7. Under Name of Stock Item select Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
ED
LE
8. In the Item Allocations Screen, Select Not Applicable from the List of Tracking
Numbers.
R
9. Enter Quantity as 5 Nos, Rate as ₹ 15,000 and the amount will get captured automatically
U
IM
as ₹ 75,000.
FF
The completed Delivery Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.42:
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
189
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The delivery note transaction will affect in stock summary, and all inventory books. If the option
integrate accounts with inventory is enabled in F11:F1:Accounting feature, then the stock value
will reflect in accounting reports like balance sheet, profit & loss account, trial balance etc.
R
AI
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
N
07-06-2018 Voucher: Rejection In
AN
KRA Traders received following goods from Manya Enterprises for ₹ 15,000
AR
against the goods delivered on 05-06-2018.
H
ED
Name of Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Samsung 32GB 01 Nos 15,000 15,000
LE
Mobile Phone
R
U
IM
Table 6.41
FF
To record the transaction of table 6.41, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
TE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > F11: Company Features > F2: Inventory Features > Enable
86
The Inventory Features screen with the required options enabled, appears as shown in the figure
11
6.43
21
R
190
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.43 Inventory Features screen
H
2. Accept the screen
Step 2: Recording Rejection In Voucher ED
LE
R
To record the Rejection In voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
U
6. In the Item Allocations Screen, Select Not Applicable from the List of Tracking
6
Numbers.
00
7. Enter Quantity as 1 Nos, Rate as ₹ 15,000 and the amount will get captured automatically
00
as ₹ 15,000.
8 86
The completed Rejection In Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.44:
11
21
R
191
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.44 Rejection In Voucher Creation screen
H
8. Accept the screen
The rejection in transaction will affect in stock summary, and all inventory books ED
LE
R
U
Rejections Out Voucher is used to record the goods that are rejected and returned to a supplier
FF
01-06-2018
21
Table 6.42
To record the transaction of table 6.42, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
192
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To record the Rejection Out voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Alt+F6: Rejection Out
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 10-06-2018
3. In the Ledger Account field, select JJ Enterprises
4. Supplier’s Name and Address field, JJ Enterprises will capture automatically
5. Under Name of Item select Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
6. In the Item Allocations screen, select Not Applicable from the List of Tracking
Numbers.
7. Enter Quantity as 3 Nos, Rate as ₹ 10,000 and the amount will get captured automatically
as ₹ 30,000.
R
AI
N
The completed Rejection Out Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.45:
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
The rejection out transaction will affect in stock summary, and all inventory books
11
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary> Press Alt+F1 for detailed mode.
The Stock Summary screen appears as shown in the figure 6.46:
193
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.46 Stock Summary Report
H
ED
2. Press Enter on Samsung 32GB Mobile Phone
3. You will get Stock Item Monthly Summary, Select June Month.
LE
4. Press Enter to view the Stock Vouchers
R
194
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6.8.5 Stock Journal Voucher
Stock Journal Voucher is used to transfer the goods from one location to another. The quantity
of stock remains the same, but the location (godown) changes. Stock journal voucher can also be
accounted for wastage or shortage of stock to increase or decrease in the Stock Item.
Illustration 23: Recording a Stock Journal Voucher in Tally.ERP 9
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
15-06-2018 Voucher: Stock Journal
R
AI
N
As there is shortage in stock in Delhi Location, KRA Traders transferred the
following goods from Bengaluru Location to Delhi Location.
AN
AR
Name of Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Samsung 64GB Mobile Phone 20 Nos 15,000 1,00,000
H
ED
LE
Table 6.43
R
To record the transaction of table 6.43, in the books of account, first ensure that the required
U
IM
Stock Item
6 -S
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Items > Under Single Stock Item
00
> Create
00
Activity: In F11: Company Features >F2: Inventory Features > Enable the option Maintain
multiple Godowns
195
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Godown
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Godowns > Create
Bengaluru Location
Allow storage of materials: This option is used for deciding whether storage of materials is
R
allowed in this Godown or not. This option will appear only if the option Allow advanced
AI
entries in master is enabled in F12: Configuration, while creating stock items. If the option
N
is not visible, then by default this option will be set to Yes.
AN
Our Stock with Third Party: Set this option to Yes, if the godown is used to account the
AR
company's goods lying with the third party.
H
Third Party Stock with us: Set this option to Yes, if the godown created is used to account
ED
the goods received from third party and the stock of third party should not affect the company
stock value.
LE
Table 6.45
R
Delhi Location
U
IM
Table 6.46
6
00
196
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To record the Stock Journal voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Alt+F7: Stock Journal
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 15-06-2018
3. Select Samsung 64GB Mobile Phone under Name of Item from the List of Items,
which needs to be transferred under Source(Consumption)
4. Select the Godown as Bengaluru Location from the List of Godowns
5. Enter Quantity as 20 Nos, Rate ₹ 15,000 and the Amount ₹ 3, 00,000 will capture
automatically.
6. Press Enter
7. Select Samsung 64GB Mobile Phone under Name of Item from the List of Items, to
R
AI
which goods are being transferred under Destination (Production).
8. Select the Godown as Delhi Location from the List of Godowns
N
9. Enter Quantity as 20 Nos, Rate ₹ 15,000 and the amount ₹ 3, 00,000 will get captured
AN
automatically
AR
10. Enter the Narration
H
ED
The completed Stock Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.48:
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
197
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Example: If KRA Traders has 80 Nos of Samsung 64GB Mobile Phones as on 15-06-2018 in
Bengaluru Location godown and. On 20-06-2018, while physically counting it was found that the
stock in Bengaluru was 75 Nos.
In the above scenario, stock recorded in books of accounts is 80 Nos and while physically counting
the stock was 75 Nos. Remaining 5 Nos of stock, there is a shortage in Bengaluru Location godown
found during Physical verification should be accounted in the books of accounts.
Considering the above example, will illustrate the same in Tally, using Physical Stock Voucher.
Illustration 24: Recording a Physical Stock Voucher in Tally.ERP 9
R
Pass the following transactions in the book of KRA Traders:
AI
20-06-2018 Voucher: Physical Stock
N
AN
Physical Verification done on 20-06-2018 and found that there is only 75 Nos
AR
of Samsung 64GB Mobile Phones in Bengaluru Location.
H
Name of Item Godown Quantity
Samsung 64GB Mobile
ED
Bengaluru Location 75 Nos
LE
Phones
R
Table 6.48
U
To record the Physical Stock Voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
FF
TE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Alt+F10: Physical Stock Voucher
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 20-06-2018
-S
The completed Physical Stock Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 6.49
8
11
21
R
198
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 6.49 Physical Stock Voucher Creation Screen
H
6. Accept the screen
The physical stock entry will affect in Stock Summary, Physical Stock Register and all ED
LE
Inventory Reports.
R
U
To view a Stock Summary Report to display the physical stock values in the particular godown,
FF
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary> Press F9: Inventory Reports > Select
TE
Godown Summary.
2. Press F2:Period and enter the required period
6 -S
199
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. Press Enter on Bengaluru Location
4. Press Enter on Samsung 64GB Mobile Phone
Samsung 64GB Mobile Phone Stock Quantity displays 45 Nos as shown in the figure 6.51
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
200
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: Physical Stock quantity will be displayed as actual stock in the Stock Summary from the date of entry of the
Physical Stock.
R
To view a Physical Stock Register Report,
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display> Inventory Books > Physical Stock Register >
N
Press Enter on June month transaction
AN
The Physical Stock Voucher Register screen appears as shown in the figure 6.53:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
Conclusion
In this chapter we have learnt, how day-to-day business transactions are recorded in Tally.ERP
9. The instant report generation feature of Tally makes it possible to check out the impact of each
transaction in the books of a business concern and helps in tracking the status of inventory and
movement of goods, leading to efficient logistics and supply chain management.
201
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Key Takeaways
A voucher is a document containing the details of a financial transaction.
Any transaction indicating the transfer of funds from cash account to cash account, cash
account to bank account; bank account to cash account and bank account to bank account
is referred to as a Contra Entry.
In Tally.ERP 9, a Payment Voucher is used to record all transactions involving payments
made by cash or bank.
In Tally.ERP 9, a Receipt Voucher is used to record transactions involving receipt of cash
and through bank.
R
In Tally.ERP 9, a Sales Voucher is used to record entries when the company sells some
AI
goods to the customers either by cash, cheque or on credit basis.
N
In Tally.ERP 9, a Credit Note entry is passed to account for return of goods sold, generally
AN
issued by the seller to the buyer.
In Tally.ERP 9, a Purchase Voucher is used when a company purchases some goods from
AR
its suppliers on cash, cheque or credit basis.
In Tally.ERP 9, a Debit Note entry is passed for purchase returns or for any change in
H
ED
price consideration
You can generate Proforma Invoice in Tally.ERP 9, generally issued by the seller to buyer
LE
as an estimated invoice.
R
You can account Non-Accounting vouchers in Tally, which are used for provisions.
U
You can account all inventory vouchers, Receipt Note, Delivery Note, Rejection in and
IM
Shortcut Keys
-S
202
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To access a Debit Note Voucher
Alt+F9 From inventory voucher creation screen
To access a Receipt Note Voucher
Alt+F8 From inventory voucher creation screen
To access a Delivery Note Voucher
Alt+F7 From inventory voucher creation screen
To access a Stock Journal Voucher
Alt+F6 From inventory voucher creation screen
To access a Rejections In Voucher
Ctrl+F6 From inventory voucher creation screen
R
To access a Rejections Out Voucher
AI
Ctrl+L From accounting voucher creation/alteration screen
N
To make any voucher as Optional
AN
Ctrl+F10 From accounting voucher creation screen
To access Memorandum Voucher
AR
Alt+P From accounting voucher creation/alteration screen
H
or any reports from Tally.
ED
To Print any invoice or reports
LE
R
U
Practise Exercises
IM
FF
TE
2. Tally has eliminated the need to first record routine transactions in a journal. In Tally.ERP
8
a. Adjusting entries
21
203
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Nandini Joshi started Universal Solutions by bringing in cash of ₹ 150,000. The correct
journal entry for the transaction is:
a. Cash Dr. 150,000; To Nandini Joshi Capital A/c Cr. 150,000
b. Bank Dr. 150,000; To Cash A/c Cr. 15,0000
c. Nandini Joshi Capital Dr. 150,000; To Cash A/c Cr. 15,0000
d. Nandini Joshi Capital Dr. 150,000; To Bank A/c Cr. 15,0000
R
AI
a. Record a receipt voucher entry
b. Record a payment voucher
N
c. Record a contra Voucher
AN
d. Record no voucher entry as it is not an accounting transaction
AR
H
6. Match the following transactions against the appropriate voucher details:
1 Made a payment of ₹ 15,000 to Sundry a ED
Debit Note Voucher
LE
Creditors.
R
RK Vendors.
IM
a. True
b. False
R
8. In case of credit sales return, debit the Sales Ledger and credit the Party Ledger/Sundry
Debtors Ledger.
a. True
b. False
204
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9. In case of a Provision entry for expense, Debit the expense ledger and credit the Provision
for Expense Ledger.
a. True
b. False
R
AI
11. Referring to the screenshot shown in the figure 6.29, which of the following entry is being
recorded?
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
205
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 7
Accounts Receivable and Payable
Management
Learning Objectives
R
AI
N
Maintain party-wise bill details in Tally.ERP 9
AN
Keeping track of receivables and payables
Set-off bills using the different methods of adjustment
AR
Make partial and full payment entries
H
Record credit transactions, and
Manage outstanding
ED
LE
Credit limit
Payment performance of debtors.
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
206
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
7.1 Introduction
Efficient management of business requires systematic maintenance of all transactions. As the
number of business transactions increases, it becomes very difficult in keeping a track of the details
of creditors, debtors, pending bills and over dues. The bill-wise details feature in Tally.ERP 9
enables tracking of each and every transaction and efficient management of payables and
receivables.
R
or services provided on credit. Accounts Payable is credited in the books of account and it is
AI
reported as current liability in the company’s balance sheet.
N
Example: Bay Traders purchased goods on credit for ₹10,000 from TT Traders on 1st July 2017
AN
and agreed to pay the amount on 15th July 2017. Bay Traders receives an invoice from TT Traders
AR
stating that the amount of ₹10,000 is due on 15th July 2017.
H
After checking the invoice, Bay Traders will record the details in their books of accounts by
ED
debiting the expense account/purchase account and crediting the accounts payable
account/sundry creditors account.
LE
R
Accounts Receivable: Accounts Receivable is the amount due from customers to the business
U
concern for goods sold or services rendered. Accounts Receivables are debited in the books of
IM
Example: Bay Traders sold goods on credit for ₹20,000 to Shabnam Traders on 1st July 2017. The
customer is allowed a credit period of 30 days to pay for the purchases.
TE
-S
Bay Traders will issue the invoice to Shabnam Traders stating that the payments have to be made
within 30 days from the date of purchase i.e., Payment should be made on or before 30th July 2017.
6
00
Once the invoice is issued, Bay Traders will account the entry in their books of account by debiting
00
the accounts receivable account/sundry debtors account and crediting the income account/sales
Account.
8 86
11
The Bill-wise details feature in Tally.ERP 9 enables tracking of transactions and efficient
management of payables and receivables. Once transactions are recorded in Tally.ERP 9, reports
can be generated instantaneously. This feature, helps in tracking outstanding bills and in sending
reminders on time to customers, thus managing outstandings efficiently.
Bill-wise detail help us to maintain our sundry creditors and debtors bills systematically and we can
find the outstanding amount, due date of each bill and also we can allocate payments/receipts to
the correct invoice to maintain an accurate account of outstanding.
207
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Dependency on business owner reduces as user can refer the outstandings statement and know if
he is liable to pay or receive. Without Bill wise, tracking pending bills will be difficult to user. This
will result in adjusting wrong bill.
In Tally.ERP 9, four types of reference details can be entered for transactions. These reference
details, called Methods of Adjustments are New Ref, Agst Ref, Advance and On Account.
R
with which it can be tracked when required.
AI
N
If we are making sales/purchase to the party for the first time,
New Ref select New Ref
AN
For example, if two purchase vouchers are recorded with the
AR
New Reference numbers 01 and 02, while recording the payment
H
entry, the reference numbers will help in keeping track of the
ED
purchase against which payments are being made.
LE
When payment is received or made against any existing bill or
R
against earlier advance, select Against ref for which the bill should
U
be adjusted.
IM
will be able to track the particular purchase bill towards which the
payment is being made, and also you will get the list of purchases.
6 -S
On Account For Example, when the party makes lump sum payment (a huge
R
Table 7.1
Creating a reference is like writing down an entry in a notebook to use the references in future.
References remember on your behalf keeps the track of due payments/receipts. To distinguish
between references you need to give unique reference numbers.
Let us now use the method of adjustments in transactions to understand them better:
208
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Business Scenario
Bay Traders, Bengaluru deals in food items like Rice, Wheat flour, Ragi and Cooking oil. The
company makes frequent credit purchases and ensures that all payments are made within the due
date. It makes sales on credit basis to different dealer with the credit period of thirty days provided
to all debtors.
Before proceeding with the illustrations on using the bill-wise details feature, based on the above
Business Scenario, let us create the company in Tally.ERP 9 and activate the bill-wise details feature
for the company.
R
Activity: Create a company in Tally.ERP 9 with the following details:
AI
N
Company Name: Bay Traders
AN
Address: No 123, 5th Block, Near Jambu Circle, Jayanagar, Bengaluru - 560041
AR
Country: India
H
State: Karnataka
Financial Year: 01-04-2017 to 31-03-2018 ED
LE
Feature
IM
FF
In order to track the details of bills payable and receivable, the feature bill-wise details has to be
enabled in Tally.ERP 9.
TE
To enable the feature maintain bill-wise details in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
-S
Note: Bill wise details for non-trading accounts is useful when one needs to track either an instalment to be paid
8
11
209
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.1 Accounting Features Screen
H
4. Accept the screen
ED
LE
Note: On after configuring Maintain bill wise details option as shown in the figure 7.1,, then Maintain
R
U
balances bill-by-bill will be enabled by default in all the ledgers created under the groups sundry debtors and
IM
When a purchase/sales invoice is recorded, New Reference is selected to give the transaction a
-S
For example, if two purchase vouchers are recorded with New reference numbers as 01 and 02,
00
then while recording a payment entry, the reference numbers will help to keep a track of purchase,
00
Illustration 1: Use of new reference for recording purchase and sale transactions and
8
Date Particulars
01-07-2017 Voucher: Purchase
Purchased following stock items from the Saha Traders on credit against the Ref
No. ST/01 and agreed to pay the amount within 15 Days from the date of
purchase.
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Basmati 455 (W) 500 Kgs 100 50,000
210
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Basmati 455 (B) 500 Kgs 110 55,000
Dehradooni Basmati (W) 1,000 Kgs 100 1,00,000
R
AI
Basmati 455 (B) 250 Kgs 120 30,000
N
AN
Table 7.2
AR
To record the transactions of table 7.2 in the books of Bay Traders, first ensure that the required
H
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
ED
LE
Purchase Ledger
R
U
Purchase A/c
FF
Table 7.3
8 86
Sales Ledger
11
Sales A/c
21
R
Table 7.4
Party Ledger
211
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Saha Traders
R
AI
Inventory values are effected? Set to No
N
Maintain balances bill-by-bill option should be enabled for tracking pending bills. If the option is
AN
disabled, it will not be possible to track bills while making or receiving payments.
AR
Default credit period: Enter the due date i.e., the credit days allowed by the supplier to make the
H
payment. If the credit period is left blank then while recording the entry enter the credit period.
ED
Check for credit days during voucher entry: By setting this option to Yes, you can keep track of
LE
the credit period allowed to parties, payables to Sundry Creditors and receivables from Sundry Debtors.
R
U
Table 7.5
IM
FF
M M Traders
TE
212
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Basmati 455 (W)
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Basmati 455 (W)
Under Select as Primary
Units Select as Kgs ( Press Alt+C to create the
Unit of Measure)
Table 7.7
R
AI
Basmati 455 (B)
N
AN
Against the Field Action to be Performed
AR
Name Enter as Basmati 455 (B)
H
Under Select as Primary
Units
ED Select as Kgs
LE
Table 7.8
R
U
IM
Table 7.9
86
Note: Can create the stock item at one go from Multi Stock Item menu
8
11
Note: If the option Use defaults for bill allocations is set to Yes, you will not be able to track bills or
check bill-wise details
5. Enter the Supplier Invoice No. as ST/01 and the date will capture automatically.
6. In the Party A/c name field select Saha Traders
213
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
7. In the Purchase ledger field select Purchase A/c ledger.
Note: Once the cursor moves to purchase ledger field, if the purchase ledger is not appearing then alter the purchase
ledger and make sure the option Inventory values are affected is set to Yes.
8. Under Name of Item field, select Basmati 455(W), and enter the quantity as 500 Kgs,
rate as ₹ 100 per Kgs and the amount ₹ 50,000 will capture automatically.
9. Press Enter and select the second stock item, Basmati 455 (B)and enter the quantity as
500 Kgs, rate as ₹ 110 per Kgs and the amount ₹ 55,000 will capture automatically
10. Press Enter and select the third stock item, Dehradooni Basmati (W) and enter the
quantity as 1,000 Kgs, rate as ₹ 100 per Kgs and the amount ₹ 1,00,000 will capture
R
automatically
AI
11. Select End of List twice and then the total amount field will get selected
N
12. Press Enter to get the Bill-wise Details screen and fill the details given below:
AN
In the Type of Ref field select New Ref.
AR
In the Name field by default the Supplier Invoice number will be shown, change
it, if required
H
In the Due Date, or Credit Days field the credit days and date will be filled
ED
automatically. It is the credit period which you have entered while creating the
LE
party ledger
The amount will be captured automatically
R
U
Note: By default, the amount will be credited, because as per the accounting rule Account Payables are
IM
credited.
FF
TE
The Bill-wise Details screen for Saha Traders appears as shown in the figure 7.2:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
214
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: If the screen of figure 7.2 is not appearing press F12: Configure from the voucher creation screen and
set the option Use default for bill allocation to No
14. Enter the narration in Narration field.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
After recording the purchase transaction, the details are reflected in the bills payable report as the
-S
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings > Payables
86
215
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.4 Bills Payable/ Outstanding Report
H
ED
The report of figure 7.4, gives you the details of total bills payable to all suppliers along with
LE
transaction details like date, ref. no, party name, pending amount and overdue by days.
R
The total amount payable by the company is ₹2, 05,000 which is payable to Saha Traders.
U
IM
6. You will get the Party Details screen, enter the despatch details, order details and buyer
00
8. Under Name of Item field, select Basmati 455(W), and enter the quantity as 250 Kgs,
8
rate as ₹ 110 per Kgs and the amount ₹ 27,500 will capture automatically.
11
9. Press Enter and select the second stock item, Basmati 455 (B)and enter the quantity as
21
250 Kgs, rate as ₹ 120 per Kgs and the amount ₹ 30,000 will capture automatically
R
10. Select End of List twice and then the total amount field will get selected
11. Press Enter to get the Bill-wise Details screen and fill the details given below:
In the Type of Ref field select New Ref.
In the Name field, enter as BA/01/MM
In the Due Date, or Credit Days field the credit days and date will be filled
automatically. It is the credit period which you have entered while creating the
party ledger
The amount will be captured automatically
Note: By default, the amount will be debited, because as per the accounting rule Account Receivables are debited.
216
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Bill-wise Details Screen for M M Traders appears as shown in the figure 7.5:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 7.5 Bill-wise Details Screen for M M Traders
LE
R
Note: If the screen of figure 7.5 is not appearing press F12: Configure from the voucher creation screen and
set the option Use default for bill allocation to No
FF
217
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
14. Accept the screen
After recording the sales transactions as shown in figure 7.6, the details are reflected in the bills
receivables report because the customer has not yet made any payment to the company.
To check the Bills Receivable/Outstanding report:
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings > Receivables
Press Alt+F1 to view the report in detailed mode.
The Bills Receivables /Outstanding Report appears as shown in the figure 7.7:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
The report of figure 7.7, gives the details of Total Bills Receivables from the customers. It also
00
displays the transaction details like date , ref. no, party name, pending amount and overdue by
00
days.
86
This method of adjustment is used to track an existing transaction, which is already tagged with a
reference number. It helps in recording a payment voucher by selecting the reference number
against which the payment is made.
Illustration 2: Use of against reference for recording partial and full payment & receipt
transactions and checking of payable and receivable report.
Pass the following transactions in the book of Bay Traders:
Date Particulars
218
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
16-07-2017 Voucher: Payment
Made a partial payment of ₹1, 05,000 to Saha Traders against the reference
number ST/01. The payment is made through Kotak Bank.
01-08-2017 Voucher: Receipt
Received a Kotak cheque of ₹57,500 from MM Traders against the Bill
reference number BA/01/MM
Table 7.10
To record the transactions of table 7.10, in the books of Bay Traders, first ensure that the required
R
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AI
N
Activity: Create Kotak Mahindra Bank ledger and provide debit opening balance of ₹5, 00,000
AN
AR
Step 1: Recording Payment Transaction (Single Entry Mode)
H
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F5: Payment
ED
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 16-07-2017
3. Press F12: Configure and set the option Use single entry mode for
LE
payment/receipt/contra vouchers? to Yes. Again press F12: Advanced and enable
R
Note: If the option- Use single entry mode for payment/receipt/contra vouchers? Is set to No,
FF
then the payment voucher will appear in the Debit and Credit mode (i.e., double entry mode).
TE
6. You will get the Bill-wise Details screen for Saha Traders with the details filled as given
00
below:
00
You will get the Pending Bills screen, which shows the total pending bills payable
8
to Saha Traders along with the Reference name and Date details.
11
219
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.8 Bill-wise Details Screen with Against Reference
H
Press Enter and accept the Bill wise Details screen ED
LE
R
7. In the Bank Allocation screen, Transaction Type select as Cheque, and the amount will
U
be captured automatically. Enter the cheque number in the Inst no. field and cheque
IM
220
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
After making payment, check the Bills Payable/Outstanding report.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings >
Payables > press Alt+F1 to view the report in detailed mode.
2. Change the period as 01-07-2017 to 01-08-2017.
The Bills Payable/Outstanding report appears as shown in the figure 7.10:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
In the report of figure 7.10, we will observe that the bill in the name of Saha Traders with Reference
TE
number as ST/01 shows 1, 05,000 instead of 2,05,000, because we have made a partial payment
-S
to Saha Traders.
6
3. Press F12: Configure and set the option Use single entry mode for
8
11
5. Under the Particulars field, select the party ledger from the List of Accounts from whom
R
221
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Bill-wise Details screen appears as shown in the figure 7.11:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 7.11 Bill-wise Details Screen with Against Reference
LE
R
Note: If the Bill-wise Details screen is not displayed on selecting the party ledger, Press F12: Configure
FF
twice and enable the option-Pre Allocate bills for payments/receipt/journal voucher in the
Payment Advanced Configuration> General Options.
TE
7. In the Bank Allocation screen, Transaction Type select as Cheque/DD, and the amount
-S
will be captured automatically. Enter the cheque date in the Inst date field and select the
6
Bank to which the received Cheque belongs to, and accept the screen.
00
222
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.12 Receipt Voucher Screen
H
9. Accept the Screen
After receiving payment from customer, check the Bills Receivables/Outstanding report.
ED
LE
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings > Receivables
R
> In the bills receivable report, you will observe that of MM Traders with Reference number
U
BA/01/MM is not visible. This is because payment has been received from MM Traders.
IM
FF
The term Advance means income received in advance or payments made in advance by the
-S
company. Income received in advance will not be considered as income until the goods are
6
delivered or services are rendered, as per accrual concept. Hence, all advance payments received
00
will be considered as liabilities and all advance payments made will be considered as assets.
00
Accrual Concept of Accounting: Under this concept, revenues are considered as income when
86
the goods are delivered or services are rendered before collection of cash. If the cash is collected
8
before rendering the service or delivering the goods, then the cash collected will not be considered
11
as income earned.
21
For Example: Assume Bay Traders, who deal in food products, receive advance/down payment
R
of 20% from customers before selling the goods to them, and agree to deliver the goods within 10
days of receiving the advance payment.
As per the Accrual Concept, Bay Traders cannot show advance payment collected as revenue
earned because the goods are not delivered to the customer. Only after the goods are delivered to
the customer the revenue is considered as earned.
This method, helps in arriving at correct information about the profits earned by a company.
Similarly, whenever advance payments are made by the company to its suppliers, it is not
considered as an expense incurred, until the goods or services are received.
223
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
In Tally.ERP 9, you can record advance receipts and payments by selecting the Method of
adjustment as Advance. You can also check the reports related to advance payments/receipts.
Illustration 3: Use of advance reference for recording advance receipts and payment
transactions and checking of outstanding reports
Pass the following transactions in the book of Bay Traders:
Date Particulars
01-08-2017 Voucher: Receipt
Received advance payment of ₹2,200 from Superior Traders against Bill No.
R
Adv/SUT/01
AI
N
11-08-2017 Voucher: Sales
AN
Sold the following Stock Items on credit to Superior Traders with Invoice no
BA/02/SUT, where 20% of advance payment was made for this bill and agreed
AR
to pay rest of the amount after 10 days.
H
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
against Bill No. Adv/ST/01. The supplier has agreed to supply the Goods after
TE
10 days.
6 -S
Purchased the following Stock Items on credit from Saha Traders with Supplier
00
invoice no. ST/03. Advance payment of ₹20,000 was made for this bill and
86
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
21
Table 7.11
To record the transactions of table 7.11 in the books of Bay Traders, first ensure that the required
ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Party Ledger
Superior Traders
224
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Against the field Action to be performed
R
AI
Default credit period: It can be entered at the time of creating the master or while recording the
N
transaction.
AN
Table 7.12
AR
H
Step 2: Recording Receipt Transaction (Single Entry Mode)
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F6: Receipt ED
LE
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 01-08-2017
R
4. Under the Particulars field, select the party ledger from the List of Accounts from
IM
5. You will get the Bill-wise Details screen for Superior Traders with the details filled as
given below:
TE
225
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.13 Bill-wise Details Screen with Advance Reference
H
ED
Press Enter and accept the Bill wise Details screen
6. In the Bank Allocation screen, Transaction Type select as Cheque/DD, and the
LE
amount will be captured automatically. Enter the cheque date in the Inst date field and
R
select the Bank to which the received Cheque belongs to, and accept the screen.
U
226
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings >
Group > Sundry Debtors
2. Change the Period as 01-07-2017 to 01-08-2017
The Group Outstandings report appears as shown in the figure 7.15:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
In the report of figure 7.15, we can observe that the Superior Traders bill amount appears in the
FF
credit column. This is because the Advance payment received from Superior Traders is not
TE
considered as earned income till the goods are delivered as per Accrual Concept of
Accounting. Hence, it is considered as a Liability.
-S
Note: The advance payment entry will be shown in the Bills Payable/Outstanding Report, because the
6
00
From the Group Outstandings press Enter on Superior Traders entry line and use the Alt+F1
86
227
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.16 Ledger Outstandings Screen
H
The report of figure 7.16, displays the details of advance received from Superior Traders.
Step 3: Recording Sales Transaction. ED
LE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Sales
R
5. You will get the supplementary details screen, enter the despatch details, order
TE
7. Under Name of Item field, select Dehradooni Basmati Rice (W), and enter the quantity
6
as 100 Kgs, rate as ₹ 110 per Kgs and the amount ₹ 11,000 will capture automatically.
00
8. Select End of List twice and then the total amount field will get selected
00
9. Press Enter to get the Bill-wise Details screen and fill the details given below:
86
In Type of Ref field, select Against Ref. (Against reference is being selected while
8
recording this sales transaction, as advance payment has been made for this sales.
11
You will get the list of pending bills to adjust, select bill no. Adv/SUT/01 and
press Enter
R
By default, the amount field reflects the total amount as 11,000. Manually change
the amount to ₹ 2,200 Dr (as the total advance paid is ₹ 2,200), and press Enter
to adjust the remaining amount.
In the Type of Ref field select New Ref, for the remaining amount; in the Name
field enter the reference number as BA/02/SUT
In the Due Date, or Credit Days field enter 10 Days (because while creating the
party ledger you had not entered the credit period).
Now, the Amount field will reflect the remaining amount of ₹ 8,800 i.e., ₹ 11,000
(Total bill amount) – ₹ 2,200 (Advance received) =₹ 8,800 (Amount receivable)
228
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Bill-wise Details screen for Superior Traders appears as shown in the figure 7.17:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 7.17 Bill-wise Details Screen for Superior Traders
10. Press Enter and save the Bill-wise Details screen
ED
LE
11. Enter the Narration
R
229
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings > Ledger >
Select Superior Traders >Press Alt+F1: Detailed
The Ledger Outstanding Report appears as shown in the figure 7.19:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 7.19 Ledger Outstandings Report
R
The report of figure 7.19 shows ₹ 8,800 as outstanding from Superior Traders, instead of ₹
U
₹11,000, as the advance amount received from them has been adjusted the pending bill.
IM
In Tally.ERP 9, after an advance amount is adjusted, the outstanding report is generated with
FF
Date Particulars
00
Made an advance payment of ₹20,000 to Saha Traders with the Bill No. Adv/ST/01
8
11
before making purchase; the supplier has agreed to supply the Goods after 10 days
21
Table 7.13
Open the Sundry Creditors Group Outstanding report and check whether the amount is reflected
in the debit or credit column. The amount should appear under debit column because we have
paid the amount in advance.
230
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
22-08-2017 Voucher: Purchase
Purchased the following Stock Items on credit from Saha Traders with the Supplier invoice no.
ST/02. Advance payment of ₹20,000 was made for this bill and agreed to pay the rest of the
amount after 10 Days.
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
R
AI
Hint: In order to change the due date, which is defined at the time of creating the party ledger,
N
enable the option Allow modification of all fields during entry to Yes
AN
Table 7.14
AR
Open the Ledger Outstandings report of Saha Traders and check the pending amount for bill no.
ST/02 and the total outstanding against this party should show as 1, 02,000
H
7.8 On Account ED
LE
On Account method of adjustment is selected when you are unable to mark a payment or a receipt
R
against any specific pending references. This method is selected whenever a lump sum amount is
U
paid or received and not able to mark against any previous pending bills.
IM
FF
Illustration 4: Use of on account for recording receipt and payment transactions and
TE
Date Particulars
00
Sold the following stock items on credit to Ashok Traders with the Ref No.
8
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
R
231
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
23-08-2017 Voucher: Sales
Sold the following stock items on credit to Ashok Traders with the Ref No.
BA/04/AT and agreed to pay the amount within 10 days of purchase
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
R
AI
Sold the following stock items on credit to Ashok Traders with the Ref No.
SA/05/AT and agreed to pay the amount within 10 days of purchase
N
AN
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
AR
Multigrain flour 50 Kgs 70 3,500
H
ED
LE
30-08-2017 Voucher: Receipt
R
Received ₹10,000 from Ashok Traders for pending bills but specific pending bill
U
Table 7.15
FF
To record the transactions of table 7.15, in the books of Bay Traders, first ensure that the required
TE
Party Ledger
00
Ashok Traders
86
232
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 7.16
Step 2: Creation of Inventory Masters
Activity: Create a stock item by name Multigrain flour and enter the opening balance of 100 quantity and rate
as ₹60.
Step 3: Recording Sales Transactions
Activity: Create the necessary masters and record all the sales transactions given in table 7.15(refer to illustration
no. 4 for guidance)
Recording of Receipt Transaction (Single Entry Mode)
R
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F6: Receipt
N
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 30-08-2017
AN
3. In the Account field, select Kotak Mahindra Bank
4. Under the Particulars field, select the party ledger from the List of Accounts from whom
AR
the payment is received, i.e., Ashok Traders
5. You will get the Bill-wise Details screen for Ashok Traders with the details filled as
H
ED
given below:
In the Type of Ref field select On Account. (On Account type of reference has
LE
been selected, as we do not have information about the bill (Bill No. BA/03/AT,
R
BA/04/AT or BA/05/AT) against which the payment has been made by Ashok
U
Traders.
IM
Note: If you select Against Reference, you will get all the pending bills of Ashok Traders.
FF
233
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Press Enter and save the Bill wise Details screen
6. In the Bank Allocation screen, Transaction Type select as Cheque/DD, and the amount
will be captured automatically. Enter the cheque date in the Inst date field and select the
Bank to which the received cheque belongs to and accept the screen
7. Enter the Narration
The Receipt Voucher screen appears as shown in the figure 7.21:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
After receiving payment from the customer, let us check the Ledger Outstanding report.
6
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Outstandings > Ledger >
00
Ashok Traders
00
The Ledger Outstandings Report will appear as shown in the figure 7.22:
8 86
11
21
R
234
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.22 Ledger Outstandings Report of Ashok Traders
H
The report of figure 7.22, displays the total outstandings of Ashok Traders. Here we can observe
that the on account balances are also considered for calculating the outstanding amount.
ED
LE
R
U
Credit Limit refers to the monetary limit agreed upon with the seller and the buyer of a business,
FF
for trading purposes. In Tally.ERP 9 credit limits can be specified for any ledger account falling
under the groups Sundry Debtors and Sundry Creditors. Credit Limits can also be defined for
TE
sundry creditors for the reason that there may be a two-way trade between the parties i.e., you may
-S
Setting credit limits will help in restricting invoicing for the customers or parties exceeding the
00
prescribed credit limits and thereby facilitating better and effective control of the outstanding.
86
Example: Bay Traders has set the credit limit of ₹50,000 to M M Traders. As on 1st September
8
11
2017, Bay Traders sold goods on credit for ₹40,000 to M M Traders; and on 5th September 2017
21
making a sale for ₹15,000. Bay Traders will not be able to make sales and generate sales bill because
of exceeding the credit limit. The M M Traders is allowed a credit limit upto ₹50,000 and if the
R
235
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Accounting Features screen appears as shown in the figure 7.23:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 7.23 Accounting Features Screen
LE
3. Accept the screen
R
U
Note: On accepting the option - Maintain budgets and controls to Yes, in all the ledgers created
IM
under the groups’ sundry debtors and sundry creditors the option – Specify credit limit will be available.
FF
TE
You can set credit limits for party ledger accounts at the time of ledger creation or from the
6
To set Credit Limits for single ledger account, follow the steps given below:
86
3. In the Ledger Alteration screen, specify the credit limit as ₹ 50,000 in the Specify credit
R
limit field
236
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.24 Party Ledger Alteration Screen
H
4. Accept the screen
ED
LE
Note: We can set the credit limit for multiple ledgers falling under the group sundry debtors or creditors or branch
R
division at once. To do so, Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledgers > Under Multiple
U
Note: Credit limit option will appear only if the option Provide advance information in masters is enabled in F12:
Configure.
TE
During invoice or order entry, if the credit limit amount is exceeded, then on accepting the
6
00
voucher, Tally.ERP 9 prompts the user with an error message displaying the amount exceeding
the credit limit specified.
00
86
Illustration 5: Checking of credit limit exceeded message while recording sales voucher.
8
Date Particulars
21
R
237
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
02-09-2017 Voucher: Sales
Sold the following Stock Items on credit to M M Traders with the Ref No.
BA/07/MM
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Table 7.17
R
Activity: Record the sales transaction which is shown in table 7.17.
AI
N
Note: In the above two transactions as shown in figure 7.17, the total amount is ₹ 50,000. I.e. the party has
AN
completely utilised the collocated credit limit.
AR
Date Particulars
H
05-09-2017 Voucher: Sales
ED
Sold the following Stock Items on credit to M M Traders with the Ref No.
LE
BA/08/MM
R
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
U
IM
Table 7.18
TE
Note: While recording the entry of table 7.18, you will get the following error message as shown in the figure 7.25.
6 -S
The Sales Invoice screen with credit limit error appears as shown in the figure 7.25:
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
238
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
In order to complete the entry, either:
The significance of setting credit limits is that during voucher entry (or invoicing), the credit limit
is displayed for the selected ledger along with current balance to help ascertain the amount
permitted or acceptable.
R
Transactions which do not affect the accounting or inventory balances are excluded from the
AI
application of credit limitations.
N
In Tally.ERP 9, Sales Order can be entered for a party with the value exceeding the credit limit set
AN
for the selected debtor.
AR
In this case Tally.ERP 9 will display a warning message as shown in the figure 7.26:
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
However, sales order can be saved with the existing order value even though the message is
8
239
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.27 Ratio Analysis Report Screen
H
2. Select Recv. Turnover in days (It shows the amount of sales locked up with debtors in
terms of sales days)
ED
LE
3. Press Enter to view the list of Sundry Debtors
R
U
figure 7.28:
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
5. Click F1: Detailed to display the report in detailed mode as shown in the figure 7.29:
240
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.29 Ledger Payment Performance - Detailed
H
ED
The Ledger Payment Performance report gives the details of all invoices raised on the debtor
and the dates when the payments were made, with the analysis of delays.
LE
R
The Ledger Performance Report can also be viewed from ledger vouchers screen. From Gateway
U
of Tally > Display >Accounts Books > Ledger > Select M M Traders> Press F2: Period and
IM
enter the period from 01-04-2017 to 02-06-2017 >Press F8: Related Reports > Select Ledger
Payment Performance.
FF
In this company, you have seen transactions being recorded for the financial year 01-04-2017 to
00
31-03-2018. Now, assume that you have completed recording transactions for the financial year
2017-18 and now want to record the transactions for the new financial year 2018-19.
86
Note: Financial Year is the year in which you will earn the income and the Assessment Year is the year in
8
11
Date Particulars
241
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
15-11-2017 Voucher: Sales
Sold the following Stock Items on credit to Ashok Traders on cash with the Reference no.
BA/08/AT
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
R
Sold the following Stock Items on credit to Ashok Traders on cash with the Reference no.
AI
BA/09/AT
N
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
AN
AR
Basmati 455 (B) 50 Kgs 120 6,000
H
01-04-2018 Voucher: Sales
ED
LE
Sold the following Stock Items on credit to Ashok Traders on cash with the Reference no.
R
BA/10/AT
U
Name of the Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
IM
FF
Table 7.19
6 -S
Observation: Once you change the date to 01-04-2018, you will get an error Date cannot be above the
00
242
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.30 Change Voucher Date Screen with Error Message
H
This error appears because the financial period for Bay Traders is from 01-04-2017 to 31-03-2018
ED
and you are trying to record the entry after this period i.e., you are recording the entry for a new
financial year, and hence you not able to record the entry. To check the financial period for the
LE
company, go to Gateway of Tally screen.
R
U
The Gateway of Tally Screen with Current Financial Period appears as shown in the figure
IM
7.31:
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
243
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Change Period screen appears as shown in the figure 7.32:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 7.32 Change Period Screen
ED
3. Press Enter from the figure 7.31screen, to go back to the Gateway of Tally screen
LE
The Gateway of Tally Screen with Changed Financial Year appears as shown in the figure
R
7.33:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Conclusion
Accounts Receivables and Payables Management is a very important aspect of any business. In
Tally.ERP 9 one can keep the track of receivables and payables by using the feature Maintain bill-
244
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
wise details wherein you can define the credit limit, credit days and generate instant outstanding
reports.
Key Takeaways
Accounts Receivables are debited in the books of account and is shown as a Current Asset
in a company’s Balance Sheet.
Accounts Payables are credited in the books of account and is shown as a Current Liability
in company’s Balance Sheet.
Bill-wise Details are specified while creating vouchers to allocate payments to invoices.
The Outstandings Statements can be generated using Bill-wise Details.
R
In Tally.ERP 9, four types of reference details can be entered for transactions. These
AI
reference details, called Methods of Adjustments are New Ref, Agst Ref, Advance and On
N
Account.
AN
Advance Payment/Receipts can be adjusted to actual bills on a later date as required.
AR
On Account is the reference, which is used when the lump sum amount is paid or received
without any bill reference details
H
Setting Credit Limits will help in restricting invoicing for the customers or parties
exceeding the prescribed credit limits
ED
LE
Shortcut Keys
R
U
Practice Exercises
21
1. Account Receivables and Payables can be maintained by enabling which of the following
R
features in Tally.ERP 9?
2. Bad Debts details can be extracted from which of the following reports in Tally.ERP 9?
245
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
a. Stock Ageing Report
b. Ageing Analysis Report
c. Cost Ageing report
d. Not Available
3. Nishanth Traders purchased goods on credit for ₹ 30,000 from Vibhav Traders on 1st
August 2017 and agreed to pay the amount on 15th August 2017. In the books of
Nishanth Traders, this transaction will be recorded as __________________.
a. Accounts receivable
R
b. Accounts payable
AI
c. Bad debt
N
d. Doubtful debt
AN
AR
4. While working in Tally.ERP 9, _______________ is selected when you are unable to
H
mark a payment or a receipt against specific pending references.
a. New Reference ED
LE
b. Against Reference
R
c. Advance
U
d. On Account
IM
FF
5. The Maintain bill-wise details feature in Tally.ERP 9 enables tracking of every transaction
TE
a. Only Payables
6
00
b. Only Receivables
c. Receivables and Payables
00
d. Stock in Progress
8 86
11
6. Which of the following is the correct entry for advance payments made to Creditors?
21
7. Rajesh received a payment of ₹5000 against a pending invoice. However, he was unable
to decide against which bill the payment was received. In Tally.ERP 9, he should account
the payment as:
a. New Reference
246
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
b. Against Reference
c. Advance
d. On Account
8. Ashish Enterprises owes ₹20,000 to Vinod Traders for purchase of goods on credit. In
the Balance Sheet of Ashish Enterprises, this amount will reflected under Current
Liabilities.
a. True
b. False
R
AI
N
9. The Gateway of Tally screen shows the Current Financial Period of a company selected
AN
in Tally.ERP 9.
AR
a. True
H
b. False
ED
LE
10. In Tally.ERP 9, ledgers are created under Groups.
R
U
a. True
IM
b. False
FF
TE
11. The term ‘Advance’ refers to income received in advance or payments made in advance.
-S
a. True
6
00
b. False
00
86
12. Setting Credit Limits will help in restricting invoicing for the customers exceeding the
8
a. True
21
b. False
R
13. Given below are the types of references and a transaction of each in a jumbled format.
Match the following
Type of Reference Transactions
1 On Account A Purchase goods on credit and the payment will
be made on future date.
2 Advance B Cleared the payment for the purchases made
earlier.
247
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3 Against Reference C Before making the purchase from the supplier,
paid . 20,000 to supplier.
4 New Reference D Received a lump sum amount from the
customer and unable to mark a receipt against
specific pending references.
R
d. 1-c, 2-a, 3-d, 4-b
AI
N
AN
14. ________ is selected when you are unable to mark a payment or a receipt against specific
pending references.
AR
a. On Account
b. New Reference
H
ED
c. Against Reference
d. Advance
LE
R
U
15. This method of adjustment is used to track an existing transaction, which is already
IM
b. New Reference
TE
c. Against Reference
d. Advance
6 -S
00
16. Referring to the figure 7.34, what is the Bill-wise reference and voucher entry recorded.
00
8 86
11
21
R
248
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 7.34 Ledger Outstanding Report
H
a. On Account reference in Payment voucher ED
LE
b. Advance reference in Payment voucher
R
249
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 8
Banking
Learning Objectives
Banking payments
Configure cheque printing
R
Cheque management in Tally.ERP 9
AI
Print cash and cheque deposit slips
N
Print payment advice
AN
Perform bank reconciliation
AR
Record post-dated cheque
H
Activate auto bank reconciliation
ED
Auto bank reconciliation in Tally.ERP 9
E-payments in Tally.ERP 9
LE
Check e-payments reports
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
250
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8.1 Introduction
Banking Module has been enhanced in Tally.ERP 9 to simplify the overall banking experience,
recording transactions and generating various banking reports. The Banking Module focuses on
managing and streamlining banking transactions and activities
Cheque Printing
Cheque Register
Bank Reconciliation
R
Deposit Slips
AI
Payment Advice
N
AN
8.2 Banking Payments
AR
The Banking feature in Tally.ERP 9 facilitates maintenance of records and processes that are
fundamental to effective recording of accounting transactions for timely payments. This feature
H
ED
enables business owners to perform a host of bank-related activities, including payments to
parties, bank reconciliation, and cheque management. Using this feature enhances and simplifies
LE
the banking experience significantly by saving time, reducing errors, improving productivity, and
R
scaling up traceability.
U
IM
The Banking feature in Tally.ERP 9 provides an end-to-end solution to the banking needs for
running your company. You can use its e-payments capability to make timely payments to your
FF
parties, manage cheques, reconcile bank statements, and others. Tally.ERP 9's banking feature
TE
The banking transactions can be provided with bank allocation details such as the transaction
type, instrument no, date, etc. A single bank amount can also be allocated to multiple transaction
6
00
types such as Cheque/DD, Cash, Electronic Cheque, Electronic DD/PO, e-Fund Transfer,
00
For Example: Coffee Federation Ltd. purchased goods on credit for ₹10,000 from Swathik
8
Traders on 1st July 2017 and agreed to pay the amount on 15th July 2017 by cheque.
11
In this scenario, the payment is made though cheque. While making the payment to Swathik
21
Traders, for ₹10,000 the transaction type can be selected as Cheque/DD with the Cheque
R
251
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity: Create a company in Tally.ERP 9 with the following details:
Company Name: Coffee Federation Ltd.
Country: India
State: Karnataka
R
AI
1. From Gateway of Tally>F11: Company Features>F1: Accounting Features>
N
Banking features.
Set the option Enable cheque printing to Yes ( By default this option is enabled
AN
for cheque printing)
AR
Set the option Set/alter transaction types to Yes, you will get the Alteration of
Transaction Type screen
H
The Alteration of Transaction Types screen appears as shown in the figure 8.1:
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
You can include or exclude the required transaction types like ATM, Cash, and ECS etc., based
on your business needs. The Cash, Cheque, e-Fund Transfer, and Others options are enabled by
default.
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: As of now enable the options as shown in the figure 8.2
The Company Operations Alteration screen appears as shown in the figure 8.2:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 8.2 Company Operations Alteration Screen
R
A cheque is a written order to the bank to pay the stated sum of money. Cheques are usually
FF
handwritten. In order to automate the entire cheque printing process, Tally.ERP 9 allows
cheques to be printed directly.
TE
Cheques are still the most preferred payment instrument across businesses. Easy management of
-S
this form of payment adds significant value in day to day operations, and hence, effective
6
Tally ERP 9 allows creation of multiple cheque books with unique ranges for every bank in bank
ledger creation, selection of cheque ranges during voucher entry and auto cheque numbering, &
86
giving a report of the status of all the cheques in the form of cheque register.
8
11
Business Scenario
21
Coffee Federation Ltd. opens up its current account in Kotak Mahindra Bank for its business
R
banking, so that the cheque deposits and withdrawals, RTGS, NEFT transactions can happen
smoothly and also the company has received the cheque book from bank.
253
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Illustration 1: Configuration of cheque book and printing cheques from Tally.ERP 9.
Date Particulars
01-07-2017 Voucher: Contra
Coffee Federation Ltd., purchased goods for ₹ 1, 50,000 from Raj Traders on
R
credit.
AI
01-07-2017 Voucher: Payment
N
AN
Coffee Federation Ltd. made a payment for ₹ 1, 50,000 to Raj Traders.
AR
mode of payment : Cheque
H
cheque number : 000001
instrument date : 05-07-2017
ED
LE
R
Table 8.1
U
Before recording the transactions of Table 8.1., let us configure cheque book and then record the
IM
transactions.
FF
Create Kotak Mahindra bank and configure cheque book, by following the steps given below:
-S
The Bank Ledger Alteration screen appears as shown in the figure 8.3:
8
11
21
R
254
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.3 Bank Ledger Creation Screen
H
Note: ED
LE
If the IFS code in incorrect, Tally prompts the warning message "Invalid IFS Code. The IFS Code must
R
IFS code used in this chapters are for illustration purpose only.
FF
4. Once you enable the option - Set cheque books to Yes, you will get the Cheque Book
TE
Management screen
-S
The Cheque Book Management screen appears as shown in the figure 8.4
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Provide the Cheque Range for Kotak Mahindra Bank:
From Number - Enter as 000001
To Number - Enter as 000100
Number of Cheques – Captures as 100
Cheque Book Name - Enter as Kotak Cheque Book 1
Note: You can provide many number of cheque books from the same Cheque Book Management screen for the
particular bank.
The Cheque Book Management screen with cheque range appears as shown in the figure 8.5:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
6. Press Enter and Accept the Cheque Book Management screen, you will go back to
6
00
256
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.6 Ledger Creation Screen with Cheque Printing Configuration
H
ED
8. From the ledger creation screen as shown in the figure 8.6, press Enter to get the Cheque
Format Selection screen
LE
The Cheque Format Selection screen appears as shown in the figure 8.7
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note:
Internet and valid TSS (Tally Software Services) is required to get the list of banks, additionally for bank
configuration, i.e to get the cheque formats.
CTS stands for Cheque Truncation System, this was introduced on 1st April 2013, in this system physical
cheque movement is eliminated and electronic cheque is used for movement. This system is undertaken by
Reserve Bank of India.
257
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9. Select the required format and press Enter, to get the Cheque Dimensions screen
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
258
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Cheque Dimensions screen appears as shown in the figure 8.8:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.8 Cheque Dimensions Screen
H
ED
LE
R
Note:
U
IM
The cheque dimensions as shown in the figure 8.8 is the predefined dimensions as per the format which we
have selected. If required we can press Backspace and define the dimensions.
FF
We can copy the cheque dimensions from one bank to another by using the key Ctrl+C: Copy From
TE
We can compare the cheque dimensions (sample) with the actual cheque and modify accordingly to suit your
requirement. Take the bank’s cheque book and measure the dimensions of a cheque leaf carefully in
-S
millimetres using scale and fill the form. You may need to correct it after trying out a couple of cheques so
6
00
that the positioning is accurate. The placing of the cheque in the printer also determines the printing. Trials
could be made on photocopies of a cheque before using an actual cheque leaf.
00
In case of a cheque with two signatories, both can be specified (Both could be the same salutation or different,
86
e.g., the first one as Director and the second one as Secretary).
8
11
10. Enable the option Print Company Name on Cheque and accept the screen
21
The Sample Format of Cheque Selected appears as shown in the figure 8.9:
R
259
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
Figure 8.9 Sample Format of Cheque Selected
AN
11. Press Esc from figure 8.9 screen
AR
The Completed Ledger Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.10:
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
Once after configuring cheque book and cheque printing options let us record the transactions
of Table 8.1
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Activity: Create the following ledgers
Raj Traders under Sundry Creditors
Purchase of goods under Purchase Accounts
Activity: Record the following transactions
260
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Date Particulars
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
261
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-07-2017 Voucher: Contra
Coffee Federation Ltd., deposited cash of ₹ 20, 00,000 in bank.
R
To record the Payment voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
AI
N
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F5: Payment
AN
2. Click F2:Date and set the date to 01-07-2017
3. Press F12: Configure - Payment Standard Configuration, and set the option Use
AR
single entry mode for payment/receipt/ contra vouchers to Yes.
H
ED
Note: On enabling the Single Entry mode, the payment screen displays the Account field (Select the ledger
which has to be credited), Particulars field (Select the ledgers which has to be debited) and in the Amount
LE
field (Enter the amount)
R
5. Under Particulars field Select Raj Traders ledger and enter the amount, ₹1, 50,000.
6. Press Enter to get the Bill-wise Details screen and fill the details given below:
FF
In the Name field by default the Pending Bills is shown with voucher number,
-S
7. Select End of List twice and then the total amount field will get selected
8. In the Bank Allocation screen,
86
From the Bank Allocations screen, Press F12: Configure > Set the option – Show
8
11
The Configuration screen in single entry mode appears as shown in the figure 8.11:
R
262
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.11 Configuration Screen
H
ED
Accept the Configuration screen
Select Transaction Type as Cheque
LE
Amount ₹1, 50,000 will be captured automatically.
R
The Bank Allocations screen in single entry mode appears as shown in the figure 8.12:
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
263
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note:
The Cheque range and Cheque number captures automatically, because cheque book is configured
in the Cheque Book Management screen in Kotak Mahindra Bank ledger alteration.
In F12: Configure – Payment Standard Configuration screen, Use default values for
bank details to be set to No. Then only then Bank Allocation screen will appear while passing the
Payment Entry.
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.13:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
11. On accepting the Payment Voucher Creation screen, you will get the Cheque Printing
00
screen
86
The Cheque Printing Configuration screen appears as shown in the figure 8.14:
8
11
21
R
264
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
265
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 8.14 Cheque Printing Configuration Screen
12. Press Enter
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.15 Cheque Printing Screen
H
ED
Note: In F12: Configure – Payment Standard Configuration screen, Print cheque after
saving voucher; and Confirm each cheque before print to be set to Yes.
LE
Activity: On 10-07-2017, Coffee Federation Ltd. made an advance payment of ₹ 50,000 to Raj Traders.
R
U
Date Particulars
IM
Table 8.3
266
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Cheque printing feature in Tally.ERP 9, manual errors can be avoided. Tally also has provision to
select respective bank’s cheque image to identify the cheque. By doing this configurations will be
created automatically.
R
4. Press Spacebar to select the transaction for which the cheque has to be printed
AI
The Single Cheque Printing screen appears as shown in the figure 8.16:
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
Note: From Cheque Printing screen, we can alter the cheque details by pressing F7: Edit Ch. Details
8
The Cheque Print Report screen appears as shown in the figure 8.17:
11
21
R
267
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.17 Cheque Print Report Screen
H
6. Press Enter to get the Cheque Printing screen
ED
LE
7. Press Enter to get the Cheque Print
R
268
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.19 Ledger Vouchers Screen
H
4. Press Alt+F6 to get the Cheque Printing screen
ED
LE
5. Press Alt+P to get the Print Report screen.
R
The Cheque Register helps you to manage your cheque books for various banks by providing the
TE
status and values of the total number of cheques for each bank (Cheque Book wise) that are
-S
Available, Unreconciled, Reconciled, Blank, Cancelled and Post-dated. The report also gives
6
information about cheques which do not belong to any cheque range available.
00
Cheque Register maintains cheque books in systematic manner. This report gives you overall
00
bank cheque book status from one screen and also helps in tracking cheque books and also can
search status of check instantly.
8 86
Cancellation of cheques are single click from this report. Cheque Register ensures no cheque leaf
11
Using this Multi Cheque Print option, you will be able to print bulk or more number of cheques
which belongs to the same bank at one go.
269
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
270
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Record the following transactions and the instrument date is same as voucher date, the cheque s are used
from cheque book range : 000001 to 000100.
Date Particulars
20-07-2017 Voucher: Payment
Coffee Federation Ltd. made a payment for ₹ 2, 50,000 to Rajdhani Traders.
mode of payment : Cheque
R
Coffee Federation Ltd. made a payment of ₹ 25,000 to Rajdhani Traders.
AI
N
mode of payment : Cheque
AN
26-07-2017 Voucher: Payment
AR
Coffee Federation Ltd. made a payment for ₹ 15,000 to Aruna Traders.
H
mode of payment : Cheque
ED
LE
Table 8.4
R
U
IM
Create Following Cheque Book of Kotak Mahindra Bank and set the cheque range as 000101 to
FF
000200.
Hint: Alter Kotak Mahindra Bank Ledger and configure cheque book details.
TE
The Cheque Book Management screen appears as shown in the figure 8.20
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Once after recording the transactions of table 8.4, view the cheqe register by following the steps
given below:
271
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Banking > Cheque Register
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
272
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Cheque Register screen appears as shown in the figure 8.21:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 8.21 Cheque Register Screen
LE
Observation: Cheque register will display the details of total number of cheques available, unreconciled &
R
reconciled cheques, blank cheque details, cancelled cheque details and you can alter cheque book by using Alt+B
U
2. Press Enter on Kotak Mahindra Bank to view the Cheque Range Register screen The
FF
3. Further, you can press Enter on the Cheque Range to get the Instrument Wise report
The Instrument Wise Report screen appears as shown in the figure 8.23:
273
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.23 Instrument Wise Report
H
ED
Observation: In Instrument wise details screen as shown in figure 8.23, we will get the details of cheques used
LE
in transactions like instrument number, instrument date, voucher type and amount etc.,
R
Tearing a cheque leaf is nothing but cancelling the cheque. Cheques also get cancelled in many
IM
scenarios:
FF
After issuing cheque due to some reason you may make cash payment, then the cheque
TE
has to be cancelled.
Any business decision due to which cheques may get cancel.
-S
Date Particulars
21
25-07-2017 Coffee Federation Ltd. cancelled a cheque having cheque number 000010 as the
R
Table 8.5
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Instrument Wise report gets displayed, Select the Cheque no. 000010 by pressing space
bar > Press Alt+A : Alter Status to get the Cheque Status.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 8.24 Cheque Status Screen
R
The Cheque Status Update Screen appears as shown in the figure 8.25:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
The selected Cheque number 000010 is cancelled and updated in Cheque Register.
275
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The cheque status in the Instrument Wise Report will be updated as Cancelled Cheque as
shown in the figure 8.26:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
276
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Instrument Wise screen with cancelled cheque appears as shown in the figure 8.26
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 8.26 Instrument Wise Report
LE
Note: If any cheque is cancelled by mistakenly in Tally.ERP 9, then the same can be reused by using the option
R
U
Alt+A: Alter Status from instrument wise screen. Please the selection line on cancelled cheque and then use the
IM
key.
FF
people will exchange blank cheque & will be informed to fill the amount once after actual
-S
transaction is made (sales or purchase). Whenever such cheque is issued, the same can be marked
6
Date Particulars
11
26-07-2017 Coffee Federation Ltd. issued a blank cheque having cheque number 000011 to
21
Table 8.6
1. From Gateway of Tally > F11: Company Features> F1: Accounting Features >
Enable the following options:
277
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Use reversing journals and optional vouchers
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
278
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Enable zero-valued transactions
2. Go to Gateway of Tally > Banking > Cheque Register
3. Press Enter on Kotak Mahindra Bank to view the Cheque Range Register screen
4. Press Enter on the Cheque Range – 000001-000100 (Kotak Book 1)
5. Instrument Wise report gets displayed, Select the Cheque no. 000011 by pressing space
bar > Press Alt+A : Alter Status to get the Cheque Status.
6. The Cheque Status screen appears, Select the Cheque Status as Blank Cheque
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears with the heading as Blank Cheque as shown
in the figure 8.28:
00
8 86
11
21
R
279
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 8.28 Payment Voucher Creation Screen
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
280
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8. Under Particulars, select the party ledger Ranjan Enterprises
Activity: If the party ledger is not created then use Alt+C key to create or go to Accounts Info menu.
Note: The cursor does not move to Amount field, as it is a Blank Cheque.
9. Select End of List twice and then the total amount field will get selected
10. In the Bank Allocation screen, the below details will be captured automatically:
Transaction Type as Cheque
Amount field will be Blank
Cheque range captures as 000001-000100
R
Cross using will be A/c Payee
AI
Cheque number is 000011 in the Inst no. field
N
Cheque date is 26-07-2017 in the Inst date field
AN
The Bank Allocations screen in single entry mode appears as shown in the figure 8.29:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.30:
281
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.30 Payment Voucher Creation Screen
H
12. Accept the screen
ED
LE
13. On accepting the Payment Voucher Creation screen, you will get the Cheque Printing
screen without Amount.
R
U
The Cheque Printing Configuration screen appears as shown in the figure 8.31:
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
282
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
Figure 8.32 Cheque Printing Screen
AI
N
In the above shown figure 8.32, the Amount field is left blank because the entry is made for
AN
Blank Cheque with the instrument number 000011 without Amount.
AR
The cheque status in the Instrument Wise Report will be updated as Blank Cheque as shown
H
in the figure 8.33:
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
Activity:
On 01-08-2017, Coffee Federation Ltd. Cancelled a Cheque having number 00015. The same Cheque
was issued as cancelled cheque to PF department.
283
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Record the following transaction
Date Particulars
05-08-2017 Voucher: Payment
Coffee Federation Ltd. issued a blank cheque having cheque number 000115 to Raj
Traders.
Hint: In this scenario, you need to select the cheque book in the name of Kotak Cheque
Book 2, with the cheque book range as 000101 to 000200 for the Kotak Mahindra
Bank.
R
AI
N
Table 8.7
AN
AR
8.5 Bank Reconciliation
H
Bank reconciliation is a statement where we can see the mismatch between the cash book and
ED
the bank book (Pass book). LE
Reconciliation of bank balance as per the cash book with the bank balance as per the pass book.
BRS is prepared in order to have authenticity of the transactions entered to verify the balances
R
U
Bank Reconciliation helps in cross verification between bank passbook/statement and Tally
FF
book and this is most important task to perform in a business as revenue in involved. There are
chances of misappropriation in balance if reconciliation is not done. Any error in company book
TE
Reasons
6
00
Cheque dishonour
21
284
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. Click F2:Period and set the date to 01-07-2017 to 31-07-2017
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 8.34 Bank Reconciliation Screen
R
Note: The Bank Reconciliation screen can also be accessed from Gateway of Tally > Display >
U
Accounts Books > Cash/Bank Books > Select Bank Ledger > Select Month >Press F5:
IM
Reconcile.
FF
The Bank Date has be to be provided based on the Instrument Date and not on Voucher
TE
Date.
-S
Observation: We can observe that there is a difference in the Balance as per bank and the
8
Balance as per company books, because the reconciliation is not done. Once reconciliation is
11
done referring to the Bank Statement, Balance as per bank and the Balance as per company
21
The Bank Reconciliation Screen after reconciliation appears as shown in the figure 8.35:
285
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.35 Bank Reconciliation Screen
H
ED
Here, the Reconciliation is done for the month of July 2017. 01-07-2017, 02-07-2017, 11-07-
2017, 21-07-2017, 26-07-2017, 27-07-2017 are the bank Dates provided for reconciliation
LE
respectively.
R
U
(Once the dates are entered, you will find the bank balance as per company books is impacted
IM
You can observe, that the Balance as per bank and the Balance as per company books are
matched.
TE
-S
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Accounts Books > Ledger > Select Kotak
Mahindra Bank.
86
You can observe the Closing Balance in Kotak Mahindra Bank is ₹ 15, 10,000, as shown in the
21
figure 8.36:
R
286
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.36 Ledger Vouchers Screen
H
3. Press F5: Reconcile. ED
LE
By Pressing F5: Reconcile, you will be taken to Bank Reconciliation screen, Where the
R
Balance as per bank and the Balance as per company books are getting balanced.
U
IM
Note
FF
Press F12: Configuration from Bank Reconciliation screen and set the option:
TE
Press Alt+C: Create Voucher to create vouchers from the Bank Reconciliation screen itself.
In case, if you have opening bank transactions (transactions pertaining to the last year) which are not yet
00
credited/ debited into bank account, you can provide Opening BRS for such transactions by pressing
86
Alt+U (U: Opening BRS) and provide the information in the unreconciled details for sub-screen.
8
You can reconcile the bank transactions from cheque register, by pressing F5:Reconcile
11
21
Tally.ERP 9 has enhanced the Bank Reconciliation capability to view and import the bank
statement and to auto reconcile the transactions. Tally.ERP 9 provides its users with the facility
of selecting the formats which includes configurations and input file type. Tally.ERP 9 supports
Excel, CSV and MT940 formats of bank statement. Currently the formats of many banks with
supporting file types such as Excel, CSV and MT940 are made available.
Auto Bank Reconciliation in Tally.ERP 9 requires a valid Tally Software Services and internet
connectivity.
The following illustration will help you to understand how auto reconciliation is handled
in Tally.ERP 9.
287
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity:
1. Create a Bank Ledger by name HDFC Bank under Bank Account and configure cheque printing. Enter
the bank opening balance as ₹ 100,000 Dr
2. Record the following transactions.
Date Particulars
23-08-2017 Voucher: Purchase
Coffee Federation Ltd. made a purchase of ₹15,000 from Ram and made payment
through HDFC cheque, vide cheque no: 000005 dated 23-08-2017.
R
23-08-2017 Voucher: Contra
AI
Coffee Federation Ltd., made a cash deposit of ₹25,000 in HDFC Bank.
N
AN
Table 8.8
AR
Once after recording the transaction of table 8.8, auto reconcile the vouchers, to do so follow
the steps given below:
H
ED
Step 1: Activating Auto Bank Reconciliation LE
To activate Auto Bank Reconciliation, alter the ledger Bank Account
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers > Alter > HDFC Bank
U
2. Enable the option Enable auto reconciliation to Yes and enable the option Set/alter
IM
3. Press Enter and accept the screen (If required, you can enter the location details)
This is required as the bank statement is imported to Tally.ERP 9 from the path mentioned.
288
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > F12: Configure > Select Banking Configuration
2. In the Location of new bank statements , enter the path of the folder containing the
excel format to be imported
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 8.38 Banking Configuration Screen
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Banking > Bank Reconciliation > Select Bank Account
2. Press Alt+B or B: Bank Statement
6 -S
289
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: Before importing the file make sure to close the bank statement file.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
290
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. The success message provides the user with the following details:
Total entries in bank statement
Number of reconciled transactions
Additional Bank Entries: Tally.ERP 9 also lists out the additional entries present in
the bank statement to enable the users to enter these transactions in Tally.ERP 9
Note: The below given screen shots (Figure No. 8.40, 8.41 and 8.42) are used for
illustration purpose only.
4. Press any key to view the Bank Reconciliation screen as shown in the figure 8.40:
R
The Bank Reconciliation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.40
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
Figure 8.40 Bank Reconciliation Screen
21
Note:
Vouchers can be created from the Bank Reconciliation screen for the transactions
that appear in the field Amounts not reflected in the company books. Voucher can
be created using the C: Create Voucher button.
All the unlinked transactions can be reconciled using the Ctrl+R: Reconcile All
Unlinked button.
To Account for Amount not reflected in the company books follow the steps given below:
291
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Banking > Bank Reconciliation > HDFC Bank> Keep
cursor on transaction which reflect under the field Amount not reflected in company
books > press Alt+C
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.42:
8 86
11
21
R
292
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 8.42 Accounting Voucher Creation Screen
R
Any cash received has to be deposited in the bank with Cash Deposit Slip attached. Tally.ERP 9
AI
allows users to generate cash deposit slip for depositing cash into a bank.
N
The cash deposit slip provided in Tally.ERP 9 has all the contents of cash deposit slip – account
AN
number, account holder name, bank name, branch name, company’s telephone number, and
AR
cash denomination details, so that user will not have to manually enter all the details.
H
This is standard format to deposit cash to bank. If it doesn’t exist then user has to rewrite all
ED
those cash denomination in bank challan during deposit. LE
Illustration 4: Cash Deposit transaction and Generating of Cash Deposit Slip.
R
Date Particulars
FF
Table 8.9
6
00
Activity: Provide opening balance of ₹ 30, 00,000 for Cash Ledger Account.
00
86
To record the transaction of table 8.9, in the books of Coffee Federation Ltd., first ensure that
the required ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
8
11
Note: On enabling the Single Entry mode, the payment screen displays the Account field (Select the ledger
which has to be credited), Particulars field (Select the ledgers which has to be debited) and in the Amount field
(Enter the amount)
4. In the Credit field, select Cash ledger and enter the amount as ₹ 4,00,000
5. In the Debit field, select Kotak Mahindra Bank
293
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6. Press Enter to view the Bank Allocations screen, by default Transaction Type will be
selected as cash, press Enter from the amount field, you will get the Cash
Denominations screen
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
8. Press Enter to accept the Cash Denomination screen & accept the Bank Allocation
screen
The Contra Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.45:
294
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.45 Contra Voucher Creation– Cash Deposit
H
9. Accept the screen
ED
Once after recording the entry of figure 8.45 let us view & generate Cash Deposit Slip in
LE
Tally.ERP 9.
R
To view Cash Deposit Slip menu, follow the steps given below:
FF
The Cash Deposit Slip screen appears as shown in the figure 8.46.
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
295
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Printing Cash Deposit Slip screen appears as shown in the figure 8.47:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
296
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.47 Printing Cash Deposit Slip Screen
H
ED
4. Set the option Print Cash Deposit Slip to Yes
5. Press Enter to get the Cash Deposit Slip Details and Cash Denomination as shown in
LE
the figure 8.48:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Figure 8.48 Cash Deposit Slip Details and Cash Denomination Screen
6. Press Enter to get the Cash Deposit Slip Print
The Cash Deposit Slip (Banker’s Copy) appears as shown in the figure 8.49:
297
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
The Cash Deposit Slip (Customer’s Copy) appears as shown in the figure 8.50:
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
298
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8.6.2 Cheque Deposit Slip
It enables the user to generate the deposit slip for payments received through cheque which need
to be deposited into the bank.
This is the standard format to deposit cheques to bank. This is the slip where all received cheque
details are available, information entered during receipt voucher. It avoids manual error, time &
effort, It is easy to write if it is one or two cheques per day, however very much useful if more
cheques are depositing every day.
R
The Cheque Deposit Slip in Tally ERP 9 displays only those transactions which have Cheque as
AI
Transaction type allocated in the Bank Allocation screen in the Receipt voucher entry.
N
Illustration 5: Cheque deposit transaction and generating cheque seposit Slip.
AN
Pass the following transaction in the book of Coffee Federation Ltd.
AR
Date Particulars
H
ED
25-08-2017 Voucher: Receipt
LE
Coffee Federation Ltd. received advance payment from Aruna Traders and
deposited the cheque of ₹ 3, 10,000 to Kotak Mahindra Bank.
R
U
Table 8.10
6 -S
00
3. In the Credit field, select Aruna Traders ledger and enter the amount as ₹ 3,10,000
11
299
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.51 Bank Allocations Screen
H
ED
6. Accept the screen LE
7. Enter the Narration and accept the screen.
R
The Receipt Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.52:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
To view Cheque Deposit Slip menu, follow the steps given below:
The Cheque Deposit Slip screen appears as shown in the figure 8.53:
300
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.53 Cheque Deposit Slip Screen
H
ED
3. Press Alt+P to print cheque deposit slip LE
The Printing Cheque Deposit Slip screen appears as shown in the figure 8.54:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
The Cheque Deposit Slip (Banker’s Copy) appears as shown in the figure 8.55:
301
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 8.55 Cheque Deposit Slip (Banker's Copy)
R
The Cheque Deposit Slip (Customer’s Copy) appears as shown in the figure 8.56:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note: Cheque’s deposited can also be entered in Contra Voucher similar to Cash Deposit.
This is the clear document for receiver to know for what reason payment has been made. If
302
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
payment is made without advice, then other end user may find difficult to verify/ trace the
details. The benefit of this document will help the receiver to pass respective transactions in their
books of accounts. And the receiver may revert immediately if any discrepancy is found in
transaction.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
303
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Illustration 6: Generating payment advice
Date Particulars
26-08-2017 Voucher: Payment
R
Cheque book range : 000001 to 000100
AI
Cheque book name : Kotak Book 1
N
AN
cheque number : 000006
AR
instrument date : 26-08-2017
H
ED
Table 8.11
LE
Step 1: Recording of Payment Voucher
R
U
3. Press F12: Payment Standard Configuration, and set the option Use single entry
mode for payment/receipt/ contra vouchers to Yes
TE
5. Under Particulars field Select Ranjan Enterprises ledger and enter the amount as ₹ 2,
6
20,000.
00
6. Press Enter to get the Bill-wise Details screen and fill the details given below:
00
In the Name field by default the voucher number will be shown, change it, if
8
required
11
7. Select End of List twice and then the total amount field will get selected
8. In the Bank Allocation screen,
Select Transaction Type as Cheque
Amount ₹ 2, 20,000 will be captured automatically.
The Cheque range will capture 000001-000100 automatically by default.
Cross using will be A/c Payee by default
The Cheque number will capture 000006 automatically in the Inst no. field
Enter the Cheque date as 26-08-2017 in the Inst date field
9. Accept the Screen
304
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.57:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 8.57 Payment Voucher Creation Screen
LE
10. Enter the Narration
R
12. On accepting the Payment Voucher Creation screen, you will get the Cheque Printing
IM
screen
FF
3. Press Spacebar to select the payment voucher recorded on 26-08-2017. (Payment made
86
The Printing Payment Advice Screen appears as shown in the figure 8.58:
R
305
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 8.58 Printing Payment Advice Screen
306
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8.8 Managing of Post-dated Cheques
Post-Dated vouchers are ignored by Tally.ERP 9 until the date in question. This is useful for
entering transactions that take place on a regular basis. For example, if there is a payment for
something on instalments, user can set up the payments in advance, and Tally.ERP 9 will only
enter them in the ledgers as and when they fall due.
A voucher is marked as post-dated at the time of creation or alteration. Click the button Post-
Dated or press Ctrl+T to make the voucher a Post-Dated voucher.
Business Scenario
R
Coffee Federation Ltd., expanded its business and now deals in buying and selling of Coffee
AI
Mugs and for few customers they sell on instalment basis and the payment has to be made
N
through PDC cheque in advance.
AN
Coffee Federation Ltd., should not record the cash receipt until the cheque date arrives, nor
AR
should it reduce the related accounts receivable balance until that date listed on the cheque.
Thus, they decide to use post-dated cheque which has no impact on the financial statements of
H
ED
Coffee Federation Ltd., until the date listed on the cheque. LE
Illustration 7: Recording of PDC related transactions in Tally.ERP 9
R
Date Particulars
27-08-2017 Voucher: Sales
FF
Table 8.12
6
To record the transactions of table 8.12, in the books of Coffee Federation Ltd., first ensure that
00
Party Ledger
11
MK Traders
R
307
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Check for credit days during voucher entry Set to No
Table 8.13
Sales Ledger
Sales
R
Enter Enter as Sales
AI
N
Under Select as Sales Accounts
AN
Inventory Values are effected Set to Yes
AR
Table 8.14
H
Step 2: Creation of Inventory Masters
ED
LE
Create stock item
R
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Items > Create
U
IM
Coffee Mugs
FF
Table 8.15
21
R
308
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8. Enter the quantity as 1000, rate as 100 and the amount will get captured automatically
9. In the Bill wise Details screen, select type of reference as new reference and enter the bill
details and save the Bill wise Details screen
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
After recording the sales transaction, the post-dated cheque received by MK Traders need to be
TE
accounted/recorded in Tally.ERP 9. Following steps will explain how to record the post -dated
-S
transaction in Tally.ERP 9.
6
00
2. Click F2: Date and provide the date of cheque i.e., 02-10-2017
3. In the Voucher Creation screen, press Ctrl+T: Post-Dated. The voucher will be
8
11
The Receipt Voucher Creation screen with Post-Dated option appears as shown in the figure
R
8.61:
309
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.61 Recording the Post-Dated Transaction in Accounting Voucher
H
ED
Note: From the above screen, if you press Ctrl+T: Current, then the post-dated
option will be removed from the screen.
LE
Activity: Create the SBI Bank account under Bank Accounts group
R
U
5. Under Particulars, select as MK Traders from whom the post-dated cheque has been
FF
received
6. In the Bill wise Details screen select against ref. and enter the amount as 50,
TE
Note: Once after selecting the party ledger, if the Bill wise Details screen is not
-S
appearing, then press F12: Configure and enable the option Pre allocate bills for
6
payment/receipt/journal voucher
00
00
7. Press Enter
86
310
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
311
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 8.62 Bank Allocations Screen
8. Fill in the required details. A new field, PDC receipt date, will be available on the screen.
This field is available for post-dated transactions only. Fill in the date on which the post-
dated cheque was received from the party. By default, the system date is captured
9. Press Enter to save the Bank Allocations screen. The Voucher Creation screen appears
10. Enter the Narration
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
Note: Press F12: Configure from the receipt entry voucher and enable the option Show
-S
final balances of bill in order to get the amount that remains due, if any post allocation is
6
Activity: Record one more post-dated receipt transaction for ₹ 50,000 dated 02-11-2017.
86
Once after recording the transaction the details will be updated in Post-dated Summary report.
8
11
21
A notional bank exhibits the same features as a normal bank account, created under the group
Bank Accounts. You can create a notional bank account when you are:
Unable to decide the bank to which the post-dated cheques received are to be deposited,
while creating the post-dated transactions.
Manually converting the post-dated cheques received.
Business Scenario:
Coffee Federation Ltd., is not able to decide the bank to which the post-dated cheques
received are to be deposited while recording the transaction.
312
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Coffee Federation Ltd., decided to use the notional bank feature of Tally.ERP 9.
Date Particulars
27-08-2017 Voucher: Sales
Coffee Federation Ltd., sold 2,000 qty of Coffee Mugs at ₹ 100 each
on credit to Tara Traders and the total sales value is ₹ 2, 00,000.
R
27-08-2017 Voucher: Receipt
AI
Tara Traders issues two PDC cheque leafs of one lakh each and the
N
cheques are post-dated to 03-10-2017 and 03-11-2017
AN
Table 8.16
To record the transactions of table 8.16, in the books of Coffee Federation Ltd., first ensure that
AR
the required ledgers are created and notional bank is configured in Tally.ERP 9.
H
Activity:
1. Create a party ledger Tara Traders under Sundry Debtors.
ED
LE
2. Record the sales transaction which is made to Tara Traders on 27-08-2017.
R
Activity: Create a bank named Notional Bank for recording transactions related to above scenario.
3. Select the Notional Bank account for transacting with post-dated cheques
313
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Post-dated Transaction Features screen appears as shown in the figure 8.65
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 8.65 Selecting Notional Bank
LE
4. Press Enter and accept the Accounting Features screen
R
3. Click F2: Date and provide the date of the cheque i.e., 03-10-2017
4. In Account field select a Notional Bank
-S
6. Enter the amount as ₹ 1,00,000, press Enter to view Bill wise Details screen
00
7. Select the Against Ref in the Bill wise Details and the amount will get captured as
00
1,00,000
86
314
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.66 Bank Allocations for Notional Bank Receipt
H
ED
Note: If instrument number field is not appearing then press F12: Configure, from the above screen and
enable the option Show instrument number during voucher creation.
LE
9. Fill in the required details in Bank allocations screen
R
10. Press Enter to save the bank details. The Voucher Creation screen appears.
U
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Date Particulars
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
316
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
27-08-2017 Voucher: Receipt
Received post-dated cheque from Tara Traders for ₹ 100,000. Date of post-dated
transaction is 03-11-2017. Cheque number: 300002.
Hint: Select Notional Bank
Table 8.17
Note: Notional Bank can be changed to actual bank from Post-dated Summary report
R
The Post-dated Summary report provides a month-wise breakup of transactions for which the
AI
post-dated cheques have been received or issued.
N
To get the Post-dated Summary report follow the below given path:
AN
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Banking > Post-dated Summary > Select the required
AR
Bank, in this case select as Notional Bank
H
The Post-dated Transactions Monthly Summary appears as shown in the figure 8.68
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
From the report of figure 8.68, drill down by placing the cursor under Received field, to view
post-dated received report.
Similarly, you can drill down by placing the cursor under Issued field, to get the post-dated
issued report.
Drill down from one of the months in the received column to get the post-dated received report
which is shown in the figure 8.69:
The Post-dated Received report screen appears as shown in the figure 8.69:
317
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 8.69 Post-dated Received Report
ED
Note: Status is showing as unlinked because we have recorded the entry by selecting the
LE
Notional Bank, once the entry is linked to the actual bank, then the entry will be
removed from the above screen as shown in figure 8.69.
R
U
3. Select the entry which is recorded on 03-10-2017, to select the entry press Spacebar
FF
The New Bank Name field screen appears as shown in the figure 8.71
318
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.71 Linking Post-dated Transaction to Actual Bank
H
ED
5. Select the actual bank to which the entry has to be linked, in the above screen (figure 8.71)
select SBI Bank ledger and press enter, you will get the screen as shown in the figure 8.72:
LE
The Post-dated Received screen after linking to actual bank appears as shown in the figure
R
8.72:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
In the figure 8.72, the entry which was linked has been removed from the report.
Note:
The same activity can be done from Post-dated issue report (Payment made in
PDC). Post-dated report can be viewed from Day Book report by pressing the key
Alt+T , enter the complete period to get all the post-dated transactions.
319
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Go to Gateway of Tally> Display> Exception reports> Post-Dated Voucher, in this
report you will get the list of all post-dated transactions.
Activity: Check the following reports and make the post-dated transaction as regular.
Check the Balance Sheet report and take down the total value of Bank Account:
o Go to Gateway of Tally > Balance Sheet>Select Current Asset Account
o Check the Bank Account value.
Make the post-dated transaction as regular:
o Now, go to Gateway of Tally> Display> Exception reports> Post-dated voucher, in this report you
will get the list of all post-dated voucher.
R
o Select the entry which is recorded on 02-09-2017, drill down to voucher level.
AI
o Press Ctrl+T: Current option and save the entry, to save at one shot press Ctrl+A. the entry will be
N
removed from the list of post-dated voucher.
AN
Check the Balance Sheet report and take down the total value of bank account and compare it with the
previous bank account value.
AR
The value will be increased, because we have made the post-dated voucher as a regular voucher/current
H
voucher and the same is updated instantly in the report.
In Tally.ERP 9, we can maintain electronic fund transfer from one bank to another or same bank
U
transfer. This allows us to record transactions easily and make payments to vendors and
IM
suppliers quickly. It also allows direct upload or export payment instructions to the bank portal.
Presently this feature is given to DBS Bank customers only.
FF
TE
Payment instructions can be sent directly to bank from Tally.ERP 9 (currently applicable for
DBS Bank), if e-payment feature is activated or enabled. To send payment instructions directly
-S
to the bank for authorization, you need to have your Tally.NET ID registered with your bank.
6
00
It also provides a seamless integration between the business and the bank on real time basis. You
00
can directly send all completed transactions to the bank through online with a click of a button,
and access real-time status of the transactions.
8 86
Business Scenario
11
Coffee Federation Ltd., makes an online payment for vendor/supplier and also sends the e -
21
Illustration 9: Recording of e-payment entry and uploading the details to DBS Bank
Date Particulars
01-10-2017 Voucher: Purchase
Purchased 500 Qty of Coffee Mugs at ₹ 50 each from Shine Traders on
credit.
10-10-2017 Voucher: Receipt
320
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Shine Traders made an online payment through DBS Bank for ₹ 25,000
to the supplier.
Table 8.18
To record the above transactions in the books of Coffee Federation Ltd., first ensure that the
required ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Bank Ledger
R
To create Bank ledger follow the steps given below:
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers > Create
N
2. Enter the Name as DBS Bank
AN
3. In the Under field select Bank Accounts head
AR
4. Enter the Bank Account Details as shown below:
A/c holder’s name: Enter as Bhaskar Software Solutions
H
ED
A/c no: Enter as 0051234567
IFS code: Enter as DBSS0IN0811
LE
Bank name: Select as DBS (India) from the List of Banks
R
Branch: Indranagar
U
IM
Note: Once after selecting the bank name as DBS Bank, you will get the e-payment feature under Bank
Configuration.
FF
The Selection of Bank from List of Bank screen appears as shown in the figure 8.73:
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Figure 8.73 Selecting the DBS Bank from the List of Banks
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Set the option Set cheque printing configuration to Yes (by this you can define
the cheque details like cheque dimensions details)
Enable auto reconciliation, you can enable this option if you want to use the
auto reconciliation feature
Set the option Enable e-Payments to Yes and Set/alter e-Payments
configuration to Yes (Ensure that this option is set to yes, in order to perform
the online payments in Tally.ERP 9), you will get the following screen
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6. In the e-payments configuration screen as shown in figure 8.74, enter the location of
6
payment instruction
00
Note:
00
86
You can send a payment instruction (currently applicable for DBS bank) from Tally.ERP 9 to
your bank if you have enabled the e-Payments feature. For other banks, you can export the payment
8
11
instruction in the required format, and upload the same to your bank portal. By default, the location
of payment instructions will be Tally folder path.
21
R
Enable e-Payments: This option is applicable only for banks supported for electronic modes of payment
i.e. DBS Bank – India, Standard Chartered Bank – India, Standard Chartered Bank – UAE,
YES BANK – India, ICICI Bank – India and Kotak Mahindra Bank.
7. Press Enter, to go back to the Ledger Creation screen
The DBS Bank Ledger Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.75:
322
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.75 DBS Bank Ledger Creation Screen
H
ED
8. Accept the screen
Activity: Alter the DBS Bank ledger and enter the opening balance as ₹ 5, 00,000
LE
R
Party Ledger
U
IM
Let us create a party ledger and enter the bank details in the same ledger, to create follow the
steps given below:
FF
323
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Enable the option Provide Bank details to Yes, you will get the Bank Details screen
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
324
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Enter the following details as shown in the figure 8.77:
Select the Transaction Type as e-Fund Transfer
Enter the A/c no details
Enter IFS code
Select the Bank
The Completed Bank Details screen appears as shown in the figure 8.77:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
Note: Once Transaction Type is selected as e-Fund Transfer, then while recording the transaction it will
auto identify the same bank or inter-bank transfer details based on the bank name selected while recording the
-S
transaction.
6
00
6. After selecting the Bank from List of Banks, press Enter, you will go back to ledger
00
creation screen
86
The Completed Ledger Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.78:
8
11
21
R
325
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.78 Completed Ledger Creation Screen
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
326
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
7. Accept the screen
Note: No need of creating purchase ledger as the same is created by you for recording previous purchase
transaction.
R
Table 8.18
AI
Hint: While recording the purchase entry if the purchase ledger is not appearing, then alter the same ledger and
N
enable the option Inventory values are effected.
AN
Step: 2 Recording of e-Payment Transaction
AR
To record the transaction, follow the steps given below:
H
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > Press F5:Payment
2. Press F2:Date and change the date as 10-10-2017
ED
LE
3. In the Account field select as DBS Bank
4. Under Particulars field select as Shine Traders
R
U
5. Enter the amount as ₹ 25,000, press Enter you will get the Bill wise Details screen.
IM
The amount will get captured automatically, enter and save the Bill wise d etails
-S
screen
6
7. Press Enter till you get the Bank Allocations screen, by default the bank details provided
00
327
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
328
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 8.79 Bank Allocations Screen
Note: From the screen of figure 8.79, we can also alter the bank details like A/c no, IFS code and Bank.
8. Accept the Bank Allocations screen
9. Enter Narration
The e-Payment Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 8.80:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
Once after recording the entry of figure 8.80, the details will reflect in the e-payments reports,
6
In Tally.ERP 9, we can check the details of e-payments transactions in e-payments reports. This
8
report displays the details of all payment instructions that are ready to be sent to bank and it also
11
displays the details of transactions with incomplete information and information mismatch with
21
masters.
R
329
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.81 e-Payments Report Screen
H
ED
2. In the report of figure 8.81, we will get the details of the entry which was recorded
previously. And also the details of Transaction with incomplete information and
LE
information mismatch with masters will get captured here
R
3. From the e-payments screen, press Ctrl+B, to send the transaction to DBS Bank. For
U
Date Particulars
TE
16-10-2017 Make a payment of ₹ 30,000 to Ram. While recording the entry do not enter any bank
-S
16-10-2017 Make a payment of ₹ 20,000 to Shisha Traders. Make sure while creating the Shisha
00
Traders ledger enable Bank details and enter the following details.
00
While recording the payment entry change the A/c no. as 123456 and IFS code as
R
16-10-2017 Make a payment of ₹ 6,000 to Sona Enterprises, Make sure while creating the party
ledger provide the Bank details and enter the following details.
Transaction Type as e-fund transfer
A/c no as 34567867896
IFS code as DBSN0123478
Bank as DBS (India)
While recording the payment entry do not make any changes in the Bank
Allocations screen, accept the screen as it is.
330
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Once after recording the entry check the e-payments report and observe the effect of the entry
in the report.
Table 8.19
R
portal. Once after uploading the exported file on the bank's portal, we can authorise them for
AI
payment.
N
Note: Exporting e-payment transaction instruction from e-payments report is given only for the following Banks
AN
Standard Chartered Bank (India)
AR
Standard Chartered Bank (UAE)
H
Kotak Mahindra Bank (India)
ED
YES Bank (India)
LE
ICICI Bank (India)
DBS Bank customers can export as well as send the payment instructions directly to DBS Bank portal.
R
U
Step 1: Rectify the Transactions which are falling under the head “Transactions with
FF
To rectify the entry which falls under Transaction with incomplete information, follow the steps
-S
given below:
6
00
331
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 8.82 e-Payments Report Screen
In the report of figure 8.82 you are getting the following details:
R
Level). In this field the second payment entry which you have made to Shisha Traders is
AI
reflecting.
N
Ready for Sending to Bank: It provides the information about the transactions which
AN
are ready to be sent to the bank (This feature is provided only for DBS Bank) or export
AR
the transactions (all other banks) to the required template. In this field the third payment
entry which you have made to Sona Enterprises is shown.
H
Transactions sent to Bank (Unreconciled): It provides the information about the
ED
transactions which are sent to bank (DBS Bank). Transactions sent to bank is blank
LE
because you have not sent any e-payment transactions to bank.
R
2. Drill down from the field Transactions with Incomplete information and rectify the
U
IM
entry
FF
The e-Payment (Transactions with Incomplete Information) screen appears as shown in the
figure 8.83:
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
3. In the figure 8.83, we are getting the error as Account Number is Mandatory and IFSC
Code is mandatory.
4. To rectify the error, press Enter on the entry line and you will get the Bank Details screen
332
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Enter the correct IFS code and press Enter, to get the screen as shown in the figure 8.84
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 8.84 Bank Details Screen
R
6. Press D:Add so that the IFS code & Account Number entered should get updated in
U
master
IM
Activity: Alter the ledger by name Ram and enable the option Provide bank details to Yes, we can observe
FF
that the IFS code & Account number is updated in the party master. This is because we have used the option D:
TE
Note: In the above screen as shown in the figure 8.84, the following details are appearing:
6
00
7. Press Enter. The entry will get removed from the screen and the same entry will move
11
333
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.85 e-Payments Report Screen
H
ED
8. In the figure 8.85, we can observe that the entry is appearing under Ready for sending to
bank field
LE
R
To rectify the entry which falls under Transaction with information mismatch (with
U
1. From the e-Payments report drill down from Transaction with information mismatch
FF
The e-Payment (Transactions with Information Mismatch with Master) screen appears as
shown in the figure 8.86
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Figure 8.86 e-Payment (Transactions with Information Mismatch with Master) Screen
2. In the figure 8.86, we are getting the warning as Account Number Altered, IFS Code
334
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Altered
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
335
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: In the above screen Alt+A: Accept as is option is available for you to accept the entry as it is.
3. Press Enter from the figure 8.86, you will get the Update Bank Details screen
The Update Bank Details screen appears as shown in the figure 8.87:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
4. Press F6: Copy Master Info., this will copy the master bank details to voucher, as shown
FF
The Update Bank Details screen (Copy Master Info.) appears as shown in the figure 8.88:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
5. In the figure 8.87, we can observe that the F6: Copy Mater Info., button is greyed out
6. Accept the screen, the entry will move out from the screen
336
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity: Go to e-payments report and observe that the entry of figure 8.88, will appear under Ready for
sending to bank field.
Step 2: Exporting e-Payment Transactions
The e-Payments Transactions Report Screen (Ready for Sending to Bank) appears as
R
shown in the figure 8.89:
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
Figure 8.89 e-Payments Transactions Report Screen (Ready for Sending to Bank)
00
Note: In the figure 8.89, under Transaction Type field you are getting Same Bank Transfer and
00
NEFT, this is updated automatically based on the bank selected in the party ledger.
86
3. From the e-payments screen, select the required transactions and press E: Export, to
8
11
export the payment instructions to bank (Here select all the transactions by pressing Ctrl
21
+ Spacebar key
R
The Export Payment Instructions screen appears as shown in the figure 8.90:
337
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.90 Export Payment Instructions Screen
H
ED
4. Press Enter from the exporting screen, you will get the following screen with successful
message
LE
Note: Enable the option Include Bill Details to Yes in order to get the invoice number/bill number
R
U
details.
IM
The e-Payments Screen (Successful message) appears as shown in the figure 8.91:
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
5. In the figure 8.91, we are getting the information about the location and file name, press
enter. The file will be available in the exported location.
6. Now one can log in to bank portal to upload the exported output file from local
system
7. Once after exporting the entry the above payment entries will reflect in Transactions
338
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
sent to bank (unreconciled) field.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
339
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The e-Payments Report screen appears as shown in the figure 8.92:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 8.92 e-Payments Report Screen
LE
The entries are reflected under Transactions sent to bank (unreconciled) field.
R
Note: DBS Bank customers can directly send the e-payment instructions to the bank portal instead of
U
exporting the file and uploading the same in bank portal like other banks.
IM
DBS Bank customers have a facility to upload the payment instructions directly to the Bank
TE
portal and authorise the same, instead of exporting the file and then uploading it.
-S
Date Particulars
00
Table 8.20
R
Once after recording the above entry, let us send the payment instructions directly to DBS Bank.
To send payment instructions directly to DBS Bank, follow the steps given below:
Step 1: Enable Security Control
Only a Tally.Net User will have permission to send the e-Payment instructions to DBS portal
directly from within Tally. Hence creation of Tally.Net User is mandatory.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Press Alt+F3 > Alter
2. Select the company
3. Enable the option Use security control to Yes
340
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Enter the Name of administrator as admin
5. Enter the password as admin123
6. Enter the same password in the Repeat password field
7. Save the Company Alteration screen
Step 2: Authorise Tally.NET User
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Press Alt+F3 > Security Control
2. Enter on Users and Passwords
The Users for Company screen appears as shown in the figure 8.93:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
-S
3. Enter Security Level and Username, make sure the user name should be registered in
DBS Bank (If it is not registered then you cannot send the payments instruction directly
00
Note: The username given in the list of users for company as shown above is the e mail ID registered with DBS
11
Bank. After creating the security level, Tally.Net password will be sent to the same e-mail ID through which you
21
341
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 8.94 Company Login Screen
2. Press Enter, now you have logged in to the company with Tally.NET User
AR
Note: The Tally.NET User I.D used only for illustration purpose.
H
ED
Step 4: Sending the payment instructions directly to the Bank
LE
To send the payment instructions, follow the steps given below:
R
The e-Payments Screen (Ready for Sending to Bank) appears as shown in the figure 8.95
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
342
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.96 Upload Payment Instructions Screen
H
5. Press Enter from the Uploading payment Instructions screen as shown in the figure
ED
8.96, to get the screen as shown in the figure 8.97 LE
The e-Payments Screen with Successful Message appears as shown in the figure 8.97:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
343
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.98 e-Payments Report Screen
H
Note: First four entries status is showing as exported because in the previous section we have exported the same.
8. Authorise last two Transactions
ED
LE
9. From the report of figure 8.98, press Ctrl+T, to authorise, this will lead you to DBS
Bank login page.
R
U
10. Log in to DBS portal and authorize the transactions for making payment to the party
IM
Authorisation pending – When transactions have been accepted by the bank, and
are available for authorization on the bank’s portal
-S
Note: You can reset the status of entry from the above screen by using the key F7: Reset Status, once it is
8
reset the entry will move back to Ready for sending to bank field
11
21
Tally.ERP 9
If you are already maintaining the data in Tally.ERP 9 and have many party ledgers in which
bank details are not configured, it may be very difficult and time consuming to enter the bank
details manually in each and every party ledger. To address this problem you can make use of
Import Bank Details feature in Tally.ERP 9
Activity: Create the following ledgers under Sundry Creditors and make sure not to enter bank details.
Magadi Traders
Rajbhog Pvt. Ltd.
344
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
TM Traders
Note: The above ledgers are created for illustration purpose only.
To Import the Bank Details of all the party ledger, follow the steps given below:
Step 1: Update the Party Bank Details in Excel Sheet
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Import Data > Bank Details
2. Press Alt+P: Payee Sample File, to export the blank excel sheet to feed the party bank
details
The Exporting Sample File screen appears as shown in the figure 8.99:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
3. Enter the export location (This is the location in which your exported file will be saved)
6
5. Press Enter to accept the screen, the blank excel sheet will get opened
00
The Blank Exported Excel Sheet screen appears as shown in the figure 8.100:
8 86
11
21
R
345
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
Figure 8.100 Exported Blank Excel Sheet
AN
6. Feed the details in the above screen
AR
H
The Excel Sheet with Ledger Bank Details appears as shown in the figure 8.101:
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
Note: In the above screen you can click on Help option and refer the criteria for entering the bank details in the
excel sheet
7. Save the excel sheet and close
Step 2: Import the Bank Details of the Ledger from Excel
To import the details bank details of ledger from Excel to Tally, follow the below given steps:
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: If the location is not in the proper format as shown in above screen then the file
will not get imported.
The Importing of Payee Bank A/c Details Screen appears as shown in the figure 8.102:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
347
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 8.102 Importing of Payee Bank A/c Details Screen
AR
3. Press Enter from the above screen, the bank details will get updated in the party ledger
H
and you will get the below given screen with success message
ED
The Completed Importing of Payee Bank A/c Details Screen appears as shown in the figure
LE
8.103:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
4. Press Enter. All the ledgers will get updated with the bank details which were
available in the excel sheet.
Once after importing the bank details, alter the Mahavir party ledger and enable the option
Provide banks details to Yes and check. Bank details will be updated.
Conclusion
Banking Feature is a very important aspect of any business. In Tally.ERP 9 one can print cheque,
keep track of cheque books and cheque numbers by using the feature Cheque Printing. And also
we have learnt how e-payments transactions are handled in Tally.ERP 9. We can generate cash
deposit and cheque deposit slips instantly; including payment advice. We can handle Bank
348
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Reconciliation in which we have the option to reconcile manually or automatically in Tally.ERP
9.
Key Takeaways
The Cheque Printing option allows you to print all the pending, already printed or the
required cheques continuously from a single screen. Using cheque printing feature in
R
Tally.ERP 9, manual errors can be avoided.
AI
Tally also has provision to select respective bank’s cheque image to identify the cheque.
N
By doing this configurations will be created automatically.
AN
Tally ERP 9 allows creation of multiple cheque books with unique ranges for every bank
AR
in bank ledger creation, selection of cheque ranges during voucher entry and auto cheque
numbering, & giving a report of the status of all the cheques in the form of cheque register.
H
ED
Whenever required, you can issue blank cheque and cancel cheque as per business
requirements.
LE
Reconciliation of bank balance as per the cash book with the bank balance as per the pass
R
book. In Tally.ERP 9, the vouchers can be reconciled by just entering the appropriate dates
U
Cash and Cheque Deposit Slips, Payment Advice can be printed from Tally.ERP 9
FF
Shortcut Keys
00
86
Ctrl+F6
R
349
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Alt+B From Bank Reconciliation screen
To import the Bank Statement
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
350
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Practice Exercises
R
d. Set the option - Enable cheque printing to Yes in F11 >F2 features
AI
N
2. What is the limitation for providing cheque number while creating the cheque book?
AN
a. 9
AR
b. 6
c. 8
H
d. 10
ED
LE
R
a. 11
IM
b. 12
c. 10
FF
d. 9
TE
5. In the Bank Allocations screen, the Cheque Range and the Instrument Number is auto
21
filled when the cheque numbers are configured while creating the Bank ledger.
R
a. True
b. False
7. We can generate both, a cheque deposit slip & a cash deposit slip in Tally.
a. True
b. False
351
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
8. What shortcut key is used to alter the cheque status a Cancelled or Blank from Cheque
register?
a. Alt+I
b. Ctrl+I
c. Alt+A
d. Ctrl+C
R
a. True
AI
b. False
N
AN
10. PDC stands for _____ _ _ _ .
a. Post-draft cheque
AR
b. Post-dated Cheque
H
c. Post-dated Compensation
ED
d. Post-dated Draft LE
11. Using _____ _ _ __ feature i can import bank statement for reconciliation.
R
b. Manual Reconciliation
IM
c. Post-dated cheque
FF
d. Payment Advice
TE
12. Given below are the types of references and a transaction of each in a jumbled format.
-S
Terms Meaning
00
payment details.
8
11
2 Cancelled Cheque B Find mismatch between the cash book and the
bank book (Pass book).
21
R
13. Referring to the figure 8.102, what is the key combination used to reconcile the
transactions from Ledger Vouchers screen.
352
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 8.104
H
ED
a. Press Alt+F6:Multi Cheque Print
b. Press F6:Bank Reconcile
LE
c. Press F5:Reconcile
R
d. Press Alt+F5:Reconcile
U
IM
14. The following Bank Reconciliation report as shown in figure 8.105 displays the difference
FF
in amount in balance as per company books and balance as per bank books. Provide the
solution to match the balances of both the books.
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Figure 8. 105
a. Need to reconcile the Vouchers by proving bank date
b. Need to reconcile the Masters by providing bank date
c. Need to reconcile the Voucher without proving the bank date
d. Need to reconcile the Masters without proving the bank date
353
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
354
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 9
Allocation and Tracking of
Expenses and Incomes
Learning Objectives
R
AI
Create and maintain cost centres
N
Create and maintain the cost categories
AN
View reports relating to cost centres and cost categories
Create and maintain cost centres class
AR
Generate reports related to cost center and categories
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
355
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9.1 Introduction
In any organisation, it is very important to keep the track of cost and profit made by an
organisation. It is also very important to keep the track of expenses incurred by each department
and the profit earned by each department. The tracking of expenses and incomes helps an
organisation to find out the details like, which department is earning profit and which department
is incurring more expenses, these information will help an organisation in making right decision at
right time.
In Tally.ERP 9, we can allocate the expenses and incomes to the unit of an organisation, this unit
vary from business to business. For example unit can be department, product, company or
individuals etc. We can configure and maintain cost allocation in Tally.ERP 9 with ease and the
R
reports gets generated instantly after recording the transactions related to cost centres.
AI
9.2 Cost Centre and Cost Categories
N
AN
A Cost Centre is any unit of an organisation to which transactions (generally, revenue) can be
allocated. When only costs or expenses are allocated to these units, they are referred to as Cost
AR
Centres. When profits are allocated to these units, they become Profit Centres.
H
Tally.ERP 9’s cost centres allow a dimensional analysis of financial information. Tally.ERP 9 gives
ED
you the cost centre break-up of each transaction as well as details of transactions for each cost
centre and also it gives the information about whether a particular unit/product/Individual is
LE
undergoing loss or earning profit to an organisation.
R
U
Examples are:
IM
Cost Categories are useful for organisations that require allocation of revenue and non-revenue
items to parallel sets of Cost Centres. Cost categories facilitate third dimensional reporting of
6
00
Expenditure and Revenue. And Cost Categories are the distinct for any cost centre, hence each
cost centre can have a particular category
00
Examples are:
86
Region-wise or Geography-wise
Employee-wise
8
11
Department-wise
21
Note: It is not necessary to create the Cost Categories, if required we can use the default cost category by name
R
Let us take an example of Cost Centres and Cost Categories given above. To understand the above examples in
combination of cost centre and categories given in table 9.1:
Cost categories Cost Centres
Salesman Manish
Employees
Salesman Jemil
Table 9.1
In the table 9.1, employees will be a Cost Category and Salesman Manish & Jemil are the Cost Centres, which
falls under Cost Category Employees.
356
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Business Scenario
PCNet World Pvt Ltd started a company as on 01-04-2016. They sell DataNet Protect
Antivirus. The organisation have different departments and many employees in the organization.
In trading activity business generates some expenses and income from different levels.
The objective of an organization is to generate, view and analyse the reports of sources of income
and expenses generated by department and employees, which helps to develop and control the
finance.
R
Activity: Create the following Company
AI
Company Name: PCNet World Pvt Ltd
N
Company Address: Block No: 879, 3rd Cross Road, Tilaknagara, Near Silicon Stationery, Bengaluru,
AN
Country: India
State: Karnataka
AR
Pin: 560001
Financial Year: 01-07-2017 to 31-03-2018
H
9.2.1 Activation of Cost Category and Cost Centre ED
LE
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > F11: Company Features > F1: Accounting Features
IM
Date Particulars
6
01-07-2017 The company has decided to track the expenses and incomes of the following
00
branches.
Name of Cost Centres
00
Gurgaon Office
86
Mumbai Office
8
11
01-07-2017 The company has decided to track the expenses and incomes of the following
employees with further breakdown.
21
Table 9.2
To maintain the details of table 9.2, in the books of accounts, first ensure that the required masters
are created in Tally.ERP 9
357
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Cost Categories
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Cost Categories > Create
Employees
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Employees
Allocate Revenue Items Set to Yes
R
Allocate Non-Revenue Items Set to Yes
AI
Allocate revenue items: if you enable this option, then the cost centres created under this cost category
N
will appear while recording the entry for Purchase, Sales, Expense and Incomes.
AN
Allocate non-revenue items: if you enable this option, then the cost centres created under this cost
category will appear while recording the entry for Assets and Liabilities.
AR
Table 9.3
Note: While creating cost category, it is mandatory to enable any one of the option Allocate revenue items
H
or Allocate Non-revenue items, or both can be enabled, but if both the options are disabled, then you will
not be able to save the cost category.
ED
LE
Cost Centres
R
U
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Cost Centres > Create
IM
FF
Salesman Manish
TE
Table 9.4
8
11
21
Salesman Jemil
R
Gurgaon Office
Against the Field Action to be Performed
358
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Category Select as Primary cost category
Name Enter as Gurgaon Office
Under Select Primary
Table 9.6
Mumbai Office
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Cost Category Let it be Primary cost category
R
Name Enter as Mumbai Office
AI
Under Select Primary
N
Table 9.7
AN
AR
Note: Cost Centre will not affect the Books of Account
H
Cost centres are applicable: Once this option is set to yes, then while recording the transaction using
ED
this ledger, we will get the allocation screen in which we can allocate the amount to their respective cost centers
and categories.
LE
R
U
IM
In this section, we will learn how to allocate the expenses and incomes to their respective cost
TE
centres.
-S
Pass the following transactions in the book of PCNet World Pvt Ltd.
86
Date Particulars
8
PCNet World Pvt Ltd Paid ₹ 75,000 towards Rent, out of which ₹ 30,000 was
paid towards Gurgaon Office and ₹ 45,000 towards Mumbai office (Use Cost
R
Table 9.8
To record the transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required masters are
created in Tally.ERP 9.
359
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Ledgers
R
Opening balance Enter as 10,00,000 Dr
AI
Table 9.10
N
AN
Rent
Against the Field Action to be Performed
AR
Name Enter as Rent
H
ED
Under Select as Indirect Expenses
LE
Cost centres are applicable Set to Yes
Table 9.11
R
U
5. Select Primary Cost Category, then select the cost centre as Gurgaon Office enter the
00
amount as 30,000 and Mumbai Office amount of 45,000, will be captured automatically.
00
The Cost Centre Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 9.1
8 86
11
21
R
360
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 9.1 Cost Centre Allocations Screen
6. Credit the SBI Bank ledger and the amount will get captured automatically
7. Enter the bank details, the Instrument no: 000002 and date 05-07-2017.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
Once after recording the entry of figure 9.2, let us check how this entry is reflecting instantly in
TE
the report. To check the same follow the steps given below:
-S
2. Select Category Summary, you will get the Cost Category Summary report.
00
3. Cost Category summary report displays the details of allocated amount with closing
00
balance.
86
Note: If the closing balance amount have debit balance, then it is a cost to the company, if it has credit balance
8
Table 9.12
361
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9.2.3 Allocation of Expenses and Incomes using Cost
Centre with Cost category
In this section, we will learn to allocate the expenses and income to parallel sets of cost centres. For
example: We can allocate expenses and incomes to the classification based on the following
types:
Region-wise or Geography-wise
Employee-wise
Department-wise
Illustration 3: Allocation of expenses and income to cost centre and cost categories.
R
AI
Pass the following transactions in the book of PCNet World Pvt Ltd.
N
Date Particulars
AN
01-08-2017 Voucher: Payment
AR
The sales team of PCNet World Pvt Ltd Began customer visits for giving a demo
of its DataNet Protect Antivirus. The company provided ₹ 35,000 towards their
H
ED
transportation and food expenses. Out of which, ₹ 15,000 was allocated for
Salesman Manish and ₹ 20,000 to Salesman Jemil, vide cheque no: 000003 dated
LE
01-08-2017 (Use Cost Centre and Cost Category).
R
Table 9.13
U
IM
To record the transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required masters are
created in Tally.ERP 9.
FF
TE
Expense ledger
6
Cost of Expenses
00
Table 9.14
R
362
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Select Cost centre as Salesman Manish and enter amount ₹ 15,000, and the
Salesman Jemil ₹ 20,000
The Cost Centre Allocation screen appears as shown in the figure 9.3:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 9.3 Cost Centre Allocation Screen
LE
R
5. Credit the SBI Bank ledger, and the amount field will be updated automatically
U
6. Enter the bank details like Instrument no: 000003 and date 01-08-2017
IM
Once after recording the entry the details will get updated in the respective reports.
363
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9.2.3.1 Allocation of expenses to multiple cost centres and cost
categories
In this section, we will learn to allocate expenses to multiple cost centres and cost categories while
recording a payment voucher and also check the relevant reports.
Cost categories &
R
Cost Centre
AI
N
AN
AR
Departments Grade
H
ED
LE
R
Pass the following transactions in the book of PCNet World Pvt Ltd.
6
00
Date Particulars
00
Made a payment towards cost of expenses for ₹ 1, 50,000, vide cheque no: 000004,
8
11
364
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To record the transaction of table 9.15 in the books of account, first ensure that the required
masters are created in Tally.ERP 9
Cost Categories
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Cost Categories > Create
Departments
R
Against the Field Action to be Performed
AI
N
Name Enter as Departments
AN
Allocate Revenue Items Set to Yes
AR
Allocate Non-Revenue Items Set to Yes
H
Table 9.16
ED
LE
Grade
R
Cost centres
00
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Cost Centres > Create
00
Marketing
86
Accounts
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Cost Category Departments
Name Enter as Accounts
Under Select Primary
Table 9.19
365
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity: Refer to cost centre of department and create the senior and junior cost centres and select the cost category
as grade
R
AI
The Cost Centre Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 9.6:
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
5. Credit the SBI Bank ledger, and the amount field will get updated automatically
86
6. Enter the bank details like Instrument no: 000004 and date 13-09-2017
8
366
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 9.7 Payment Voucher Screen
H
7. Accept the screen
In this section, we will learn to automate cost centre and cost categories while recording the
IM
Cost Centre Classes are used to automate cost centre allocations in transactions, i.e., while
-S
recording the transactions, we have assigned the amount to cost centers manually but with Cost
Centre Classes the same will be done automatically. On creating a Cost Centre Class, you need to
6
00
select it in the voucher screen before making the entry. You can also use Cost Centre Classes when
voucher classes are being used.
00
86
Date Particulars
21
The company has pre-allocated the sales percentage to its employee as, 35% to
Salesman Manish and 65% to Salesman Jemil. Sold 2,000 Nos, of Booklets @ ₹
5/ Nos and 40 Nos of Antivirus CD’s @ ₹ 750 each
Name of Stock Quantity Rate/Nos Amount
Booklets 2,000 5/No 10,000
Antivirus CD’s 40 750 30,000
Table 9.20
367
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To record the transaction of table 9.20 in the books of account, first ensure that the required
masters are created in Tally.ERP 9
R
AI
The Auto Cost Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 9.8:
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
-S
Ledgers
21
Sales A/c
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Sales A/c
Under Select Sales Accounts
Inventory values are affected? Set to Yes
Cost Centres Applicable? Set to Yes
Table 9.21
368
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Stock Item
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Items > Create
Booklets
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Booklets
Under Select Primary
Units Select Nos
R
(Bring the cursor in the units field and press
AI
Alt+C to create Units of Measure)
N
Opening Enter Quantity as 2,000 – Rate as 4
AN
Table 9.22
AR
H
ED
Antivirus CD
Against the Field Action to be Performed
LE
Name Enter as Antivirus CD
R
U
The Sales Voucher Creation screen with cost center class selection appears as shown in the
21
figure 9.9:
R
369
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 9.9 Selection of CC Classes
H
5. In the Party A/c name field select the ledger SBI Bank
ED
6. In Sales ledger field select Sales A/c
7. Select the stock items, 2,000 Nos of Booklet @ ₹ 5/ Nos and 40 Nos of Antivirus CD
LE
@ ₹ 750 each.
R
U
The Sales Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 9.10
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Observation: Once after recording the entry check the ledger break-up report. To do so, go to Gateway of Tally
> Display > Statements of Accounts > Cost Centres > Ledger Break-up > Select Sales A/c ledger. In Cost
Breakup of Ledger, we can observe that the amount is allocated to their respective cost centres based on the percentages
defined at the cost centre classes.
370
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9.4 Cost Centre Reports
Cost centre reports are primarily performance reports. To access Cost Centre reports,
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Cost Centres
R
Let us discuss each report in detail.
AI
N
9.4.1 Category Summary
AN
This report lists out all cost categories for which transactions have been allocated. Below each cost
category, all the cost centres under the cost category are also listed, with the sub-cost centres, if
AR
any.
H
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Accounts > Cost Centres > Category
Summary
ED
LE
The Cost Category Summary report for the period 01-07-2017 to 20-10-2017 appears as shown
R
Observation: In figure 9.11, we can observe that the values falling under credit column indicates the income
generated by the unit and the value falling under debit column indicates the expenses incurred by the unit.
From the report of figure 9.11, we can drill down to the transaction level.
Month-wise Cost Centre Summary
Selecting a cost centre, and pressing Enter leads to the Month-wise Cost Centre report. You can
add new column and select another cost centre to view the details. This helps in analysing the
performance of cost centres month-wise.
371
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Select Junior and press Enter, to get the Month-wise Cost Centre Monthly Summary of
Junior will appear
You have the option to add a new column and select another cost centre.
Cost Centre Vouchers Report
All transactions pertaining to a cost centre will be displayed in this report.
Press Enter on the required option and you will get the Cost Centre Vouchers report
The Cost Centre Vouchers screen is also accessible from all other Cost Centre Reports but
the vouchers displayed are only those that relate to the currently selected cost centre.
R
these transactions, with details of the transaction values and balance are displayed here.
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display >. Statements of Accounts > Cost Centres
N
2. Select Cost Centre Break-up
AN
3. Select Salesman Manish, from the List of Cost Centres
4. Press F2:Period and change the period 1-07-2017 to 20-10-2017
AR
5. Press Alt+F1
The Breakup of Cost Centres screen appears as shown in the figure 9.12:
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
One ledger can be allocated to different cost centres. For example, the ledger Cost of expenses is
allocated to Junior and senior. We can view a comparative report of conveyance expenditures
incurred by the two cost centres using the Ledger Break-up report.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display >. Statements of Accounts > Cost Centres
2. Select Cost of Expenses
The Cost Breakup of Ledger screen appears as shown in the figure 9.13:
372
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 9.13 Cost Breakup of Ledger Screen
H
9.4.4 Group Break-up ED
LE
This report displays the summarised information of all Cost Centres for the selected Group. We
can drill down to the list of vouchers.
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display >. Statements of Accounts > Cost Centres
U
.
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
373
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
classes in Tally.ERP 9. We have seen how these cost centers values will get updated in the report
instantly, once after recording the transactions.
Key Takeaways
A Cost Centre is a unit of an organisation to which expenses as well as incomes are
allocated.
Cost Categories are used when the organisations have to allocate resources to parallel
sets of cost centres.
Cost Centre Classes are used to automate the allocation of cost centre and cost
categories.
In Tally.ERP 9 we can allocate expenses to multiple cost centre
R
AI
Shortcut Keys
N
Shortcut Key Description
AN
F2 From voucher creation screen
To change the date
AR
F4 From cost centre voucher report
H
To select the required cost centre
ED
F6 From cost centre voucher report
To navigate to daily breakup of cost
LE
centre
R
Practice Exercises
-S
a. True
b. False
00
86
b. False
21
3. Match the following items and select the appropriate answer from the given response
R
sheet.
374
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Cost Category is used for ______.
a. Making accounting impact of Cost Centres
b. To enable parallel allocation of costs
c. To automate allocation of costs in transaction
d. None of these
R
d. Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Ledger > Create > F12
AI
N
6. From the below given, Figure 9.15 find the total expense amount incurred by junior and
AN
senior level employees
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
a. ₹ 1,50,000
375
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
b. ₹ 75,000
c. ₹ 2,25,000
d. ₹ 3,00,000
7. Which of the following reports is not available in Tally.ERP 9 for Cost Centres?
a. Category Summary
b. Cost Centre Break-up
c. Ledger Break-up
d. Stock Item Break-up
R
8. In the below given Figure 9.16, the cost of expenses of ₹ 40,000/- is allocated to _____
AI
Cost Centre
N
Figure 9.16 Cost Centre Vouchers Screen
AN
a. Salesman Jemil
b. Salesman Manish
AR
c. Senior Grade
d. Junior
H
9. Cost Centre can be grouped under cost centre
ED
LE
a. True
b. False
R
U
a. True
b. False
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
376
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
377
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 10
MIS Reports
Learning Objectives
R
AI
Identify and list the purpose of different MIS reports
N
Generate MIS reports in Tally.ERP 9
AN
Customize and analyse MIS reports in Tally.ERP 9
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
378
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
10.1 Introduction
Management Information Systems, commonly referred by its acronym MIS. It is an information
system designed to provide management with accurate and timely information necessary for
evaluating business activities, tracking progress and decision making.
Based on the nature of business, MIS reports differ from organisation to organisation and division
to division. For example, the daily MIS report of a customer call-center, will include reports that
capture detail like total number of calls received from customers, total number calls received for
R
new sales, total number of calls for complaints, etc. At the same time, for a company that deals in
AI
buying and selling of products to the customers on credit and cash basis, would maintain periodic
N
MIS reports that reflect details like total number of purchases and sales made by the company,
total bills payables, total bills receivables, etc.
AN
Similarly, within the same organisation different divisions/departments require different types of
AR
MIS Reports for arriving at business decisions related to their functional area. Thus, a revenue and
H
expenses reports will be useful for an Accounts manager whereas reports related to inventory and
ED
goods inflow/outflow report, will be useful to a Production manager.
LE
At the same time, every business organisation is required to prepare certain financial reports that
R
should the business profit or loss (Profit and Loss account) and financial position of the company
U
Systems
6 -S
00
00
MIS Reports comes with many advantages, few of which are listed below:
86
Aids in Faster Decision Making: MIS reports provide instant and accurate data which
8
help the management in taking right decisions at the right time i.e., supports the
11
Aids in Planning: It provides information based on which managers can plan business
activities.
R
Collection and Storage of Information: The bigger an organisation, bigger the problem
of collecting and maintaining data and information. MIS helps handle large volumes of
data with ease.
Evaluation of Performance: MIS help in setting performance standards, monitoring
performance, taking corrective measures in case of deviations in plans, etc.
379
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
10.3 Types of MIS Reports in Tally.ERP 9
Accounting Reports: To obtain information on the financial position, operational performance
and economic activities of the business.
Financial Reports: To determine the financial condition of an organisation as required by
shareholders, creditors and government units.
Inventory Reports: To manage the Inventory effectively since the actual status of stock items is
obtained.
R
AI
Management Control Reports: To utilise budgets, cost centre reports, scenario reports etc. for
N
controlling activities.
AN
10.4 MIS Reports in Tally. ERP 9
AR
Tally.ERP 9 facilitates instant generation of MIS Reports. A few types of commonly used MIS
H
Reports, which can be generated using Tally.ERP 9 are discussed below:
Trial Balance ED
LE
Profit and Loss A/c
R
Balance Sheet
U
Ratio Analysis
TE
Day Book
6
Bills Receivables
00
Bills Payables
86
Purchase Register
Sales Register
8
11
Exception Report
21
Let us understand the use of MIS Reports with the help of a business scenario.
R
Business Scenario
Mark Brothers started a company namely Mark Traders dealing in Mobile Phones. The company’s
business operations extended to dealers in India and Japan.
Activity: Create a company in Tally.ERP 9 with the following details:
Company Name: Mark Traders
Address: No 505, 18th Cross VTR Park, Begur Main Road, Bengaluru.
Country: India
380
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
State: Karnataka
Financial Year: 01-04-2017 to 31-03-2018
The details of the company’s transactions during the first six months of operations are given below:
Create necessary masters and record the below transactions in said vouchers.
Date Particulars
01-07-2017 Voucher: Receipt
Mark Traders invested ₹ 20, 00,000 as Capital in their company Mark Traders.
R
They deposited the amount in the company bank account in SBI through a DD.
AI
N
01-07-2017 Voucher: Purchase
AN
Purchased the following stock item from AK Traders; domestic trader on credit
AR
with the Bill Ref No.01
H
Name of the Stock Godown Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount
Item
ED (₹)
LE
K5 Mobile Phones Main 100 Nos 1,000 1,00,000
Location
R
U
IM
Item (₹)
8
11
381
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01-10-2017 Voucher: Purchase
Purchased the following stock item from PIP Traders; International trader from
Japan on credit with the Bill Ref No.02
R
15-11-2017 Voucher: Sales
AI
Sold the following Stock Item to ST Traders; domestic trader on credit with the
N
Bill Ref No. SA/02
AN
Name of the Stock Godown Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount
AR
Item (₹)
H
K6 Mobile Phones Main 100 Nos 3,000 3,00,000
ED
Location
LE
01-12-2017 Voucher: Sales
R
U
Sold the following Stock Item to the domestic customer on cash with the Bill
IM
Item (₹)
K5 Mobile Phones Main 10 Nos 2,000 20,000
-S
Location
6
00
00
Purchased following stock item from the domestic trader on cash with the Bill
8
Ref No.03
11
21
Item (₹)
K6 Mobile Phones Main 20 Nos 1,000 20,000
Location
Table 10.1
To record the above transactions in Tally.ERP 9.
Create the necessary ledgers before recording the above given transactions.
382
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note
1) Create two separate purchase ledgers
International Purchases
Domestic Purchases
2) Create two separate sales ledgers
International Sales
R
Domestic Sales
AI
3) Create PIP Traders party ledgers selecting country as Japan.
N
AN
AR
The management is interested in receiving information related to Sales Revenue generated within
the country and outside the country, Cash and Fund Flow details, Payable and Receivable
H
details and the Financial Performance of the company in the first 6 months of business.
Now, let us see how different reports can be generated from Tally.ERP 9 to meet the ED
LE
management’s information needs.
R
U
IM
A trial balance is a statement showing the balances or total of debits and credits of all the accounts
TE
in the ledger. It helps in the preparation of financial statements such as Profit & Loss account,
Balance Sheet and Cash Flow statements. In a Trial Balance, the balances of various accounts
-S
(debit balances and credit balances) are listed in a sheet or a statement at the end of the accounting
6
00
period.
00
All revenue and expense accounts appearing in the trial balance are transferred to the trading and
86
profit and loss accounts and all liabilities, capital, and asset accounts are transferred to the balance
sheet
8
11
To generate Trial Balance for Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
R
383
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 10.1 Trial Balance Screen
ED
LE
10.4.2 Balance Sheet
R
U
IM
A Balance Sheet is a financial statement that reports a business’ financial position as on a specific
FF
date. The term balance sheet implies that the report shows the balance between two figures. It
TE
shows a balance between the assets and liabilities of a business. The fundamental accounting
equation is,
6 -S
The accounting equation is inbuilt in Tally.ERP 9. It takes information from the Chart of Accounts
00
created and transactions entered to create the Balance Sheet automatically. No extra processing is
86
To generate Balance Sheet for Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
R
384
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.2 Balance Sheet Screen
H
The Balance Sheet in Tally.ERP 9, gets updated automatically with every transaction that is
ED
recorded. Notice the first line on the left shows the Capital Account information as an impact of
LE
the first transaction. A Balance Sheet is always prepared as on a particular date; in this case it is
R
From the above report we can get the details of Liabilities and Assets, from which the financial
IM
The Button Bar can be used to view additional information or toggle to another report.
TE
o Display the Balance Sheet for a different date and compare with the current one
o Display the Balance Sheet of another company when more than one company is open
8
11
o Enable the option Show Vertical Balance Sheet to view the Balance Sheet in Vertical
format
o Enable the option Show Percentages to view the amounts as a percentage of total in
a separate column
385
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
during the reporting period are recorded in the Profit and Loss account or Income and
Expenditure account.
The Profit and Loss account in Tally.ERP 9 displays the information based on the default primary
groups. It is updated instantly with every transaction/voucher that is entered and saved. No special
processing is required to produce a Profit and Loss account in Tally.ERP 9.
Illustration 3: Generation of profit and loss account and applying configurations to get
reports in desired formats using Tally.ERP 9
To generate Profit & Loss A/c for Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
R
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Profit and Loss Account
N
2. Click F1: Detailed, to view the Profit and Loss Account in the detailed format
AN
The Profit and Loss Account screen appears as shown in the figure 10.3:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
Note: If gross profit and loss is not displayed in the above report, press F12: Configure and enable the option
21
The Profit & Loss account is generated and updated immediately from the date of opening of
books till the date of last entry. It is displayed according to the configurations set in the F12:
Configure menu.
The Profit & Loss account, by default is displayed in the horizontal format. However, this can be
configured to display the same in a vertical format by selecting the option in F12: Configure.
Some of the Button Bar options are:
386
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Change the date of the Profit & Loss account using F2: Period
Add new columns to:
o Display the Profit & Loss account for a different period to compare with the current
one
o See the effect of different Stock Valuations on the Profit & Loss account
o Select and compare Profit & Loss accounts of different companies
Press F12: Configure and set the required parameters such as:
o Enable the option Show Vertical Profit & Loss Account, to view the profit and loss
account in vertical format
R
o Enable the option Show Percentages to view the amounts as a percentage of total in
AI
a separate column
N
o Enable the option Show with Gross Profit to view the Gross Profit along with the
Nett Profit
AN
AR
10.4.4 Cash Flow Statement
H
A Cash Flow Statement is a record of the amounts in cash and cash equivalents entering and
ED
leaving a company. It complements the Balance Sheet and Profit and Loss Account. A Cash Flow
LE
Statement helps a business owner (and other stakeholders) understand how or from where the
company’s money is coming, and where it is being spent.
R
U
A Cash Flow Statement shows only the actual cash inflows and outflows of a company, unlike a
IM
Balance Sheet or Profit and Loss account which also show future cash incomings and outgoings
(i.e, credit transactions). Based on the grouping of ledgers and transactions entered, Tally.ERP 9
FF
Cash flow statements can also be used as receipts and payments statement. This is particularly
-S
useful for businesses such as non-profit organizations where receipts and payments statements
6
need to be generated.
00
Illustration 4: Generation of cash flow statement and applying configurations to get reports
00
To generate Cash Flow Statement for Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
8
11
The Cash Flow Statement screen appears as shown in the figure 10.4:
R
387
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.4 Cash Flow Statement Screen
H
The Cash Flow statement is displayed in terms of monthly break-up for the financial year. For the
ED
month of May Mark Traders’ Net Flow shows a negative balance, because in that month the
company has had only cash outflows but no cash inflows.
LE
Tally.ERP 9 also provides a graphical presentation of monthly cash inflows and outflows at the
R
U
bottom of the report. To view the details of any particular month, move the cursor to the
IM
4. Now, click F1: Detailed, to view the Cash Flow Statement in detailed format:
-S
The Cash Flow Summary screen appears as shown in the figure 10.5:
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Figure 10.5 Cash Flow Summary from July to December 2017 Screen
388
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Cash Flow Statement for a particular month shows the inflow details on the left pane and the
outflow details on the right pane. It also highlights the Net inflow at the bottom centre of the
screen.
Additionally the following actions can be performed to customize the report as per requirements:
R
format
AI
o Enable the option Show Percentages to view the amounts as a percentage of total in
N
a separate column
AN
AR
10.4.5 Funds Flow Statement
H
A Fund Flow statement is a report, which explains the movement of funds during an accounting
ED
period. The statement consists of Sources of funds and Application of funds.
LE
The difference between the two shows the net change in the working capital during the period.
Only those transactions that affect the net working capital of the firm, find place in this statement.
R
U
To generate Funds Flow Statement for Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
TE
The Funds Flow Statement screen appears as shown in the figure 10.6:
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
389
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Funds Flow statement is displayed in terms of monthly break-up for the financial year.
Tally.ERP 9 also provides a graphical presentation of monthly cash inflow and outflow at the
bottom of the report. To view the details of any particular month, move the cursor to the
respective line and press the Enter key.
2. Press F2: Period and enter the date from 01-07-2017 to 31-12-2017
3. Now, click F1: Detailed, to view the Cash Flow Statement in detailed format:
The Funds Flow Summary screen appears as shown in the figure 10.7:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
Figure 10.7 Funds Flow Summary from July to December 2017 Screen
-S
Additionally the following actions can be performed to customise the report as per requirements:
6
o Enable the option Show Vertical Funds Flow Summary to view the report in vertical
00
format
86
o Enable the option Show Percentages to view the amounts as a percentage of total in
a separate column
8
11
Ratio express numerical relationship between two numbers. The relationship of one item to
R
another is expressed in simple mathematical form known as a ratio. Accounting ratios are
expressed in the form of time proportion, percentage or per one rupee.
The Ratio Analysis report provides a critical overview of a company’s performance in the form of
ratios. Not only does this report provide an instant understanding of the Working Capital, the
Operating Cost percentage and Gross Profit percentage, but also gives information about the
payment performance of debtors. The return on investment percentage and the return on working
capital percentage are other critical ratios available in this report. Tally.ERP 9 uses the data from
transactions to arrive at the ratios. The report is generated automatically.
390
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Illustration 6: Generation of ratio analysis report and applying configurations to get reports
in desired formats using Tally.ERP 9
To generate Ratio Analysis Report for Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Ratio Analysis
The Ratio Analysis report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.8:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
The Ratio Analysis report has two primary parts: Principal Groups and Principal Ratios. Each
line item on both sections provide unique insights into a company’s financial status.
6 -S
Financial MIS Reports are very important for a business, not only for legal purposes but also for
00
ensuring good health of the business. Tally.ERP 9 generates all the financial MIS Reports instantly
00
thus saving a lot of time for the business and helps it prosper by providing key information at the
right time.
8 86
In Tally.ERP 9, as soon as transactions are entered they are immediately posted to the respective
21
ledgers, books and registers, thereby facilitating instant generation of report and faster decision
R
making.
Books of Account is a record of the commercial accounts of a company and consolidates the
transaction details as they are entered. Although the elements of a transaction are posted into many
different ledgers simultaneously. Tally.ERP 9 brings all the transactions of a particular type
together into relevant books of account for viewing and printing. For example, Cash Book records
all the transactions affecting cash and the Sales Book records all sales transactions
391
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
10.4.7.1 Day Book
The Day Book contains a record of all transactions made by a business, irrespective of the type of
transaction. By default the display is set to the date of the last voucher entry made, but this can be
set to list all the transactions made over a certain period.
Transactions include all financial vouchers, reversing and memorandum journals as well as
inventory vouchers.
Illustration 7: Understanding how to generate Day Book in Tally.ERP 9
To generate Day Book for Mark Traders for the period 01-07-2017 to 31-12-2017, follow the steps
R
given below:
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display>Day Book
N
2. Click F2: Period on the button bar and specify the period as from 01-07-2017 to 31-12-
AN
2017
AR
The Day Book screen appears as shown in the figure 10.9:
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
The report of figure 10.9 displays the details of day to day transactions recorded from 01-04-
21
From the report of figure 10.9, press F4: Change Voucher, to view the transactions related to a
particular voucher type.
392
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
It starts with the opening balance of Cash and Bank and ends with the closing balance of
Cash and Bank.
It does not take into account outstanding receivables and payables.
It may be Capital or Revenue in nature, relating to the current, previous or subsequent
year; as long as they are actually received or paid, they must appear in this account
No special processing is required to produce a Receipts and Payments account in Tally.ERP 9,
once the transactions are recorded then the report will be updated automatically.
Illustration 8: Generation of receipts and payments report and applying configurations to
get reports in desired formats using Tally.ERP 9
R
To generate Receipts and Payments report of Mark Traders for the period 01-07-2017 to 31-12-
AI
2017, follow the steps given below:
N
AN
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display> Receipts and Payments.
2. Press F1: Detailed, to view the Receipts and Payments report in the detailed format
AR
3. Press F2:Period and enter the period as 01-07-2017 to 31-12-2017
H
The Receipts and Payments report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.10:
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
The report of figure 10.10, can be viewed in Vertical format by enabling the option Show Vertical
Receipts & Payments to Yes in F12: Configure.
393
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To generate Purchase Register report of Mark Traders for the period 01-04-2017 to 31-12-2017,
follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display> Account Books>Purchase Register
The Purchase Register report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.11:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
The report of figure 10.11, display the details of total monthly purchases made by the company
IM
for the specified period, along with a graphical representation of the same information at the
FF
Further, you can press Enter from monthly summary to get Voucher Register. It shows all the
purchase transactions made for the specified period.
6 -S
A Sales Register displays the monthly summary of all sales transactions and the closing balances at
00
the end of each month, for the selected period. The list of transactions pertaining to any month
can be viewed by selecting the required month. Tally.ERP 9 enables change of display according
86
To generate Sales Register report of Mark Traders for the period 01-04-2017 to 31-12-2017, follow
R
394
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.12 Sales Register Screen
The report of figure 10.12, display the details of total monthly Sales of the company for the
H
ED
specified period, along with a graphical representation of the same information at the bottom of
the screen.
LE
Further, you can press Enter from monthly summary to get Voucher Register. It shows all the
R
bills and over dues becomes complicated. The Bill-wise details feature in Tally.ERP 9, will enable
6
the tracking of each transaction and efficient management of payables and receivables.
00
In Tally.ERP 9, once the transactions are recorded using Bill wise details, the receivable and
00
The Bills Receivable report in Tally.ERP 9 displays all the outstanding receivables for a company
R
395
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Bills Receivable report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.13:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 10.13 Bills Receivable Report Screen
ED
The report of figure 10.13, displays all outstanding receivables of Mark Traders invoice-by-invoice,
LE
for the period specified. This report takes into consideration only those party ledgers for which
R
Note: In the Bills Receivables report, we are getting the details of stock items, because we have enabled the
option Show Qty Info in Detailed Format in F12: Configure option.
FF
The Bills Payable report in Tally.ERP 9, displays all the outstanding payables of the company
-S
To generate Bills Payable report of Mark Traders, follow the steps given below:
00
Payables
8
2. Click F1: Detailed, to view the Bills Payables Report in the detailed format
11
21
The Bills Payables report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.14:
R
396
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.14 Bills Payable Report Screen
H
The report of figure 10.14, displays all outstanding payables of Mark Traders invoice-by-invoice,
for the period specified.
ED
LE
R
U
An organization, which is dealing with inventory, it becomes very important to track the details
of inventories like the stock available in the organisation, details of transferred stock from one
TE
godown to another, details of dead stock, details of ageing of goods etc. Instant delivery of
these information will help an organisation to make business decision faster and this in turn
-S
Inventory in Tally.ERP 9 operates in the same way as accounting with regard to displaying,
00
modifying and printing reports. Tally.ERP 9 generates inventory reports based on the vouchers
86
entered till date. You can use the customised reports to compare inventory data between
different companies, periods of the financial year, and so on.
8
11
A Stock Summary is a statement of the stock-in-hand on a particular date. It is one of the primary
R
inventory statements that is generated in Tally.ERP 9 .This report updates the stock record in real
time as and when transactions are entered. Stock Summary provides information on stock groups
and shows the quantity details, rate and closing value of the stock items under them.
Illustration 12: Generation of stock summary report using Tally.ERP 9
To view a Stock Summary Report,
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary > Press Alt+F1 for detailed mode
2. Press F12: Configure and enable Show All Items (incl. zero balance) and Expand all
levels in detailed format and accept the configuration screen.
397
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Summary screen appears as shown in the figure 10.15:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 10.15 Stock Summary Report
ED
LE
Further, you can press Enter on Stock Group and Stock Item to get the Monthly Summary and
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
10.4.8.2 Stock Transfer
Stock Transfer report displays the details of stock items which are transferred from one godown
to another godown along with quantity rate, closing balance details etc.
Illustration 13: Recording stock journal voucher and generation of stock transfer analysis
report using Tally.ERP 9
Activity
In F11: Company Features >F2: Inventory Features > Enable the option Maintain
R
multiple Godowns
AI
Create a godown as Branch Location-Mysore
N
Record the following transaction in the books of Mark Traders
AN
30-12-2017 Voucher: Stock Journal
AR
Mark Traders transferred 20 Nos of K6 Mobile Phones from Main Location to Branch
H
Location located in Mysore city
ED
LE
Name of Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
R
Table 10.2
Step 1: Recording Stock Journal Voucher
FF
To record the Stock Journal voucher in Tally.ERP 9, follow the steps given below:
TE
3. Under Source (Consumption) field, select K6 Mobile Phones under Name of Item,
00
5. Enter Quantity as 20 Nos, Rate ₹ 2,000 and the Amount ₹ 40,000 will capture
8
automatically.
11
7. Under Destination (Production) field select K6 Mobile Phones under Name of Item
R
The completed Stock Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 10.17:
399
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.17 Stock Journal Voucher Creation Screen
H
11. Accept the screen
ED
The Stock Journal transaction will impact the Stock Summary report and all inventory books. If
LE
the option integrate accounts with inventory is enabled in F11:F1:Accounting feature, then the
R
stock value will reflect in accounting reports like balance sheet, profit & loss account, trial balance
U
etc.
IM
To view the Stock Transfer/Movement Analysis report, follow the steps given below
TE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Movement Analysis>
-S
Transfer Analysis > Select Stock Journal from the List of Voucher Types
6
00
The Transfer Analysis report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.18:
00
8 86
11
21
R
400
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 10.18 Transfer Analysis Report Screen
2. Press Enter to get the Item Voucher Analysis screen
The Item Voucher Analysis screen appears as shown in the figure 10.19:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 10.19 Item Voucher Analysis Screen
R
U
This report of figure 10.19, displays the Goods Out and Goods In against the particular stock
IM
item.
FF
Once the inventory masters are set in Tally.ERP 9, Mark Traders can track the movement of
TE
stock items from one location to another location, keep count of stock items available with them,
and track the number of stock items available in different locations. This will help in faster process
-S
Movement analysis shows the analysis of only those inventory transactions which are integrated
86
with the accounts, i.e. inventories which are also recorded in the books of accounts.
8
Movement analysis report is used for comparative studies. They give an insight into the flow
11
characteristics of the stock in an organization. It also helps in finding out the slow moving items
21
which cause blockages in the flow of the working capital of the organization.
R
401
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 10.20 Movement Analysis Menu Screen
AR
Stock Group Analysis
H
Stock Group Analysis report can be viewed and configured depending on your business
requirements. You can effectively analyse the movement of stocks by using the various
ED
LE
configuration options.
R
This report shows the details of inward and outward transactions carried out for all the stock items
U
in that group.
IM
To view the Stock Group Analysis for a specific stock group, follow the steps given below:
FF
1. Press Enter on Stock Group Analysis > Select Name of the group from the List of
TE
Stock Groups
2. Press Alt+F1 for Detailed
6 -S
The Stock Group Analysis report displays as shown in the figure 10.21:
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
402
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Stock Item Analysis
Stock item movement analysis report provides supplier wise, buyer wise and consumption wise
details of stock item movement. Purchase cost comparison for the item across suppliers and sale
value comparison across buyers can be viewed here.
To view Stock Item Analysis for a specific stock item, follow the steps given below:
1. Press Enter on Stock Item Analysis > Select K6 Mobile Phones from the List of Stock
Items
The Stock Item Analysis report displays as shown in the figure 10.22:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
Group Analysis
00
00
Group Analysis report contains information about items transacted in vouchers for the Ledgers
created under the selected group.
86
To view Group Analysis for a specific Group, follow the steps given below:
8
11
1. Press Enter on Group Analysis > Select Sundry Debtors from the List of Groups
21
403
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.23 Stock Item Analysis Screen
H
Ledger Analysis
ED
LE
Ledger Analysis is similar to Group Movement Analysis, where sales and purchases of stock items
R
involving the selected ledger can be viewed. The next level of information brings up the
U
transaction-level details.
IM
To view Ledger Analysis for a specific Group, follow the steps given below:
FF
1. Press Enter on Ledger Analysis > Select AK Traders from the List of Ledgers.
TE
404
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Further drill down in reports will display the Item Voucher Analysis from Stock Group
Analysis, Stock Item Analysis, Group Analysis and Ledger Analysis.
The Item Voucher Analysis screen displays as shown in the figure 10.25:
R
AI
Figure 10.25 Item Voucher Analysis Screen
N
AN
10.4.8.4 Ageing Analysis
AR
Ageing Analysis Report, displays the age of the stock in hand. This report lists the age-wise
break-up of inventory to point out old stock. From this report we will get the details of dead stock
H
i.e. the stock which is lying from long period.
ED
Ageing Analysis lists out the batch details that have already expired or may expire in the near
LE
future. This information will help you in keeping track of the age of stock and also quick moving
inventory, since the older stock may depreciate in value or become obsolete and result in a loss.
R
U
The Ageing Analysis report will help you find out which batches have already expired, which
IM
batches are going to expire or you can even list them as per Manufactured or Purchased Date. It
is very useful for industries dealing with perishable goods where goods past the expiry date are of
FF
no value.
TE
To view the Ageing Analysis Report, follow the steps given below:
6
00
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Ageing Analysis > Select
00
the group for which Ageing Analysis is required from the List of Stock Groups
86
405
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 10.26 Ageing Period Screen
H
ED
Note: The Ageing Analysis report produces a default ageing period of <45 days, 45-90 days, 90-180 days
LE
and >180 days. Depending on requirement, the ageing slabs can be defined by you.
R
The Stock Ageing Analysis Report screen appears as shown in the figure 10.27:
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
406
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Conclusion
In this chapter, we have learnt, how MIS reports helps in the management of business organisation
in tracking business daily activities, analyzing problems, and evaluating performance thereby
hastening the decision making process. We have experienced the efficiency of Tally.ERP 9 in
generating reports based on transaction entries.
Key Takeaways
R
MIS is an acronym for Management Information Systems
AI
MIS is an information system designed to provide management with accurate and timely
N
information necessary for evaluating business activities, tracking progress and decision
AN
making.
AR
MIS Reports facilitate faster decision making.
A Balance Sheet is a financial statement that reports a firm’s financial position at a specific
H
ED
time. The fundamental accounting equation is: Assets = Liabilities + Owner’s Equity
Profit and Loss Account or Income Statement is a periodic statement, which shows the
LE
net result of business operations for a specified period.
R
A Purchase Register displays information on the purchases made by the business concern.
IM
A Sales Register displays the monthly summary of sales transactions and closing balances.
FF
Transfer Analysis report displays the details of stock items which are transferred from one
godown to another godown.
-S
Shortcut Keys
00
86
To access configuration
21
407
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Practise Exercises
1. ___________ is a statement showing the balances or total of debits and credits of all the
accounts.
a. Balance Sheet
b. Profit & Loss Account
c. Trading Account
d. Trial Balance
R
specific date.
AI
a. Balance Sheet
N
b. Profit & Loss Account
AN
c. Trading Account
d. Trial Balance
AR
H
ED
3. Liabilities plus Owners Equity = __________.
a. Income
LE
b. Expense
R
c. Current Liability
U
d. Assets
IM
FF
4. __________ is a record of the amounts of cash and cash equivalents entering and leaving
TE
a company.
a. Cash Flow Statement
-S
c. Balance Sheet
00
d. Trial Balance
00
86
c. Balance Sheet
R
d. Trial Balance
408
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
7. The _______ contains all the transactions made by a business, irrespective of the type of
transaction.
a. Day Book
b. Payables
c. Receivables
d. Payable
R
c. Cash Sales
AI
d. Bills Receivable
N
AN
9. _____________ is a liability to a Company.
AR
a. Bills Payable
H
b. Cash Purchase
ED
c. Cash Sales
d. Bills Receivable
LE
R
U
10. Which of the following reports displays the performance of the company in the form of
IM
ratio?
a. Balance Sheet
FF
c. Ratio Analysis
d. Trial Balance
6 -S
00
Given below are names of different types of reports and an explanation of each in a
86
jumbled format.
8
11
specified period.
2 Balance Sheet b It is a record of the amounts
of cash and cash
equivalents entering and leaving a
company.
3 Profit and Loss Account c It reports a business’ financial
position as on a specific date.
409
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4 Cash Flow Statement d The balances of various accounts
(debit balances and credit
balances) are listed in a sheet or a
statement at the end of the
accounting period.
R
d. 1-d, 2-c, 3-a, 4-b
AI
N
12. The head Current Asset is shown in a Profit & Loss Account.
AN
a. True
b. False
AR
H
ED
13. The Capital Account head comes under the Balance Sheet.
a. True
LE
b. False
R
U
IM
b. False
TE
-S
a. Stock Summary
00
b. Ledger Summary
00
c. Group Summary
86
d. Transfer Summary
8
11
16. Which of the following report will help in knowing the dead stock in Tally.ERP 9.
a. Stock Summary
21
b. Ageing Analysis
R
c. Transfer Analysis
d. Movement Analysis
17. Which voucher is used to record transfer of goods from one location to another?
a. Purchase Voucher
b. Sales Voucher
c. Stock Journal
d. Contra Voucher
410
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
18. Refer to the figure 10.28
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 10.28 Cash Flow Report Screen
LE
R
Why is the Nett Flow showing a negative balance in the above screenshot?
U
IM
411
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
TallyPRO - Part II
Chapter 11
Storage and Classification of
Inventory
Learning Objectives
R
AI
Godowns management
N
Creation & storing inventories in godowns
Recording purchase voucher with godown
AN
Recording sales voucher with godown
AR
Stock categories & summary reports
Create and maintain batch-wise details
H
Record transaction by honouring the expiry date of batches
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
412
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.1 Introduction
It is very important to keep the track of goods manufactured or received in batches with expiry
details and also storage of the same is very crucial for an organisation, which is dealing in
manufacturing or trading of goods. A good storing and classification details will help a business to
move out the stock on time.
In Tally.ERP 9, we can maintain storage details by activating godown feature and also classification
or grouping of stock can be maintained by enabling the option stock category and stock group.
We can also maintain the details of perishable goods, batch details, manufacturing and expiry
details in Tally.ERP 9 by enabling the option batch wise details.
R
AI
Godown is a place where inventories/ stocks are stored. You can specify the stock item to a
N
particular Godown. The user can get the reports of movement of stocks between different
AN
locations/ Godowns and inward and outward of stock items for each Godown.
Stock Category offers a parallel classification of stock items. Like stock Groups, classification is
AR
done based on similarity in behaviour
H
Business Scenario 1
ED
Sharp-Soft Industries, is into trading business of Bicycles, the Bicycles are purchased and placed
in multiple warehouses and used accordingly during sales. Sometime as per requirement the
LE
bicycles may be moved/ transferred from one warehouse to another for effective sales
R
management
U
IM
State: Karnataka
-S
Pin: 560001
Financial year: 01-04-2017 to 31-03-2018
6
00
Godown is a place where inventories/ stocks are stored. You can specify the stock item to a
particular godown. The user can get the reports of movement of stocks between different
8
locations/ godowns and inward and outward details of stock items for each godown.
11
21
In Tally.ERP 9, we have provided the feature to create godown in single mode and multiple mode
R
and also we can provide address for created godown. Stock transfers between several locations
and warehouses can be easily tracked. Based on the godown types, you can view the stock summary
from the stock summary report.
Note: In case of Job work or outsourcing, we even maintain the details of stock lying with third party
or third party stock lying with us (company), these details can be efficiently managed.
413
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2. Set the option – Maintain multiple Godowns to Yes
The Inventory Features screen appears as shown in the figure 11.1
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 11.1 Inventory Features Screen
LE
3. Accept the screen
R
U
IM
In Tally.ERP 9, we can create the godown from the inventory info menu screen. We have the
option to create a single godown at a time or multiple godowns at one go.
TE
-S
landed
86
local warehouse.
11
stored
R
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Godowns > Single Godown > Create
Local Warehouse
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Local Warehouse
414
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Under Select as Primary
Use For
Our stock with third party Set to No
Third party stock with us Set to No
Our stock with third party: Set this option to Yes, if you want to keep the track of goods sent to third
party, this option will be enabled by the principal manufacturer (the person who will outsource the work to job
worker)
Third party stock with us: Set this option to Yes, if you want to keep the track of goods received from
third party, this option will be enabled by the job worker (the person who is undertaking the outsourcing work)
R
AI
Activity: Similarly create the following godowns in Tally.ERP 9
N
Showroom Stores
Scrap Godown
AN
AR
Note: We can create multiple godown at once from Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Under
Multiple Godown > Create > Select All Items
H
11.2.3 Allocation of Stock to Particular Godown while Defining Opening ED
LE
Balance
R
U
In Tally.ERP 9, we can define the details of godown even at the time of providing stock opening
IM
balance.
FF
TE
Date Particulars
00
31-03-2017 Sharp-Soft Industries has the following stock with them in local
warehouse godown
86
Item
11
To record the above transaction, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers are
created in Tally.ERP 9.
Unit of Measure
415
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Type Let it be Simple
Symbol Enter as Nos
Formal Name Enter as Numbers
Number of decimal places Let it be as 0
Stock Item
Go to Gateway of Tally> Inventory Info> Stock Items > Under Single Stock Item > Create
Bicycle
R
AI
Against the Field Actions to be Performed
N
Name Enter as Bicycle
AN
Under Select as Primary
AR
Units Select as Nos
H
Opening Balance Enter as 15 Nos @ ₹ 4800
Godown
ED
Select as Local Warehouse
LE
The Stock Item Allocation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.2
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
In the stock item allocation screen, we are storing the stock items in local warehouse.
11.2.4 Recording of Purchase, Sales and Stock Transfers with Godown Details
In this section, we will learn to record purchase, sales and stock transfers details along with godown
and also we will be checking the impact of the recorded transaction in the godown summary and
stock summary report.
416
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.2.4.1 Purchase of Inventory
Illustration 3: Accounting of purchase, sales and stock transfer details in Tally.ERP 9
R
Bicycle 70 Nos 4,900/ Nos 3,43,,000
AI
To record the above transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
N
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
AN
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
AR
Party Ledger
H
ED
Go to Gateway of Tally> Accounts Info.> Ledgers> Create LE
Atlas Global
R
Purchase Ledger
8
11
Purchase A/c
21
417
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3.
Enter the Supplier invoice no.: PUR01
4.
In the Party A/c name field select the ledger Atlas Global
5.
In Purchase ledger field select Purchase A/c
6.
Under Name of Item, select Bicycle, and enter the details as shown in the figure no 11.
2:
The Stock Item Allocations screen with godown appears as shown in the figure 11.2:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
Once after recording the entry, go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary > Press Alt+F1, to
get the details of godown in which the stock is stored.
418
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.2.4.2 Recording stock transfer entry using stock journal
In this section, we will learn to transfer the stock from one godown to another godown and also
transferring of goods from multiple godowns to one godown.
Date Particulars
01-07-2017 Voucher: Stock Journal
On the same day, 55 Nos of Bicycle was transferred from local warehouse
R
to showroom stores
AI
Name of Stock Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
N
Item
Bicycle 55 Nos 4882.35/ Nos 2,68,529.25
AN
To record the above transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
AR
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
H
Recording Stock Journal Voucher
The Stock journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.5:
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note: In the Source (Consumption) side, select the Godown from which the stock will be moved out and in
the Destination (Production) select the Godown in which the stock will be moved in.
419
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
01‐07‐2017 The company has opened a new showroom and transferred the following
stock items from local warehouse to jayanagar stores.
Name of Item Quantity Rate Amount
Bicycle 10 Nos 4,882.35/ Nos 48,823.50
R
Date Particulars
AI
01-07-2017 Voucher: Stock Journal
The following stock items were transferred to locale warehouse from
N
jayanagar stores and showroom stores.
AN
Godown Name of Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Stock Item
AR
Jayanagar Bicycle 2 Nos 4,882.35/ 9,764.70
H
stores Nos
ED
Showroom Bicycle 5 Nos 4,882.35/ 2,4411.75
Stores Nos
LE
To record the above transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
R
Note: The class is created in order to transfer the stock items to multiple godowns at once from a single voucher.
TE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Voucher Types > Alter > Stock
-S
Journal.
6
The Voucher Type Alteration screen with class appears as shown in the figure 11.6:
00
8 86
11
21
R
420
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. Set the option – Use Class for Inter-Godown Transfers to Yes
The Voucher Type Class screen appears as shown in the figure 11.7:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 11.7 Class Godown Transfer Screen
LE
4. Accept the screen
R
U
421
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Journal Voucher Creation screen with godown transfer class appears as shown in the
figure 11.9:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 11.9 Stock Journal – Godown Transfer Class Screen ED
LE
8. Accept the screen
R
U
IM
in Tally.ERP 9.
TE
Sold Bicycle to Mega Cycle Mart, the stock was dispatch from showroom
stores godown
86
Item
11
To record the above transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
R
Party Ledger
Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers > Create
422
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Under Select as Sundry Debtors
Maintain balances bill-by-bill Set to Yes
Default Credit Period Leave it Blank
Check for credit days during voucher entry? Set to No
Inventory values are affected Set to No
Sales Ledger
Sales A/c
R
AI
Against the Field Actions to be Performed
N
Name Enter as Sales A/c
AN
Under Select as Sales Accounts
AR
Inventory values are affected Set to Yes
H
ED
Step 2: Recording Sales Voucher LE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Sales
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 01-07-2017
R
4. In the Party A/c name field select the ledger Mega Cycle Mart
5. In Sales ledger field select Sales A/c
FF
6. Under Name of Item, select Bicycle, and enter the details as shown in the figure 11.10:
TE
The Stock Item Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 11.10:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note: In the stock items allocations screen, we can define the details of godown.
423
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Sales Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.11:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 11.11 Sales Voucher Screen
LE
8. Accept the screen
R
U
IM
goods for reprocessing or sell it as a scrap. In Tally.ERP 9, we can maintain a damaged goods
TE
details.
-S
Date Particulars
86
To record the above transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
424
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.12:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 11.12 Stock Journal Screen
4. Press Ctrl+A to accept the screen
ED
LE
Observation: Once after recording the entry of figure 11.12, go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary
R
U
> Press Alt+F1, the details of the above quantity will reflect under scrap warehouse
IM
In this section, we will learn to generate godown summary and stock movement details in
TE
Tally.ERP 9. Godown summary report displays the details of godown-wise stock item details along
with quantity, rate and amount information. This report helps to understand the total quantity
-S
available in particular godown. Stock Movement report gives the details of the stock inward and
6
stock outward.
00
00
Godown Summary
86
2. Select Primary
11
425
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.13 Godown Summary Screen
H
Observation: From the report of figure 11.13, we can observe the godown-wise details of stock item, by this
ED
information we will come to know the total number of stock available in particular godown.
LE
Movement Analysis
R
U
IM
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Movement Analysis> Stock
Group Analysis
FF
2. Select Primary
TE
426
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.3 Stock Category
Stock Category offers a parallel classification of stock items. Like stock Groups, classification is
done based on similarity in behaviour.
Business Scenario
Sharp-Soft Industries deals in weather cover of different brands like Hercules and Sharp with 10
& 12, size. Now the company wants to know the availability of stock items based on sizes and
irrespective of their brand.
R
11.3.1 Activation of Stock Categories
AI
In order to set the parallel classification for stock item, stock category feature should be activated
N
in Tally.ERP 9.
AN
To enable the stock categories, follow the steps given below:
AR
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Press F11: Company Features > F2: Inventory Features
H
2. Set the option – Maintain stock categories to Yes
ED
The Inventory Features screen appears as shown in the figure 11.15: LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
427
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Bicycle Cover (Sharp‐12)
Once after enabling the stock category in Tally.ERP 9, next steps is to create the stock category,
to do so, follow the steps given below:
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Categories > Create
Size 10
Against the Field Action to be Performed
R
Name Enter as Size 10
AI
N
Under Select as Primary
AN
The Stock Category Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.16
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
Co
Stock Category
Size 12
21
R
428
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Category Select as Size 10
Units Select as Nos
The Stock Item Creation with stock category appears as shown in the figure 11.17:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
Bicycle Cover (Sharp‐10) Size 10
TE
Bicycle Cover (Hercules‐12) Size 12
Bicycle Cover (Sharp‐12) Size 12
6 -S
Once after setting the stock categories in stock items, once after recording the transactions using
00
the stock items in which the stock category is defined, the reports related to stock categories will
00
In this section, we will learn to record the transactions with stock items in which stock category
is defined.
21
R
429
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Bicycle Cover 100 Nos 125/Nos 12,500
(Sharp-10)
Bicycle Cover 100 Nos 130/Nos 13,000
(Hercules -12)
Bicycle Cover 100 Nos 130/Nos 13,000
(Sharp -12)
To record the above transactions, in the books of account, first ensure that the required ledgers
are created in Tally.ERP 9.
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F9: Purchase
AI
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 04-07-2017
N
3. Enter the Supplier invoice no.: PUR02
AN
4. In the Party A/c name field select the ledger Atlas Global
5. In Purchase ledger field select Purchase A/c
AR
6. Under Name of Item, select Bicycle Cover (Hercules -10)
7. In the Stock Item Allocations screen, enter the godown as local warehouse, quantity as
H
100 Nos and rate as ₹125 details
8. Similarly select the other stock items as shown in the figure 11.18:
The Purchase Voucher appears as shown in the figure 11.18: ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
Once after recording the transaction the details will be updated in stock category summary report.
To check Stock Category Summary report, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Inventory > Categories > Select
Size 10
2. Press Alt+F2, enter the period as 01-07-2017 – 31-07-2017
3. Press Alt+F1, to view in detailed mode
The Stock Category Summary report appears as shown in the figure 11.19:
430
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.19 Stock Category Summary Screen
H
In the report of figure 11.19, we are getting the total quantity of stock items falling under stock
ED
category - size 10 irrespective of their brand – hercules and sharp. Similarly we can check the
details of other stock category.
LE
Batch details are used to identify the movement of inventory in batches or lots. Although this is a
FF
requirement primarily of the pharmaceutical industry, the same can be used by other industries
TE
that maintain or manufacture perishable goods. Many organizations also purchase in batches in
-S
order to monitor the result of the batch purchased individually. Hence, Tally.ERP 9 has used the
term Batch/Lot.
6
00
Batches/Lots are also often used to monitor the date of manufacture, date of receipt and the date
00
of expiry. Tally.ERP 9 makes provisions to enter both the manufacturing date and the expiry date
to take decisions as required.
86
Batch-wise details are given for maintaining batch information pertaining to stock items. The
8
Manufacturing date and expiry date can be set for the batches.
11
Let us understand how to use the batch-wise details feature in Tally.ERP 9 through the below
21
given scenario
R
Business Scenario
Sharp-Soft Industries diversified its business and now started dealing in medicines which is
traded in lots/batches. It has two Godowns, namely Onsite and Stores and it wants to keep the
track of the expiry and manufacturing dates.
431
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Press F11: Company Features > F2: Inventory Features
2. Set the option – Maintain batch-wise details to Yes
3. Set expiry dates for batches to Yes
The Inventory Features screen appears as shown in the figure 11.20:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
In this section, we will learn to set manufacturing and expiry details and set batch wise details while
-S
Date Particulars
86
One Box contains 100 blister packs of tablets; with Batch No. RGBP-001 and
manufacturing and expiry dates are 31-07-2017 and 31-12-2017 respectively
21
To record the above transactions in the books of account, first ensure that the required masters
are created in Tally.ERP 9
432
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Party Ledger
Timela Pharmaceuticals
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Timela Pharmaceuticals
Under Select as Sundry Creditors
R
Maintain balances bill by bill Set to Yes
AI
Default credit period Leave it Blank
N
Check for credit days during voucher entry? Set to No
AN
Inventory values are affected Set to No
AR
Purchase Ledger
H
Purchase of Medicines
Against the Field Action to be Performed
ED
LE
Name Enter as Purchase of Medicines
Under Select Purchase Accounts
R
Stock Group
TE
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Groups > Create
Antioxidant
-S
Units of Measure
11
21
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Unit of Measure > Create
R
Simple Unit
Blister Packs
Against the field Name Action to be performed
Type Select Simple
Symbol Enter as Bpks
Formal name Enter as Blister Packs
Number of decimal places Let it be as 0
433
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Compound Unit
A Compound Unit is a relation between two Simple Units. Hence, before you create a Compound
Unit, ensure that you have already created the required Simple Units.
Compound Type
Box of 100 Bpks
Against the field Name Action to be performed
Type Select as Compound
First Unit Enter as Bx
Conversion Factor Enter 100
R
Second Unit Enter as Nos
AI
The Completed Unit Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.21:
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
Godown
8
11
Onsite
R
434
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Stock Item
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Items > Create
Reginseng-10mg
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Reginseng-10mg
Under Select as Antioxidant
Category Select as Not Applicable
Units Select as Box of 100 Bpks
Maintain in batches Set to Yes
Track date of manufacturing? Set to Yes
Use expiry dates? Set to Yes
R
AI
The Completed Stock Item Creation screen with batch details appears as shown in the figure
N
11.22:
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
2. Press F12: Configure > Press F12: Advance Configuration and set the option Allow
use of expired batches for all stock items to No
21
435
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.23 Stock Item Allocations Screen
H
12. Press enter and End of List
ED
13. Enter the Bill wise Details and accept the screen
LE
The Purchase Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.24:
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
436
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Once after recording the purchase entry, go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books
> Batch, select the item and batch number, to view batch wise details. In Batch voucher report,
the purchase details will be captured under Inward column.
R
AI
Illustration 11: Sales of goods with Batch details
N
Pass the following transaction in the book of Sharp-Soft Industries:
AN
Date Particulars
AR
07-11-2017 Voucher: Sales
Sold goods on cash and generated Cash Invoice for Batch No RGBP-001
H
Name of Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
ED
Reginseng-10mg 200 Box ₹ 250/Box 50,000
LE
R
To record the above transactions in the books of account, first ensure that the required masters
U
The Stock Item Allocations with batch wise details appears as shown in the figure 11.25:
21
R
437
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.25 List of Active Batches
10. Enter the Quantity as 200 Box and ₹ 250 Rate fields respectively
H
ED
The Sales Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.26:
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
Date Particulars
15-01-2018 Voucher: Sales
Made cash sales and generated Cash Invoice for Batch No RGBP-001
Name of Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Reginseng-10mg 30 Box ₹ 250/Box 7,500
To record the above transactions in the books of account, first ensure that the required masters
are created in Tally.ERP 9
438
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Recording Sales Voucher
R
10. From the List of Active Batches, select the Batch No. RGBP-001
AI
N
The Stock Item Allocations screen with batch no. details appears as shown in the figure 11.27:
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
Note:
86
As shown in the figure 11.27, the Batch No. RGBP-001 is not appearing because the batch has expired
on 31-12-2017. Hence, it is not made available in the List of Active Batches.
8
11
If you want the expired batches to be displayed in the List of Active Batches, then the same can be achieved
by enabling the option Allow use of expired batches for all stock items in F12: Advanced
21
Configuration.
R
Similarly, you have the option of Show batches with zero quantity in the List of Active
Batches from F12: Advanced Configuration.
The Stock Item Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 11.28:
439
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.28 Stock Item Allocation Screen
13. Press Enter to accept
H
ED
The Sales Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.29:
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
440
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
23-01-2018 Voucher: Stock Journal
Sharp-Shop Industries, transferred expired stock of Batch No. RGBP-001,
from the Onsite Godown to the Scrap Warehouse, since the stock items got
expired
Name of Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
Reginseng-10mg 1,000 Box ₹ 200/Box 2,00,000
To record the above transactions in the books of account, first ensure that the required masters
are created in Tally.ERP 9
R
AI
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Press Alt+F7: Stock Journal
N
2. Press F12: Configure and set the option Allow use of expired batches for all stock
items to Yes
AN
The Stock Journal Configuration screen appears as shown in the figure 11.30:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
Note: Set the option - Allow use of expired batches for all stock items must be Yes, this option is
8
11
enabled to get the expired batch listed in the List of Active Batches. If the option is set to No, then the expired
batch RGBP-001 will not get listed in the List of Active Batches)
21
R
441
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 11.31 List of Active Batches in the Stock Journal
ED
7. Select the batch number from which you want to transfer the goods select RGBP-001
LE
8. Enter the Quantity as 1,000 Nos @ Rate as 200/ Nos, the amount will be calculated
R
automatically.
U
IM
Note: Do not change the manufacturing date and expiry date while recoding stock journal voucher
FF
9.
Under the Destination (Production) column select the following details
10.
Under Name of Item select the stock item - Reginseng-10mg
TE
11.
Select the Godown as Scrap Warehouse
-S
12.
Enter the new Batch number as RGBP/EXP/RNV – 001
13.
Enter the Quantity as 1,000 and Rate @ 200/ Nos, the amount will be captured
6
00
automatically
14. Enter the Manufacturing Date as 01-07-2017 and Expiry Date as 31-12-2017.
00
The Stock Item Allocations screen with expired batch details appears as shown in the figure
86
11.32:
8
11
21
R
442
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.32 Item Allocation Screen
H
15. Press Enter to accept
ED
The Completed Stock Journal Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.33:
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
Note: Stock Journal voucher can also be used to record the details of manufacturing process in Tally.ERP 9.
Once after recording the entry go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory >Statements
of Inventory > Godowns > Select Scrap Warehouse
The Godown Summary report of scrap warehouse appears as shown in the figure 11.34:
443
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.34 Godown Summary Report Screen
In the Godown Summary report, we are getting the details of stock item available in scrap
H
warehouse. This report indicates the total value of scrap lying with us, in this case it is ₹ 2,
ED
09,800.
11.4.5 Batch Reports
LE
R
In this section, we will learn to generate and analyse the details available in batch reports like batch
U
Batch Vouchers is a list of all vouchers for a particular stock item of the same batch for a given
TE
period. This report comprises of both inwards and outwards transactions along with Quantity,
Rate and Closing Value details for the selected batch.
6 -S
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Batch and press enter
2. Select the required Stock Item and Batch from the List of Batches
8 86
The Batch Items screen with list of batches appears as shown in the figure 11.35:
11
21
R
444
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 11.35 Selection of Batch of Stock Item screen
AR
3. Select the Batch No. RGBP-001
4. Press F2: Period and set the period from 01-07-2017 to 31-03-2018
H
The Batch Voucher report appears as shown in the figure 11.36:
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
Note: The report of figure 11.36, shows that one purchase, one sales have been made using Batch no. RGBP-
001 and also it displays the details of stock transfer. It is displays the details of batch manufactured date and expiry
date.
Activity: The same report can be generated from the Stock Summary report. To generate the same, go to
Gateway of Tally > Stock summary > Select the Group Antioxidant> Select the Stock Item Reginseng-10mg >
Bring the cursor in the May month > Press Enter > Press F5: Batch > Select the Name of Item and Batch to
view the Batch Vouchers report.
445
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.4.5.2 Batch Summary Report
Batch Summary is a summary of all the batches of a particular stock item for a given period. We
can select the required batch and further drill down to view the Batch Monthly Summary and
then further to the batch voucher report of the selected batch of an item.
To view the batch summary report, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Batch
2. Select the required Stock Item and select the Batch from the List of Batches
3. Select the required Batch number
4. Press F2: Period and set the period from 01-07-2017 to 31-03-2018
5. Press F6: Batch Summary and then press Alt+F1: Detailed
R
AI
The Batch Summary report appears as shown in the figure 11.37:
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
-S
Note: Press F12: Configure from the above screen and enable the options Show Mfg date and Show exp
00
date and check the Batch Summary report. It will display the expiry and manufacturing date details.
86
From the report of figure 11.37, we will get the details of the stock available in the selected
8
Transfer analysis report gives you the details of stock transferred from one location to another
with quantity, rate and additional cost details, it will also give you the details of Batches/Lots.
446
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.38 Transfer Analysis Report - with Batch Manufacturing & Expiry Details
H
In the transfer analysis report, we will get the transfer details like goods in, goods out and other
ED
inventory information like quantity, value, additional cost etc.
LE
11.5 Stock Valuation Methods
R
Important goal of accounting for inventory is to have accurate information about the costs and
U
IM
sales. Stock valuation allows a company to provide a monetary value for stock items lying in their
inventory. This information allows a company to properly evaluate expenses and revenues on their
FF
There are different types of stock valuation methods that can be used for accurate stock valuations
based on the nature of business.
-S
Different types of stock valuation methods available in Tally.ERP 9 are listed below:
6
1. At Zero Cost
00
2. Average Cost
00
4. FIFO Perpetual
8
7. LIFO Perpetual
R
447
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
There are different types of stock valuation methods available for calculating the recorded value
of closing stock (ending inventory) in Tally.ERP 9.
Business Scenario
Sharp-Shop Industries, diversified its business and now deals in buying and selling of Mobile
phones like TK-4 and Techno TK-5. The company wants to calculate its closing stock value based
on FIFO method
R
Tally.ERP 9.
AI
N
Illustration 14: Creation of stock items with their respective stock valuation method
AN
Name of Stock Item Stock Valuation Method
AR
KT-4 FIFO Perpetual
H
KT-5 FIFO Perpetual
MK-4
ED LIFO Perpetual
LE
To configuration of stock valuation method for given stock items, follow the steps given below:
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. >Stock Item > Create, you will get the
U
IM
following screen:
The Stock Item Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 11.39:
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
448
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Item Creation screen with F12: Configure appears as shown in the figure 11.40:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 11.40 Stock Item Creation (Filled) screen
ED
6. Press F12: Configure from the figure 11.40 and set the option Allow advance entries in
LE
Masters to Yes, as shown in the figure 11.41:
R
U
The Stock Item Configuration screen appears as shown in the figure 11.41:
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
449
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.42 Stock Item Creation with Behaviour Column
8. By default, the costing method selected is the Average Cost Method
H
ED
Note: In Tally.ERP 9 stock valuation methods are displayed under Costing Method
LE
9. Bring the cursor in the Costing method field and press Space bar button to get the list
R
The Stock Item Creation screen with costing method appears as shown in the figure 11.43
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
450
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.44 Completed Stock Item Creation screen
Note: The stock valuation method can be defined even at the time of alteration of stock items. However, if the
H
stock item is altered after recording the transaction then the changes made in the costing method will not be applicable
ED
for transactions already recorded. Hence, to make the costing method applicable all the entries have to be reaccepted
LE
(i.e., alter the entries and press enter till the vouchers are accepted).
R
U
13. Ignore Difference due to Physical Counting? : In Tally.ERP 9, you can record the
IM
physical stock as counted, using a physical stock voucher. If you wish to ignore the
difference and continue with the stock as per books, set this option to Yes.
FF
14. Ignore Negative Balances?: If you set this option to Yes, Tally.ERP 9 ignores the item
TE
entry is made, Tally.ERP 9 automatically updates the quantity and value in inward by
6
00
purchase entry is made, Tally.ERP 9 automatically updates the quantity and value in
86
17. Treat all Rejections inward as Scrap?: If you set this option to Yes, then, whenever a
11
rejection inward entry has been made [without tracking number], Tally.ERP 9
21
automatically reduces the amount from the closing stock balance. In this case, you need
R
not pass the credit note for reducing the value against rejection inward. This is used for
defective items returned by the customer.
18. Press Enter or Y to accept/save the stock item.
Activity:
1. Create the following stock items
Name of Stock Item Stock Valuation Method
KT - 5 FIFO Perpetual
MK- 4 LIFO Perpetual
451
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.5.2 Different Types of Costing Methods
In this section we will learn about the different types of costing methods available in Tally.ERP
9. Stock valuation methods are displayed under the Costing Methods menu:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.45 List of Costing Methods
H
1. At Zero Cost: Cost of an item is considered as zero. For example, for defective items that
ED
have no commercial value and also when the stock is used for own consumption this
LE
method is selected. For example, any purchases made for own consumption, like purchase
of furniture, plant and machinery etc., this valuation method is selected.
R
U
2. Avg. Cost: This method is used to assign the average cost of production to a product.
IM
Inventory items are piled and combined together in such a way that they cannot
be separated to assign a specific cost to the individual units within it. For example,
-S
chemicals and oils, etc. -- chemicals bought 2 weeks ago cannot be differentiated
6
from those bought yesterday because they all are mixed together.
00
The accounting system of the company is not advanced to track FIFO or LIFO
00
inventory details.
8 86
Periodic System (Yearly bases): This is also known as Weighted Average Cost.
R
The weighted average cost for the whole year is computed as below:
Average cost = Total Inward value for the Year
Total Inward Quantity for the year
452
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. FIFO (First-in, First-Out): This method is used when the first Stock items bought are
the first ones to be sold and the stock items bought later are sold later.
It is commonly used by the business that trades in food stuff or any other goods that have
a limited shelf life.
R
system, it is assumed that items purchased first are sold first across the financial
AI
year (i.e., first lot may be from previous year entry).
N
4. Last Purchase Cost: Last Purchase Cost is the Last Purchase Rate. Cost of Goods Sold
AN
and Cost of Inventory are based on the Last Purchase Rate.
5. LIFO (Last-in, First-Out): This method is used when the Last Stock items bought are
AR
the first ones to be sold and the stock items bought first are sold last.
H
ED
They are two types of LIFO Costing methods:
LIFO Annual: Under the LIFO Annual method, it is assumed that items
LE
purchased last are sold first under the current financial year (i.e., first lot from the
R
LIFO Perpetual: Under the LIFO Perpetual method, it is assumed that items
purchased last are sold first across the financial year (i.e., first lot may be from
FF
6. Standard Cost: Standard Cost is Standard Rates specified in the Inventory Master. Cost
of Goods Sold and Cost of Inventory are based on the Standard Rates.
-S
7. Market Valuation Method: The Market Valuation Method is used to determine the
6
realisable worth of an Item. Unrealised Profit of an Item = Closing Value as per Costing
00
Select the appropriate method applicable for the Item from the Valuation Methods List,
86
453
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11.5.3 Recording of Purchase and Sales Transactions
In this section, we will learn to record the transaction with stock items in which the costing
method is configured
R
KT - 4 100 Nos 2,000/ Nos 2,00,000
AI
KT - 5 100 Nos 3,000/Nos 3,00,000
N
MK - 4 100 Nos 4,000/Nos 4,00,000
Voucher: Purchase
AN
05-12-2017
Purchased the following goods from Karamchand and the cash payment was made
AR
immediately. Select the godown as local warehouse
Name of Stock Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
H
Item
ED
KT - 4 50 Nos 1,500/ Nos 75,000
KT - 5 50 Nos 2,500/Nos 1,25,000
LE
MK - 4 50 Nos 3,5000/Nos 1,75,000
R
Purchased the following goods from Karamchand and the cash payment was made
IM
Item
TE
Item
11
Once after recording the transaction let us c heck how the stock valuation is done in case of
FIFO and LIFO Perpetual methods.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary, in this report the stock value of KT -4 is
displaying as 61,000, to check the calculation details, bring the cursor on KT – 4 stock
item and press Enter
454
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
2. Press Enter on December Month from Stock Item Monthly summary
The Stock Voucher report appears as shown in the figure 11.47:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 11.47 Stock Voucher Report Screen ED
LE
Let us check the calculation based on FIFO Perpetual method:
R
U
First lot purchase details = 100 Qty at 2,000/No, total Value = 200,000
IM
When 120 Nos of goods we sold, the quantity were first taken from first lot of purchase i.e. 100
-S
quantity and the remaining 20 quantity were taken from second slot of purchase
6
00
Third lot purchase details = 10 quantity is remaining, total value = 10*1600 = 16,000
8
11
Therefore the total stock value of KT – 4 is 61,000 as per FIFO Perpetual method
21
R
In Tally.ERP 9, we have a facility to view the stock valuation of all stock items with different
costing methods, to do so follow the steps given below:
455
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.48 Auto Repeat Column Screen
2. Select Stock Valuation Method option from Column Details list
H
3. Press Enter, you will get the following screen with all stock valuation as shown in figure
ED
11.49: LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
456
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.50 Stock Summary Report with all stock valuation (Continued)
H
In the figure 11.49 and 11.50, we can view the stock valuations of different costing methods like
ED
FIFO, LIFO, Average Cost, Standard cost etc.
Conclusion
LE
In this chapter, we have learnt to configure godown, stock category, batch details and also we have
R
specific reports and checked how instantly the inventory reports like batch summary, godown
IM
summary, transfer analysis and stock summary with stock valuation gets updated.
FF
Key Takeaways
TE
Tally.ERP 9 has an option to display only those batches which have not expired and hide
11
The choice of stock valuation methods depends on a number of variables, like the business
situation and financial goals of the business organisation.
R
Shortcut Keys
Shortcut Key Description
Alt+F6 From the Batch Voucher report
457
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To navigate to the Daily Breakup of
batch Items report.
F4 From godown summary report
To select the godown from the list of
godown
Ctrl+S From batch voucher report
To navigate to the stock item alteration
screen.
F6 From batch voucher report
To navigate to the batch summary
report.
R
AI
Practice Exercises
N
1. Manufacturing and expiry dates can also be set for batch-wise details.
AN
a. True
b. False
AR
H
2. With default settings, Tally does not allow selection of batches for which Expiry dates fall
ED
before Voucher date.
a. True
LE
b. False
R
3. Match the following items and select the appropriate answer from the given response
U
sheet.
IM
4. Where can we find the option to ‘Allow use of expired batches for all stock items’ be set
21
to ‘Yes’?
a. F11 > Inventory Features
R
5. Batch wise details come under which section in F2: Inventory Features
a. General
b. Storage & Classification
c. Order Processing
d. Other Features
458
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
6. From the below given Figure 11.39, the voucher class is used for_________
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.51 Stock Journal Voucher
H
a. Transfer of Ledger Closing Balances
b. Inter-Godown Stock Transfers
ED
LE
c. Physical Verification of Stocks
d. None of These
R
U
7. Maintain multiple Godowns come under which section in F2: Inventory Features?
IM
c. Purchase Management
TE
d. Sales Management
-S
a. True
00
b. False
00
9. From the below given Figure 11.32, ______voucher is used for Transfer Analysis
8 86
11
21
R
459
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 11.52 Transfer Analysis
H
a. Journal
ED
LE
b. Physical Stock
c. Stock Journal
R
d. Bicycle
U
IM
10. Payment voucher is recorded to transfer the stock from one godown to another godown
a. True
FF
b. False
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
460
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 12
Management of Purchase and Sales
Cycle
Learning Objectives
R
Handling of complete sales order processing.
AI
Handling of complete purchase order processing.
N
View order details and outstanding reports
AN
Close orders due to cancellation, lack of stocks or return of goods etc.
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
461
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
12.1 Introduction
It is very important for any organization who are dealing in inventory to maintain the track of
order received/placed. Proper tracking of orders (sales/purchase order) leads to on time delivery
of goods to customer place and also it leads to track the details of goods which are yet to be
received from suppliers.
In Tally.ERP 9, management of purchase and sales cycle is very simple and easy to maintain. We
can track the sales order till it reaches to the customers place, similarly we track the purchase order
till we receive the goods from suppliers. This helps in analysing the reason for outstanding order
details like delivered on time or not and the reason for delay.
R
AI
N
12.2 Purchase Order Processing
AN
Purchase order processing is the process of placing the order with suppliers for the supply of
AR
goods. The purchase order contains the following details:
H
Supplier Name
ED
Name of Stock Item
Quantity and Rate Details
LE
Date of Order etc.
R
U
Later, when the ordered goods are received, the Purchase Order is tracked/maintained in the
IM
Step 1: Recording Purchase Order Voucher: It is an order placed by the business entity to a
-S
supplier for the delivery of specified goods at a given price and at a predetermined time.
6
Step 2: Recording of Receipt Note Voucher: Receipt note voucher is used for recording goods
00
Step 3: Recording of Rejection Out Voucher: Rejections Out voucher records the details of
goods that are rejected and sent back the a supplier. (This voucher is recorded only in case of
8
rejection out, if there are no rejections then the following step should be followed)
11
21
Step 4: Recording Purchase Invoice: Purchase invoice is used to record the purchase
transactions of the company (Once after recording this transaction the purchase value will get
R
Step 5: Recording of Debit Note Voucher: Debit Note is a document issued to a party stating
that the company is debiting their account in company’s books of account for the stated reason
or vice-versa. This voucher is recorded only in case of purchase return or when the goods are
rejected after recording purchase invoice.
Step 6: Recording of Payment Voucher: Once the order is completed, then the payment is
made to the supplier.
462
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: To return the damaged goods we have used the vouchers Rejection out and Debit Note, the difference is when
the goods are rejected before recording the purchase invoice, the details should be accounted in rejection out voucher
(Because it will affect only the inventory reports).
When the goods are rejected after recording the purchase invoice, then the rejection details should be accounted in
Debit Note voucher (Because it will impact both accounting and inventory reports).
Business Scenario
Pearlshine Traders are into wholesale trading of Furniture’s, and they deal in Chairs, Tables and
Cabinets, they receive order from customers and place orders to suppliers. Pearlshine Traders want
to track order processing details for smooth functioning of business.
R
AI
To understand Order Processing in Tally.ERP 9, let us consider that Pearlshine Traders placed an
N
order for Chairs from Realto Furniture’s and then sold it to SeaSagar Distributors after they
AN
received the order.
AR
To maintain the books of accounts in Tally.ERP 9, the user must create the company to record
H
the transactions.
Activity: Create a company in Tally.ERP 9 with the following details:
ED
LE
Company Name: Pearlshine Traders.
R
U
Address: Block No: 111, Near High Court Road, Sampangi Rama Nagar, Bengaluru,
IM
Country: India
FF
TE
State: Karnataka
-S
Pin: 560001
6
00
9
21
In Tally.ERP 9, we need to activate the Order Processing feature, in order to manage the complete
R
463
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Set the option – Use rejection inward and outward notes to Yes
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 12.1 Inventory Features Screen
R
Once after activating the order details, let us learn to record the transactions involved in complete
order processing using Tally.ERP 9.
FF
Date Particulars
-S
additional Packaging & Handling Charges of 1%. The Chairs are due on 06-07-
00
Table No 12.1
R
To record the above transactions in the books of accounts, first ensure that the required masters
are created in Tally.ERP 9
Step 1: Creation of Accounting Masters
Party Ledger
Realto Furniture’s
464
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
Table No 12.2
AI
N
Purchase Ledger
AN
Purchase A/c
AR
Against the Field Name Actions to be performed
H
ED
Name Enter as Purchase A/c
Under Select Purchase Accounts
LE
Inventory values are affected Set to Yes
R
U
Table No 12.3
IM
Expense Ledger
FF
TE
Table No 12.4
21
R
Stock Group
Wooden Furniture’s
465
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Unit of Measure
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Unit of Measure > Create
R
Pcs
AI
N
Against the Field Action to be Performed
AN
Type Let it be Simple
AR
Symbol Enter as Pcs
H
Formal Name Select as Pieces
Number of decimal places Set as 0
ED
LE
Table No 12.6
R
U
Stock Item
IM
Table No 12.7
8 86
11
Activity: Go to Gateway of Tally > Press F11: Company Features >F2: Inventory features
21
Godown
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Godowns > Create
Warehouse
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Warehouse
Under Select as Primary
466
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table No 12.8
Step 3: Recording Purchase Order
To record the purchase order, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Order Vouchers > Alt+F4: Purchase Order
2. Click F12: Configure:
Set the option Use common ledger account for item allocation to Yes
Set the option – Provide complete accounting allocations in order/ delivery note
to Yes. (Enabling this option will allow you to select accounting masters (Purchase
ledgers) in the order voucher)
R
AI
3. Press F2:Date and change the date to 01-07-2017
N
4. Select Realto furniture’s in the Party A/c name field
AN
5. Once after selecting the party ledger, you will get the supplementary details screen, in
which you can define the supplier’s details, order details and receipt details.
AR
6. The voucher number will be displayed in the Order no.: field by default, change it to
PO_001
H
ED
7. In Purchase ledger field select Purchase A/c
8. Under Name of Item, select Chairs and press Enter, the Stock Item Allocations screen
LE
appears
R
(This is the due date for the delivery of the item. This will enable the monitoring of
IM
outstanding deliveries. The order can be split for delivery on different dates)
FF
11. Enter 200 in the Quantity field and ₹ 510 in the Rate field, the amount field will be
-S
calculated automatically.
6
00
The Completed Stock Item Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 12.2
00
8 86
11
21
R
467
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 12.2 Item Allocation for Chairs
AR
12. Accept the Stock Item Allocations screen to return to the Purchase Order screen
H
13. Press enter and take the selection to List of Ledger Accounts field
ED
14. From List of Ledger Accounts, select Packaging & Handling Charges at 1% on the
item value
LE
15. Enter the Narration
R
The Purchase Order Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 12.3
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note: Altering a Purchase Order, once after recording the purchase order one can alter the voucher. To alter a
Purchase Order, go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Day Book > F4: Chg Vch and select Purchase
Orders or Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Purchase Orders Book and
select the required Purchase Order to open the Order Voucher Alteration screen.
468
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Receipt Note.
Receipt Note is recorded against respective purchase orders i.e., when goods are received from
supplier against the placed order, receipt note is recorded. The entry will reflect in the stock
summary report.
Illustration 2: Recording receipt note for received goods
Date Particulars
06-07-2017 Voucher: Receipt Note
Record a receipt note on Realto furniture’s, the received goods are stored in
Warehouse (Godown). This receipt note will be linked to the purchase order -
R
AI
PO_001 that was recorded on 01-07-2017
Name of Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
N
AN
Chairs 200 Pcs ₹ 510/Pcs 1,02,000
AR
Table No 12.9
H
Step 1: Record Receipt Note Voucher
To record the receipt note voucher, follow the steps given below: ED
LE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Alt+F9: Receipt Note.
R
2. Click F12: Configure button and set the following option to Yes
U
(Enabling this option will allow you to select the order number against which the
FF
6. Select PO_001 in the Order No(s) field from the Party Details screen:
8
11
469
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 12.4 Party Details Screen
AR
H
7. Accept the screen to return to the voucher creation screen
ED
8. The stock item will appear automatically, press enter and the Stock Item Allocations
screen will appear with the quantity details
LE
9. By default, Tracking No will capture the Reference no.: RN-01
R
10. From List of Orders select PO_001 in the Order No.: and accept the Stock Item
U
Allocations screen
IM
11. Godown, Quantity, Rate and Amount will get captured as per the purchase order, if
FF
The Receipt Note Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 12.5:
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
470
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary > Select Wooden furniture’s > you will get the
stock item Chairs >Press Alt+F1, to view in detailed mode > Press enter on stock item, to get the stock
item monthly summary> Select the required month> you will get the message as Purchase bill
pending. By this we will come to know that the goods are received against the order but bill is not raised
on the same.
2. Check the balance sheet you will get the value in current asset and current liabilities. This shows that the
inventory details are integrated with accounts. If you don’t want to integrate, then the same can be achieved
by following the below given procedure.
R
Go to Gateway of Tally > F11: Features >F1: Accounting Features /F2: Inventory
AI
features > Disable the option “Integrate accounts and inventory”. Now check the balance
N
sheet report you will observe that the report is blank. In Tally.ERP 9, we have the option to integrate
AN
accounts with inventory.
AR
3. Check the Profit and Loss account report and then enable the option “Integrate accounts
with inventory” and check the same report once again. The Purchase and closing stock value will
H
appear in profit and loss account report
ED
LE
Rejection Out voucher
R
The Rejections Out voucher is used to record the details of goods that are rejected and sent back
U
to the supplier.
IM
FF
Date Particulars
-S
Table No 12.10
11
Now to record the rejection out voucher in the books of Pearlshine Traders, follow the steps given
below:
21
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Press Alt+F6: Rejections Out
2. Press F2:Date, and change the date to 07-07-2017
3. Under Ledger account field, select the party Realto furniture’s and the same ledger
name will be captured in Supplier’s Name and Address field.
4. Select the stock item Chairs that is returned/ rejected, you will get the following Stock
item allocation screen.
471
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Item Allocations screen appears as shown in the figure 12.6:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.6 Item Allocation Screen
H
ED
5. Select the Tracking No.: RN01.
6. Enter the returned Quantity as 5, Rate and the amount will get captured automatically.
LE
R
The Rejection Out Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 12.7
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Activity: Check the stock summary report and observe the available stock quantity details, it will display as 195
instead of 200.
472
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
recorded on 06-07-2017.
AI
Name of Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
N
Chairs 195 Pcs ₹ 510/Pcs 99,450
AN
Table No 12.11
AR
Step 1: Recording Purchase Transaction.
H
ED
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > Press F9: Purchase
2. Press F2: Date and change the date to 10-07-2017
LE
3. Enter the Supplier invoice no.: PUR01
R
4. Select the Party A/c name: Realto furniture’s, you will get the Party Details screen.
U
473
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
Debit Note
TE
Table No 12.12
474
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity:
Note: In case the goods are returned after recording the purchase invoice then the details have to be recorded in the
debit note voucher as the rejected goods value should reflect in inventory reports as well as in accounting reports.
If goods are rejected before recording purchase invoice then the rejected details should be recorded in the Rejection out
voucher, because the value should reflect only in the inventory books.
R
AI
N
Now to record the debit note in the books of Pearlshine Traders, follow the steps given below:
AN
1. Go to Gateway of Tally> Accounting Vouchers > Press Ctrl+F9
2. Press F2: Date and change the date to 15-07-2017
AR
3. Enter the Original invoice no.: PUR01, this is the supplier invoice number of purchase
against which is goods are returned
H
ED
4. Enter the Original Invoice Dt.: 10-07-2017, this is the Supplier invoice date of the
purchase which is returned
LE
5. In the Party A/c name field select the party ledger Realto furniture’s, you will get the
R
475
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
11. In the Bill-wise Details for screen follow the below given details.
In Type of Ref field select Against Ref
In the Name field select PUR01 from Pending Bills
In the Due Date, or Credit Days field, it will capture as 15-07-2017(5 Days).
Amount will get captured automatically.
The Debit Note appears as shown in the figure 12.11
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
Note: Make sure in the above entry the packing and handling charges are not selected, if gets selected remove the
TE
same.
-S
Activity: Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Account > Outstandings > Select
Ledger > Select Realto furniture’s Check the Bills outstanding report payable to Realto furniture’s and
6
00
When the order is received from a customer for supply of goods,, then in the sales order voucher,
11
items, quantities, date of delivery, etc., details are given with sales order number. Later when these
21
goods are delivered, the sales order is tracked for the order details either in the delivery note or in
R
476
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 3: Recording of Rejection In Voucher: Rejection In voucher is used to record goods that
are rejected and sent back by the customer. (This voucher is recorded only in case of rejections, if
there are no rejections then next step should be followed)
Step 4: Recording Sales Invoice: Sales invoice is used to record the sales transactions of the
company (Once after recording this transaction the sales value will get reflected in accounting
reports like balance sheet and profit and loss account)
Step 5: Recording of Credit Note Voucher: Credit Note is a document issued to a party stating
that you are crediting their account in company’s books of account for the stated reason or vice-
versa. This voucher is recorded only in case of sales return and when the goods are returned after
R
recording sales invoice.
AI
Step 6: Recording of Receipt Voucher: Once the order is completed then the payment is
N
received from the Customer.
AN
Note:
AR
For returning the damaged goods, we have used the vouchers Rejection In and Credit Note, the difference
H
is, when the goods are rejected before recording the sales invoice, the details should be accounted in Rejection
In voucher (Because it will effect only the inventory reports).
ED
LE
When the goods are rejected by the customer after recording the sales invoice, then the rejection details should
R
be accounted/ recorded in Credit Note voucher (Because it will affect both accounting and inventory reports).
U
IM
Date Particulars
TE
SSD_001). The due date for delivering the goods is 04-08-2017 and select
6
Table No 12.13
11
To record the above transactions in the books of accounts, first ensure that the required masters
21
Party Ledger
477
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
Sales A/c
N
Against the Field Actions to be Performed
AN
Name Enter as Sales A/c
AR
Under Select Sales Accounts
H
Maintain balances bill-by-bill Set to No
Inventory values are affected
ED
Set to Yes
LE
Table No 12.15
R
Delivery Charges
U
IM
Table No 12.16
00
00
SSD_001.
5. In the Sales ledger select Sales A/c
6. Under Name of the Item, select Chairs and press enter, the Stock Item Allocations
screen will appear
7. Enter 04-08-2017 in the Due on field, this is the due date for the delivering the item to
the customer
8. Select Warehouse in the Godown field. (Only when the Multiple Godown feature is
enabled, this field will be displayed)
478
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
9. Enter 150 in the Quantity field, and ₹ 690/Pcs in the Rate field, the amount will be
calculated automatically
10. Press enter and take the selection to List of Ledger Accounts field
11. From List of Ledger Accounts, select Delivery Charges at 1% on the item value
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
To alter any details like party name, order no, voucher date etc., you can follow the below given path.
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Day Book > F4: Chg Vch and select Sales Orders
6
or
00
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Sales Order Book select the required
00
Delivery Note
11
The Delivery Note is used for recording goods delivered to a customer, it can be raised against
21
Table No 12.17
479
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
8. Select the Tracking No. DN01 and the Order No. SSD_001 and rest details will get
captured automatically
480
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 12.15 Delivery Note Voucher Screen
10. Press Ctrl+A to accept the screen
ED
LE
Rejections In voucher
R
U
A Rejections In voucher is used to record goods that are rejected and returned by the customer.
IM
Illustration 8: Recording rejection note for accounting the details of goods rejected
FF
by the customer
TE
Date Particulars
-S
Table No 12.18
Step 1: Recording Rejection In voucher
8
11
3. Select the party under Ledger Account field and the same will be captured in
Customer’s Name and Address field
4. Select Chairs under Name of Item, which is returned by the customer, you will get the
Stock Item Allocations screen
481
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.16 Item Allocation Screen
5. Select the Tracking No.: DN01.
H
ED
6. Enter the returned Quantity as 2, rate and amount will get captured automatically.
The Rejection In appears as shown in the figure 12.17
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
Activity: Check the stock summary report and observe the available stock quantity details.
Sales Invoice
Sales Invoice can be recorded against the Delivery Note Voucher.
Illustration 9: Recording sales and raised invoice to customer
Date Particulars
482
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table No 12.19
Step 1: Recording Sales invoice.
R
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 20-08-2017
AI
3. Enter the Reference no.: SAL01
N
4. Select SeaSagar Distributors in the Party A/c name field, you will get the Party Details
AN
screen
The Party Details appears as shown in the figure 12.18:
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
5. Select the Delivery Note No(s): DN 01, the Order No(s) will get captured automatically.
11
6. Accept the Party Details screen to return to the Accounting Voucher Creation screen
21
7. The stock item Chairs will captured automatically, press enter on the stock item and the
R
Stock Item Allocations screen will appear, accept the screen as it is.
8. In the Bill-wise Details for screen select the following details:
Type of Ref as New Ref.
In the Name field enter invoice number SAL01
Due Date, or Credit Days field enter as 27-08-2017(7 Days).
Amount will get captured automatically.
The Sales Voucher Screen appears as shown in the figure 12.19
483
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 12.19 Sales Invoice Screen
AR
9. Press Ctrl+A to accept the screen.
H
Credit Note voucher ED
LE
R
Credit Note is a document issued to a party stating that you are crediting their account in your
U
books of accounts for the stated reason or vice versa. It is commonly used in case of sales returns,
IM
Illustration 10: Recording sales voucher and raised invoice to the customer
TE
Date Particulars
-S
Table No 12.20
8
Activity:
R
Note:
If the goods are rejected after recording sales invoice then the details have to be recorded in the Credit note
voucher as the value should reflect in inventory reports as well as in accounting reports.
484
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
If goods are rejected before recording sales invoice then the rejected details should be recorded in the Rejection
In voucher, because the value should reflect only in the inventory books.
Now to record the credit note in the books of Pearlshine Traders, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally> Accounting Vouchers > Press Ctrl+F8 Credit Note
2. Press F2: Date and change the date to 22-08-2017
3. Enter the Original invoice no.: SAL01, this is the sales invoice number against which the
goods are returned
4. Enter the Original Invoice Dt.: 20-08-2017, this is date of sales invoice
R
5. In the Party A/c name field select SeaSagar Distributors, you will get the Party Details
AI
screen
N
The Party Details appears as shown in the figure 12.20:
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
9. Press enter on the stock item to get Stock Item Allocations, enter the returned Quantity,
11
11. In the Bill-wise Details for screen follow the below given details.
In Type of Ref field select Agst Ref
In the Name field select SAL01 from Pending Bills
In the Due Date, or Credit Days field, it will capture as 27-08-2017 (7 Days).
Amount will get captured automatically.
485
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 12.21 Credit Note Voucher Screen
AR
12. Press Ctrl+A to accept the screen
H
Note: Do not select the Delivery Charge ledger while recording the credit note entry
ED
LE
Activity: Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Account > Outstandings > Select
R
Ledger > Select SeaSagar Distributors, Check the Bills outstanding report receivable from SeaSagar
U
Distributors.
IM
After recording purchase and sales orders, you can view the details of the orders to know the
6
amount of stock that needs to be processed for the order, (before recording invoices for the order)
00
3. Select Sales Orders Outstanding, and set use due orders only to No
4. Select Wooden Furniture’s and drill down to the Order Details screen
R
5. In the Order Details screen, press Alt+F1 to view the report in detailed format
486
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.22 Order Details screen
H
The Order Details report is generated as on 22nd August, 2017. Based on the period of the report
ED
and the due date of the order, the report will display the outstanding status of the order.
LE
Click F12: Configure button and set the following to yes:
R
487
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
Sales Order Summary statement gives detailed information on outstanding sales orders. The
00
outstanding orders can be viewed Stock Group wise, Stock Category wise, Stock Item wise,
86
1. Go to Gateway of Tally> Display > Statements of Inventory > Select Sales Order
Outstandings> Select All orders > Press Alt+F1: Detailed
R
488
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.25 Sales Order Outstanding Report
H
ED
The report of figure 12.25, displays the details of ordered quantity and the balance quantity details.
LE
Activity: Similarly check the purchase order outstanding report.
R
U
Pre-closing of order is required when there are order cancellations, lack of stocks, goods returned
due to defects, etc. For this, Pre-closure of Orders option is given in Tally.ERP 9 and pre-closing
TE
Date Particulars
00
31-08-2017 Pearlshine Traders decided to close the complete pending sales order raised in
86
Table No 12.21
R
Pre-close Order
To pre-close the Sales Order, follow the steps given below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Inventory > Sales
Order Outstandings
2. Select All Orders
The Order Details screen appears as shown in the figure 12.26:
489
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.26 Order Pre-Closure Details
3. Press Ctrl+C Pre-Close
H
ED
4. Enter the Pre-Close Quantity as 10 Pcs, enter the reason for pre-close, and enter
Closed on Date
LE
Note: In case of partial closure of order, enter the quantity details in Pre-close quantity column, for example: in
R
the figure 12.27 , the balance quantity is displaying as 10 now if you want to close order only for 5 quantities,
U
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
Note: Lead Time is the time taken by the supplier to supply the goods once the order is placed
N
AN
Illustration 1: Defining reorder level for stock items
AR
Date Particulars
H
01-07-2017 Pearlshine Traders setup the reorder level for the following stock items
Name of
Reorder Usage Criteria Minimum Usage Criteria ED
LE
Item
Quantity Pattern Order Pattern
R
Quantity
U
Table No 12.22
TE
To do the above illustration in the books of accounts, first ensure that necessary masters and
required setup are made in Tally.ERP 9:
6 -S
Note: Before setting Re-order level, we need to enable the option Enable purchase order processing in
00
F11 > F2: Inventory Features screen. If this option is set to No, then we will not be able to set re-order level
00
in Tally.ERP 9.
86
Stock items
21
Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Items > Create
R
Tables
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Tables
Under Select as Wooden Furniture’s
Units Select as Pcs
Opening Balance 15 Pcs,
(Do not enter rate)
Godown Warehouse
491
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table No 12.23
Activity: Similarly, create one more stock items by name Cabinets and enter opening quantities as 20 Pcs Store
in warehouse
The Reorder Levels Menu screen appears as shown in the figure 12.28:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
From the figure 12.28, we can define the reorder level from Stock Groups option or the same
can be defined at the Stock Item option. If you select Stock Group, then at one go you can
TE
define the Reorder Levels for all the stock items, if you select Stock Item, then the Reorder
Levels need to be define one by one to all the available stock items.
6 -S
Note: The Specify Reorder Levels screen appears, where all the Stock Items (Chairs, Tables, Cabinets
and Tile) under the Stock Group - Wooden Furniture’s are displayed
86
The Simple Reorder Level screen appears as shown in the figure 12.29:
21
R
492
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 12.29 Simple Reorder Level Screen
AR
Note: The Reorder Level screen appears based on the books beginning from to the date of last entry.
H
3. Click Alt+R: Adv Reorder button to record the reorder level in advanced mode
ED
4. Click Alt+M: Adv. Min Qty button to record the minimum quantity in advanced mode
LE
TIP:
R
U
The buttons, R: Adv Reorder and M: Adv Min Qty, can be used to toggle between advanced mode and simple
IM
The Specify Reorder Level screen in advanced mode appears as shown in the figure 12.30
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
Note: The reorder and minimum order quantity is defined based on consumption patterns. The consumption
patterns are decided based on a stipulated time period. Tally.ERP 9 allows you to choose from the time parameters
of Days, Weeks, Months and even Years.
493
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Set the Reorder Level and Minimum Order Quantity for the particular stock items
using advanced parameters as shown in figure 12.31:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
Figure 12.31 Completed Specify Reorder Level Screen in Advanced Mode
ED
6. Set the Reorder level to given units (user-defined) or you may also consider the
LE
consumption pattern for the period and accept the value computed as the Reorder Level
R
7. Set the Minimum Order Quantity to given units or you may also consider the
U
consumption pattern for the period and accept the value computed as the Reorder Level
IM
Note: Consumption patterns can be given only if you specify a user-defined quantity to the Reorder level and
Minimum Order quantity. Tally.ERP 9 then compares the two values and considers the lower or higher of the two
TE
Date Particulars
22-08-2017 Voucher: Purchase Order
00
Placed an order for the following products to Realto Furniture’s with the order
86
Purchase Order
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Order Vouchers > Press Alt+F4
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 22-08-2017
494
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
86
495
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table No 12.25
To record the illustration of figure 12.25, in the books of accounts, first ensure that necessary
masters and required setup are made in Tally.ERP 9
Ledgers
Go to > Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info > Ledgers > Create
Ashwin Interior Designers & Renovators
Against the Field Action to be Performed
R
AI
Name Enter as Ashwin Interior Designers &
Renovators
N
Under Select as Sundry Debtors
AN
Maintain balances bill-by-bill Set to Yes
AR
Default credit period Leave it Blank
H
Check for credit days during voucher entry? Set to No
Inventory values are affected
ED
Set to No
LE
Table No 12.26
R
Sales Order
FF
3. Select Ashwin Interior Designers & Renovators in the Party A/c name field
-S
(Once after selecting the party ledger, you will get the supplementary details screen, in
6
which you can define the Suppliers details, Order Details and Receipt Details.)
00
a. The voucher number will be displayed in the Order no.: field by default, change
00
it to SAL/002
4. In Sales ledger field select Sales A/c
86
496
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.33 Sales Order Voucher Screen with filled details
H
12.9 Display Reorder Status ED
LE
After specifying the reorder levels, we can use the Reorder Status report to do an analysis of the
R
inventory.
U
To view the Reorder Status report, follow the steps given below:
IM
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Inventory > Reorder Status
1. Select Wooden Furniture’s
FF
The Inventory Reorder Status screen appears as shown in the figure 12.34:
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The explanation of each column and what happens when you drill down is as given below:
Name of Item: The list of stock items that belong to the Stock Group selected are
displayed. Highlight the required item and press Enter to arrive at the Movement Inward
details. This gives you Party-wise/Transfer-wise details of movements for the Stock item.
The Inward details display the Basic Invoice Rate and Effective Rate. You can drill
down to the last level of voucher details.
Closing Stock: This column displays the Closing quantity of the item as per the date
specified in the report.
Purchase Orders Pending: This column displays the total quantity of stock item pending
from purchase orders.
Sales Orders Due: This column displays the total quantity of stock items due for sales
R
based on the sales orders raised.
AI
When you drill down from this column, the Sales Orders Outstanding report will appear.
N
Nett Available: The quantity given here is arrived at, based on the formula: Nett
AN
Available = Closing Stock + Purchase Orders Pending - Sales Orders Due.
Reorder Level: The Reorder Level defined for the stock item will be displayed here. When
AR
you drill down from this column, the Specify Reorder Level screen will appear.
Shortfall: Shortfall is displayed as on 31-08-2017 with the specifications:
H
Reorder level quantity or consumption of the last 5 days whichever is higher
Minimum order quantity or consumption of last 5 days whichever is higher
ED
LE
Minimum Order Quantity: This indicates the minimum quantity that has to be ordered
R
in each order raised for that stock item, even though the required quantity is less than the
U
Order to be placed: The numbers falling under this option indicated the order to be
placed.
TE
Note: While defining the Minimum order quantity, we have defined the criteria as Higher, hence the order to be
-S
Conclusion
86
In this chapter, we have learnt about the management of sales and purchase cycle in Tally.ERP 9, we
8
have raised the order, handled rejections, raised an invoice against the order and completed it with
11
receipts and payments. We have also seen how easy it is to maintain reorder level for any given stock
21
item in Tally.ERP 9. This chapter handled
R
Key Takeaways
Order processing includes purchase and sales order processing. Here the details of
purchase orders placed and sales orders received can be obtained.
Pre-closure of order is done when orders need to be closed due to cancellation of order,
lack of stocks, and delay in acceptance etc.
When goods are rejected before raising a purchase or sale invoice then the details are
recorded in rejection in or rejection out vouchers.
498
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
When goods are rejected after raising a purchase or sale invoice then the details are
recorded in debit note or credit note vouchers.
Reorder Level is the inventory level at which the company has to place an order for the
stock item.
Shortcut Keys
Shortcut Key Description
Alt+F4 From Order Vouchers menu
R
To record Purchase Order
AI
Alt+F5 From Order Vouchers menu
N
To record Sales Order
AN
Alt+F6 From Inventory Vouchers menu
To record Rejections Out
AR
Ctrl+F6 From Inventory Vouchers menu
H
To record Rejections In
ED
Alt+F8 From Inventory Vouchers menu
To record Delivery Note
LE
Alt+F9 From Inventory Vouchers menu
R
Practise Exercises
FF
TE
1. What is the shortcut key for Purchase Order? Identify from the following.
-S
a. Alt+F5
6
b. Alt+F4
00
c. Ctrl+F5
00
d. Ctrl+F4
86
a. True
11
b. False
21
3. From the below Figure 12.35, the Rejection Out voucher is recorded to account the
details of _________.
R
499
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
Figure 12.35 Inventory Voucher Creation Screen
AN
a. Sales Order Details
b. Purchase Order Details
AR
c. Rejection Details
d. Payment Details
H
ED
4. From where can we activate Order Processing Feature? Identify from the following.
a. Gateway of Tally> F12> Inventory Configuration
LE
b. F11 > F2
R
d. F11 > F1
IM
FF
a. Order Entry
b. Sales Entry
-S
c. Rejection Entry
6
d. Challan Entry
00
6. From the below given Figure 12.36 Rejection In voucher is used to record ___________
00
8 86
11
21
R
500
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 12.36 Rejection In Voucher Screen
H
a. Defective goods rejected by the customer
b.
c.
Damaged goods rejected by the customer
Inferior goods rejected by the customer ED
LE
d. All of the above
R
U
7. From where can we see the outstanding orders details? Identify from the following
IM
c. Display> Inventory Books> Outstanding Orders
TE
8. From the below given figure 12.37 Purchase Order voucher is issued to _______
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
501
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
a. Customer
b. Bank
c. Supplier
d. None of these
9. The delivery of goods can be less than the required order, it is subjected to availability of
goods with the supplier
a. True
b. False
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
502
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
503
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
504
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 13
Price Levels and Price Lists
Learning Objectives
Create and maintain price levels and price lists
Use price lists while passing invoice
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
505
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
13.1 Introduction
A Price List refers to a list of items maintained by an organisation along with their price
details. It is generally used by organisations which deal in multiple products.
Price Lists are maintained in various structures for different types of buyers (customers),
viz., Wholesalers, Dealers, Retailers, etc. It is structured based on the classification of
buyers and is referred at the time of making sales. Whenever the sale prices change (on the
basis of time), the changes are reflected in the Price List also. In case of bulk sales, discounts
can also be given to the buyers.
Tally.ERP 9 permits you to create any number of price lists & Price levels, based on the
R
Stock Group and Stock Category to match the required structure.
AI
N
Business Scenario:
AN
AR
Emerald-Shine Makers are into manufacturing of mobile phones and they sell the goods
to wholesalers and retailers at different prices to each level of customers, the com pany have
H
decided to fix the price of the products for different kinds of buyers based on time periods
and size of order and also the discount rate varies based on the size of the order. The
ED
LE
company wants to predefine the price list for each and every stock items.
R
Let us now see how Tally.ERP 9 handles such a situation through the Price List
U
IM
feature.
FF
Country:India
6
Pin: 600001
Financial year: 01-04-2017 to 31-03-
00
2018
8 86
Levels
R
We can define the classification of buyers like wholesalers, retailers etc. in the Price Level and
stock items prices can be defined in the Price List.
.
Illustration 1: Defining price levels for different buyers
Pass the following transaction in the book of Emerald-Shine Makers
01-07-2017 Price List
The Emerald-Shine Company, wants to define price levels for its buyer
Classification like:
Wholesale PL
Retail PL
Table 13.1
506
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
To maintain the price levels in the books of accounts, first ensure that the required
configurations are made in Tally.ERP 9.
Follow the below given steps to create the Price Levels (Classification of Buyers) in Tally.ERP
9.
R
3. Press enter and the Company Price Levels screen will appear.
AI
4. Define the price levels for Emerald-Shine Makers as:
N
Retail PL-1
AN
Wholesale PL-1
AR
The Price Levels Screen appears as shown in the figure 13.1:
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
Illustration 2: Defining price list for different stock items of the company in Tally.ERP 9
R
Table 13.2 Wholesale PL-1 Price List
AI
N
Retail PL-1
Stock Group Name of the Stock Quantities Rate Discount
AN
Item Rate
AR
From: Less
than
H
Mobile Phones OMED - GEN_1 50 6,000 --
ED
Basic Phone
50 100 6,000 5%
LE
100 150 5,500 1%
R
50 100 12,000 5%
100 150 11,500 --
TE
Smart Phone
50 100 16,000 5%
00
Note: Emerald-Shine Makers doesn’t sell, mid-range mobile phones GEN_2 and GEN_3.
21
R
To maintain the price levels in the books of accounts, first ensure that the required masters are
created in Tally.ERP 9.
Units of Measure
508
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 13.4
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Units of Measure > Create
Nos.
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Type Let it be as Simple
Symbol Enter as Nos
Formal Name Enter as Numbers
Number of decimal places Enter as 0
Table 13.5
Stock items
Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Items > Create
R
AI
OMED - GEN_1 Basic Phone
N
Against the Field Action to be Performed
AN
Name Enter as OMED - GEN_1 Basic Phone
Under Select Mobile Phones
AR
Units Select Nos
H
Note: Minimum one stock item must be created in Tally to enable the Price List option.
ED
Table 13.6
Activity: Similarly, create two items by name:
LE
OMED - GEN_4 Smart Phone
R
Price List
To create price list follow the steps given below:
TE
2. In Stock Group Name, select All Items from List of Stock Groups
3. Select Wholesale PL-1 in Price Level and specify Applicable From date 01-07-2017
6
00
4. Under Particulars, select the applicable stock items, refer the Table 13.2 Wholesale
PL-1 Price List and fill the details
00
8 86
11
21
R
509
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Price List appears as shown in the figure 13.2
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 13.2 Defining Wholesale PL-1 Price List details
H
5. Accept the screen
Activity: ED
LE
R
Similarly, create the price list for Retail PL-1 as on 01-07-2017, refer Table 13.3 Retail PL-1.
U
Additionally enable the feature Use separate discount column in invoices from Gateway of Tally >
IM
F11: Company Features> F2: Inventory Features (This is enabled to record the transaction
with discount details)
FF
TE
Note:
From the figure 13.2 screen, we can revise the price list i.e. if there is any change or variation in the price or
-S
discount then the same can be revised using Alt+R: Revise Price option.
6
In Under group field, you can even select the particular group, in this case you can select Mobile Phones as stock group.
00
00
The explanation of the fields appearing in the Price List is given below:
86
Price Level – The Price Levels selected will be displayed here (the priced levels defined
11
in the F11: Features (Inventory Features) of Tally.ERP 9 will be available for selection)
21
Applicable from – The date from which the Price List will be applicable is displayed here.
R
Quantities – There are two columns: From and Less than. Here, the user can define the
quantity range of the items as per requirement.
Rate – This is the rate for the item based on the quantity range given.
Disc% (if any) – You can define a discount percentage in the Price List which will be
taken automatically in the sales invoice.
Historical Details – There are two columns: Rate and Disc%. Tally.ERP 9 provides
the historical details of the sale rate and discount percentage of any previously created
Price Lists. Therefore, you can define the current price details based on the information
given in the historical details.
Cost price – In this column, Tally.ERP 9 displays the cost price (Purchase) of the item
calculated based on the stock valuation method given in the item master. This has been
provided to assist the user in giving the appropriate sale price. By viewing the historical
price details and the cost price of an item, the sale price for the new Price List can be
defined accordingly.
510
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Manually it is very difficult to remember the price list of multiple stock items based on different
classification of buyers. We have used only two classification of buyers for illustration purpose
only, but in real business scenarios the classification of buyers varies in size and it becomes very
difficult to maintain the inventory data with its price list for any organisation.
In Tally.ERP 9, once the price levels and price list are defined, then while recording the
transactions the price, discount details will get captured automatically and the information will be
accurate.
R
The following illustrations will demonstrate how price lists can be used in a sales invoice.
AI
N
Illustration 3: Recording Purchase Voucher
AN
Date Particulars
AR
31-07-2017 Voucher: Purchase
H
Emerald-Shine Makers purchased the following mobile phones from
ED
Daffodil Gadgets
Name of Stock Item Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
LE
OMED - GEN_1 Basic 900 Nos 4,500/Nos 40,50,000
R
Phone
U
Phone
OMED - GEN_5 Smart 900 Nos 13,000/Nos 1,17,00,000
FF
Phone
05-08-2017 Voucher: Sales
TE
-S
Basic Phone
8
Table 13.7
11
21
To record the transactions of table 13.7, in the books of accounts, first ensure that the required
masters are created in Tally.ERP 9
R
511
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Party Ledgers
Daffodil Gadgets
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Daffodil Gadgets
Under Select Sundry Creditors
Price level applicable Select Not Applicable
Maintain balances bill-by-bill Set to Yes
Inventory values are affected Set to No
Table 13.8
R
Magnum Stores
AI
Against the Field Action to be Performed
N
Name Enter as Magnum Stores
AN
Under Select as Sundry Debtors
Price level applicable Select Wholesale PL-1
AR
Maintain balances bill-by-bill Set to Yes
H
Inventory values are affected Set to No
ED
Price Level Applicable: If we select any specific price level, then while recording the entry it will
capture the prices of stock item based on specific price level selected here.
LE
Table 13.9
R
Purchase Ledger
U
Purchase A/c
IM
Table 13.10
6
00
Sales A/c
00
Table 13.11
21
512
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Purchase Voucher appears as shown in the figure 13.3
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 13.3 Purchase Invoice Screen
H
7. Accept the screen
ED
Note: In case of Purchases, Price List will not be applicable since prices are declared/fixed by the
LE
Supplier.
R
U
IM
6. Select the stock item OMED - GEN_1 Basic Phone and enter quantity as 150 Nos.
6
(Hence the required price level is selected in the ledger master of Magnum Stores)
00
513
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Sales Voucher appears as shown in the figure 13.4
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 13.4 Sales Invoice Screen
H
ED
9. Accept the screen LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
514
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Observation:
In the sales invoice as shown in figure 13.4, we can observe how the rate and
discount appeared automatically, this is because we have defined the price list
details for all the stock items.
Tally.ERP 9 provides you the flexibility to select items with and without the Price
List in the same invoice.
Date Particulars
06-08-2016 Sold the following stock item to Variety Infocom at Retail Price.
R
AI
Name of Stock Quantity Rate per (₹) Discount Amount (₹)
N
Item
OMED - GEN_1 100 Nos ₹ 5,500/Nos 1% 5,44,500
AN
Basic Phone
AR
H
ED
Table 13.12 LE
The price of stock items vary from time to time, the price may increase or decrease based on the
IM
market condition, then as per the latest prices of stock items.. The price list defined in Tally.ERP
FF
9 can be revised.
TE
Emerald-Shine Makers wants to revise the Wholesale PL-1 price list as the
00
rate of stock items are increased by ₹ 100 and the discount rate is fixed.
00
Table 13.13
8 86
515
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
Figure 13.5 Revision of Price List Screen
AR
1. In the Revise Price field select Increase by amount (Because the price is increased by
100 ₹)
H
2. Enter the Amount as ₹ 100
ED
Note: If the price are decreased, select decrease by amount or percentage, if the prices are increased, then select
LE
Increase by amount , if no variation in the price ,select as Not applicable (Not applicable can be selected when
R
The Price List with revise price updated message appears as shown in the figure 13.6
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
516
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Press Enter from the Price List screen, you will get the Price List with revised rates.
The Price List with Revised Price screen appears as shown in the figure 13.7
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 13.7 Price List with Revised Price Screen
R
Observation: On the left hand side in the under rate column, you are getting the revise price of
U
6. Press Enter from the figure 13.7 screen and save the Price List screen.
FF
TE
Once after revising the price for stock items let us record the sales transaction with revised price
list in Tally.ERP 9.
6 -S
Date Particulars
15-08-2017 Voucher: Sales
8 86
Table 13.14
Step 1: Recording Sales Invoice
517
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounting Vouchers > F8: Sales
2. Press F2: Date and change the date to 15-08-2017
3. Enter the Reference no.: SAL03
4. In Party A/c name select Magnum Stores
5. Select Sales A/c in Sales ledger field
6. Select the stock item OMED - GEN_1 Basic Phone and enter quantity as 200 Nos.
7. Rate and Discount automatically appear as ₹ 5,100 and 5% respectively (As it was defined
in the updated Price List 10-08-2017)
8. Enter the Bill-wise Details as required
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
Activity: Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statement of inventory > Stock query > Select
OMED - GEN_1 Basic Phone >Press F7, to view the price list details and then press F10: Show
86
Conclusion
21
In this chapter, we have learnt how to define the different types of price levels for an organisation
R
using Tally.ERP 9 application. Apart from different price levels, we have learnt how price list for
multiple stock items are defined from the single screen and how these details reflect while
recording sales transactions.
Key Takeaways
Price list is generally used by organizations which require to set and change prices over a
period of time.
Price List can be maintained for different kinds/classifications of buyers.
Tally.ERP 9 facilitates the setting of different price levels while creating price lists for
multiple stock items.
Price list can be revised as per organisations requirement.
We can define the discount details while defining the price list
518
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Shortcut Keys
Key Combination Functionality
R
AI
F7 From Stock Query report
N
To get the Price List
AN
F10 From Stock Query >Price List report
AR
To get the Latest Price
H
Practice Exercises ED
LE
R
1. Tally.ERP 9 requires you to enter Price List details at the time of defining Price Level s
U
itself.
IM
a. True
b. False
FF
TE
2. From the below given Figure 13.9, the price list is defined for _______________
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
519
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
3. Match the following items and select the appropriate answer from the given
response sheet
R
c. a-1, b-3, c-2
AI
d. a-1, b-2, c-3
N
AN
4. You can create new price list, but can’t revise the price list.
a. True
AR
b. False
H
ED
5. To create Price Lists in Tally, Go to ______.
a. Gateway of Tally > Accounting Info > Stock Category > Stock Item > Create
LE
b. Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Group > Stock item > Create
c. Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Voucher types > Stock Item > Create
R
d. Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Price List > Create
U
IM
FF
b. False
-S
7. The date from which the Price List will be applicable cannot be set in the Price List.
6
a. True
00
b. False
00
8. For the discount percentage to be taken in the Price List, Separate Discount Column on
86
520
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Chapter 14
Manufacturing Process
Learning Objectives
Understanding of manufacturing process
R
Accounting of manufacturing entry in Tally.ERP 9
AI
N
Recording stock journal voucher
AN
Checking of reports like cost estimation and transfer analysis
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
521
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
14.1 Introduction
Manufacturing Processes is the process of conversion of raw materials/components into
finished goods. A Bill of Materials is a list of constituent items along with quantity details
that can be allotted for the manufacture of a certain product, by-product or likewise. This
facilitates immediate reduction in stock of the item automatically and also it saves time by
automatically allocating the components while recording Manufacturing entry. This process
of listing the items that make up another item is made possible in Tally.ERP 9 by enabling
the Bill of Materials feature.
Business Scenario
R
AI
N
DDL Manufactures are engaged in the business of assembling and manufacturing DDL
Laptops. For this the company maintains a Bill of Materials and record manufacturing
AN
journals using the BoM.
AR
H
Activity: Create the following Company
ED
Company Name: DDL Manufactures
th
LE
Address: No 209, 19 cross, twin tower New Delhi 110034
Financial Year: 01-04-2017
R
U
IM
Note: The same option can be enabled at the time of creation of stock item by pressing F12: Configure
00
Option.
86
Materials
21
R
Bill of Materials (BoM) is created only for those items that are being assembled in-house.
Therefore, you need to specify a BoM at the time of creating a Stock Item or while altering
the stock item. For trading items, you do not need a BoM.
Once after activating Bill of Materials, we can define the components while creating finished
good as stock item in Tally.ERP 9.
522
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
List of Components Units used for manufacturing 1 unit of
Finished goods (DDL Laptop)
Display Screen 1
Hard Disk Drive 1
Internal Battery 1
Keyboard 1
Speakers 2
Touch Pad 1
Table 14.1
R
To define the list of components using Bill of Materials in Tally.ERP 9, follow the
AI
procedure given below:
N
AN
Creation of Inventory Masters
Stock Groups
AR
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Groups > Create
H
ED
Against the Field Action to be Performed
Name Enter as Raw Materials
LE
Under Select as Primary
R
U
Table 14.2
FF
Activity: Similarly create the stock group by name Finished Goods under Primary and set yes to
TE
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info > Stock Items > Under Multi Stock Items
> Select Create > Select All Items, then create all the stock items given in Table 14.1
00
at one go
86
The Multi Stock Item Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 14.1
8
11
21
R
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Info. > Stock Items > Create
2. Enter the details as shown in the figure 14.2
The Stock Item Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 14.2
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
3. Enable the option Set components (BoM), the BoM List screen will appear as
6
The Stock Item Multi Components (M BoM) appears as shown in the figure 14.3
00
8 86
11
21
R
524
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
4. Enter DDL Pearl Black Laptop Bold in the Name of BoM field and press
Enter to get the Stock Item components (BoM) screen where we can define the
details of components
The Stock Item Components (BoM) screen appears as shown in the figure
14.4
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
BoM to Yes, you will get the Type of Item column to select the component type
TE
Note: In some of the manufacturing processes along with the Finished Goods, Co-Products or By-Products
6
or Scrap may be produced. We can define the Stock Item Type by enabling the option Define Type
00
7. Enter the components name one by one as shown in the figure 14.5
86
The Stock Item Components (BoM) screen of DDL Laptop appears as shown in the
8
figure 14.5:
11
21
R
525
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Figure 14.5 Stock Item Components (BoM)
8. Once after listing all the components as shown in the figure 14.5, select End of
List
and save the Stock Item Creation screen.
The purpose of creating a bill of material is to enable the auto consumption of the
materials in the ratio specified, when the product is manufactured. Tally.ERP 9 allows us
to use a Manufacturing Journal to enter the goods manufactured with the bill of materials.
Note: Tally.ERP 9 supports multiple BoM creation and copying of one BoM details to another. Ctrl+C
Copy BoM option will be highlighted, if more than one BoM is created.
R
AI
14.4 Accounting of Manufacturing Process in
N
AN
Tally.ERP 9
AR
Manufacturing Journal is the place where the manufactured inventory is accounted and
H
recorded since is not a default Voucher Type in Tally.ERP 9. A new voucher type has to be
created in Tally.ERP 9, for accounting manufacturing process.
ED
LE
Illustration 2: Creation of Manufacturing journal voucher and Accounting of
R
Date Particulars
TE
01-07-2017 Purchase the following components from Mohan Traders on credit and
-S
Stock Item
00
Drive
11
Battery
R
526
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
10-07-2017 Sold the following stock items to Sona Computers on credit
Name of the Quantity Rate per (₹) Amount (₹)
stock item
DDL Laptop 50 10,000/Nos. 50,000
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
527
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Table 14.3
To record the transactions of table 14.3, in the books of DDL Manufacturers, first ensure
that the required ledgers are created in Tally.ERP 9.
R
AI
Jayanagar Store house
N
3. Accept the Godown Creation screen
AN
Step 2: Creation of Manufacturing Journal Voucher Type
To create a new Manufacturing Journal voucher type, follow the steps given below:
AR
H
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Accounts Info. > Voucher Types > Create
ED
2. In the Name field Type Manufacturing Journal
3. In Select Type of Voucher field, select Stock Journal, by doing this the
LE
manufacturing journal voucher type will inherit the properties of predefined stock
journal voucher type
R
U
The Manufacturing Journal Voucher Type creation screen appears as shown in the figure
-S
14.6:
6
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
528
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Note: The Manufacturing Journal is a variant of the Stock Journal, where the Bill of Material will be
captured automatically and where the purpose is to record a manufacturing activity. Hence, the manufacturing
journal should be used where a stock item is manufactured using a BoM. And also in manufacturing
journal, we can define the expenses incurred details in manufacturing voucher.
Mohan Traders
R
AI
Against the Field Actions to be Performed
N
Name Enter as Mohan Traders
AN
AR
Under Select as Sundry Creditors
H
Maintain balances bill-by-bill Set to Yes
entry?
IM
Table 14.4
TE
Debtors
00
Accounts
11
Expenses
R
529
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Step 4: Recording of Purchase Voucher
R
AI
7. Enter Godown as Jayanagar Storehouse and Quantity, Rate and Amount will get
N
captured automatically in Item Allocation screen
AN
The Purchase Voucher screen appears as shown in the figure 14.7
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
Note: All the raw materials is stored in Godown by name Jayanagar Location
530
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Observation: Once after recording the transaction go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary > Press
Enter on Raw Materials, we will get the details of purchased stock.
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Press Alt+F7 > Select
Manufacturing Journal
2. Press F2:Date and change the date to 02-07-2017
3. In the Name of product field select DDL Laptops (Finished Goods)
4. Once after selecting finished good, Name of BOM & Components(Consumption)
details will get captured automatically, if required one can change the Name of BOM by
R
pressing Backspace
AI
N
The Manufacturing Journal Voucher screen with BOM appears as shown in the figure 14.8:
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
R
U
IM
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
5. In Godown field select Jayanagar Storehouse, this is location where a finished goods
8
11
details the Quantity, Rate and Amount will get captured automatically for component.
R
The Manufacturing Journal Voucher screen with components appears as shown in the figure
14.9:
531
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 14.9 Manufacturing Journal Voucher Screen - Components
H
Note:
ED
LE
Once after defining the quantity to be manufactured in manufacturing journal voucher, the
components will get automatically listed along with the required quantity to make a finished goods.
R
This is happening because we have created BoM and selected the same while recording the
U
IM
record the entry without selecting BoM. If BoM is not selected, then we need to allocate the required
TE
components manually.
-S
Storehouse
00
scrap or co-products or by-products are produced then need to select the same under
this field)
86
9. Under Type of Additional Cost select the expenses incurred while manufacturing
8
The Completed Manufacturing Journal Voucher appears as shown in the figure 14.10:
R
532
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 14.10 Manufacturing Journal Voucher Screen
H
ED
11. Accept the screen
LE
Observation: Once the labour Charge and Packing charge is added the effective rate of
R
primary item increases to 5,860/Nos. In this price the labour charge and packing charge is
U
added.
IM
Activity: Once after recording the above entry, go to Gateway of Tally > Stock Summary, here you will
FF
get the finished goods quantity as 50. This is the quantity which we have manufactured.
TE
7. Under Name of Item field as DDL Laptops and fill in the details in Item Allocations
R
533
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
The Stock Item Allocation for screen appears as shown in the figure 14.11:
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
Figure 14.11 Stock Item Allocation screen
LE
8. Accept the screen
9. Enter the Bill-wise Details
R
The Sales Voucher Creation screen appears as shown in the figure 14.12:
FF
TE
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
534
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Activity:
Once after recording the entry of figure 14.12, check the stock summary report the finished goods
quantity will be nil. This is because we have manufactured 50 quantity of laptop and sold the same.
On 10-07-2017, manufacture 100 Quantity of DDL Laptop and store the same in
Jayanagar Storehouse and include labour charges of ₹ 4,000 and Packing charges of ₹ 2,000
while manufacturing.
R
AI
N
In Tally.ERP 9, Stock Journal voucher is used to transfer the goods from one location to
AN
another and also this voucher is used to record the manufacturing process.
AR
Illustration 2: Transferring of manufactured goods from one location to another using
stock journal voucher and checking of stock journal register.
H
Pass the following transaction in the book of DDL Manufactures ED
LE
Date Particulars
11-07-2017 Transferred 50 Quantity of DDL Laptops from Jayanagar Location
R
U
to Jayanagar Showroom.
IM
Table 14.5
To transfer the manufactured goods from one location to another, follow the steps given
FF
below:
1. Go to Gateway of Tally > Inventory Vouchers > Press Alt+F7 > Select Stock
TE
Journal
-S
2. Under Source (Consumption) field select the stock item by name DDL Laptop
3. Select the Godown as Jayanagar Storehouse
6
00
4. Enter Quantity as 50 and the Rate and Amount will get captured automatically
00
The Stock Journal Voucher screen with Source (Consumption) appears as shown in the
86
figure 14.13:
8
11
21
R
535
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
5. Bring the cursor to Destination (Production) filed and enter the stock item details as
shown in the figure 14.14
R
AI
N
AN
AR
H
ED
LE
Figure 14.14 Stock Journal Voucher Screen – Destination (Production)
R
Once after recording the entry check the following report in Tally.ERP 9
FF
14.6 Reports
TE
Once after recording the transactions like purchase, manufacturing journal, sales and
-S
stock journal let us check the how these transactions are reflected instantly on reports
6
like Stock Journal Register, Transfer Analysis, Godown Summary and Cost estimation.
00
Stock Transfers/Stock Journal Register displays the list of all the Stock Journal Vouchers
86
used in Tally.ERP 9 to make stock adjustments. For example, to record any increase or
8
Transactions recorded in manufacturing journal voucher will reflect the details in Stock
journal register.
R
To view stock transfer register, go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books>
Stock Transfers.
The Stock Journal Register screen appears as shown in the figure 14.15:
536
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 14.15 Stock Journal Register
H
ED
Select a particular month and press Enter to reach the Voucher Register where we will
get the details of all vouchers of that particular month.
LE
R
When using different Stock Journals types to record different transactions, Transfer
IM
Analysis
FF
This report displays information about the Items which are transacted in the Stock
-S
To view the Stock Transfer analysis for any Stock Journal Voucher
Type:
86
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Movement Analysis
8
11
>Transfer Analysis > Select Manufacturing Journal, from the list of voucher type.
21
14.16:
537
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 14.16 Transfer Analysis Report
H
ED
In the report of figure 14.16, you will get the goods production details as well as goods
consumed details.
LE
R
Activity: Similarly check the other reports falling under the Movement Analysis
U
Report.
IM
FF
Cost Estimation is a statement that gives the value of the cost incurred in the
manufacturing of finished goods. To view the cost estimation of a particular finished
-S
product, select the relevant Stock Group which will display the stock consumption
6
details and cost thereof for each of the stock items falling under that Group.
00
00
Cost estimation helps in fixing the selling price of the final product after charging
appropriate overheads and allowing certain margin for profits. It also helps in drawing
86
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Statements of Inventory > Cost Estimation >
Select Finished Goods (Stock Group) > Press F5 to display all BoM
538
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
R
AI
N
AN
AR
Figure 14.17 Item Estimates Report
H
ED
Note:
LE
From the report of figure 14.17, press F6:Component-wise to view Components-wise
Item Estimates details.
R
U
Press F5: Show All BOM to view the details all BOM created in Tally.ERP 9.
IM
FF
Stock Ageing Analysis report displays the details of period i.e., how long the stock is lying
ideal in the godown. It produces default ageing period of <45 days, 45-90 days, 90-180
-S
days and >180 days. Depending on the requirement, you can also define the ageing slabs.
6
00
To check the Stock Ageing Analysis report, follow the steps given below:
Go to Gateway of Tally > Display > Inventory Books > Ageing Analysis > Select
00
The Stock Ageing Analysis report appears as shown in the figure 14.18:
11
21
R
Note: From the Stock Ageing Analysis Report screen, press Alt+F1: Detailed, in order to get the details
of Godowns.
Conclusion
R
In this chapter, we have learnt about manufacturing process and how the same is handled
AI
with ease in Tally.ERP 9, with the use of Bill of Materials. We have seen how BoM
N
automate the allocation of components while recording manufacturing journal voucher
AN
and also we have seen how additional cost incurred while manufacturing can be added to
the cost of finished goods.
AR
H
Key Takeaways ED
LE
Bill-of-Material is a term generally associated with the manufacturing of goods.
R
Tally.ERP 9’s Manufacturing Journal records the item manufactured with the use
U
item consumed
The manufacturing journal is not a default voucher type in Tally.ERP 9. It has to be
FF
created
TE
Cost Estimation is a statement that gives the value of the cost incurred
6
Shortcut Keys
86
540
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.
Practice Exercises
1. Bill of Materials (BoM) feature can be enabled for which type of stock item?
a. Finished Goods
b. Components
c. Scrap
d. Raw Materials
R
2. I cannot allocate the expenses incurred to produce finished goods in Tally.ERP 9.
AI
a. True
N
b. False
AN
3. In ______________report, one can check the details of all the BoM created in
AR
Tally.ERP 9.
a. Stock Journal Register
H
b. Transfer Analysis
c. Cost Estimation
ED
LE
d. Transfer Analysis
R
used in Tally.ERP 9.
IM
a. Bill of Materials
FF
b. Price Level
c. Bill of Inventory
TE
a BoM 1 Recording of
21
Manufacturing process
b Manufacturing journal Voucher 2 Transfer of stock from
R
R
b. Purchase Voucher Type
AI
c. Physical stock Voucher Type
N
d. Stock Journal Voucher Type
AN
9. What is the shortcut key to record a Manufacturing Journal Voucher?
AR
a. Alt+F8
H
b. Alt+F7
ED
c. Ctrl+F7
d. Ctrl+F8
LE
R
10. I can transfer the goods from one location to another location with
U
_________Voucher.
IM
a. Purchase
b. Sales
FF
c. Rejection In
TE
d. Stock Journal
6 -S
00
00
8 86
11
21
R
542
This book is a personal copy of STEFFI MURLEEDHARAN NAIR of NIIT Panvel Centre , issued on 09/05/2020.
No Part of this book may be distributed or transferred to anyone in any form by any means.